Руководство По Работам в Условиях Мастерских
Руководство По Работам в Условиях Мастерских
Руководство По Работам в Условиях Мастерских
WITH ACCESSORIES
SL65B
WORKSHOP MANUAL
IMPORTANT: The information contained in this manual are valid at printing time. As the Manufacturer
12602
continuously improves his products, some information may not be updated. In case of discrepancies, apply
to Sales and Service Department.
• This manual has been written for a skilled content, please contact:
technician, in order to give him the
information necessary to repair this FIAT KOBELCO CONSTRUCTOR
machine. MACHINERY S.p.A.
Strada Settimo, 323
- Read this manual carefully for correct San Mauro Torinese (TO)
information about repair procedures. 10099 ITALIA
PRODUCT SUPPORT
- For any question or comment, or in case DOCUMENTATION CENTER
you notice a mistake in this manual Fax. ++39 011 6877357
• The complete repair manual consists of one maintenance standards, remove and install
volume: procedures, disassembly and assembly
procedures.
SL65B - Workshop Manual "Compact loader
with accessories" • The complete Workshop Manual for the
compact loader with accessories model
• “Compact loader with accessories" Workshop SL65B consist of the following volume
Manual contais the technical information identified by print number as shown
necessary for machine/engine service and herebelow:
repair, service equipment, information on
12602
ATTENTION
CONTENT
SECTION 10 – ENGINE
Chapter 1 – Gearboxes
CONTENT
CONTENT
CONTENT
CONTENT
CONTENT
SECTION 39 – FRAMES
CONTENT
Chapter 1 – Axles
CONTENT
Chapter 1 – Heater/Defroster
CONTENT
CONTENT
Chapter 1 – Buckets
CONTENT
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES
CONTENT
CONTENT
7
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION
CONTENT
COMPANY POLICY
Company policy, which is one of continuous improvement, reserves the right to make changes in design and
specifications at any time without notice and without obligation to modify units previously built.
All data given in this book is subject to production variations. Dimensions and weights are approximate only and
the illustrations do not necessarily show skid steers in standard condition.
MODEL CODES
The range of Skid Steers described in this manual is identified in the text by the engine horsepower Pferdestarke.
(PS). The skid steers listed below may not be available in all countries or markets.
ENGINE PS MODEL
332T/JF 60 SL65B
4 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
SAFETY PRECAUTION INFORMATION battery cable. This will shut off power to the
EIC and prevent damage to the EIC board or
CAUTION
blowing the 5-amp fuses if the board is
Unsafe operating practices and improper use of the accidentally grounded.
skid steer and its attachments on the part of the oper-
ator can result in injuries. Observe the following 16. If welding is required on the skid steer,
safety precautions at all times: disconnect the (–) negative ground cable.
1. For servicing, the skid steer should be on failure to disconnect the battery may result in
level terrain, engine stopped with the wheels damage to the EIC (Electronic Instrument
blocked or the entire skid steer solidly Cluster) monitoring system and other electri-
supported with the wheels off the ground cal components.
before servicing any component of the
17. If welding is required on an attachment,
drivetrain.
remove the attachment from the skid steer.
2. For servicing under the operator’s seat, raise
18. Give complete and undivided attention to the
the seat and pan assembly up to the raised
job at hand so that complete control of the
latched position and securely latch.
skid steer is maintained at all times.
3. Do not operate the skid steer unless the seat
19. Drive slowly over rough ground and on
is latched in the operate position.
slopes; keep alert for holes, ditches and
4. Do not service the skid steer with a raised other irregularities that may cause the skid
boom unless the boom is resting on the steer to overturn.
boom lock pins.
20. Avoid steep hillside operation which could
5. Do not service the skid steer with the engine cause the skid steer to overturn.
running unless the skid steer is properly and
21. Never transport a loaded bucket at full height.
securely supported with all four wheels off
Operate the skid steer with the load as low as
the ground.
possible until it becomes necessary to raise
6. Use caution when servicing the unit around the boom to discharge the load into a truck,
moving parts. container, etc.
7. Do not tilt the boom and cab without proper 22. Reduce speed when turning so there is no
instruction. danger of the skid steer overturning.
8. Do not tilt the boom and cab without using 23. Never drive up or back up a hill or incline with
the proper cab tilting tool. a raised boom or the skid steer could over
turn.
9. Reinstall all shields removed for service.
24. Always look behind you before backing the
10. Never loosen any hydraulic connections skid steer.
before relieving the pressure in the hydraulic
system. 25. Maintain proper transmission oil level to
prevent loss of hydrostatic braking.
11. Wear eye protection such as goggles, etc.
26. Do not allow passengers to ride on the skid
12. Wear ear protection such as ear plugs, etc. steer at any time.
When you feel the noise level is uncomfort-
able. 27. Do not allow children to operate the skid
steer or ride on the skid steer at any time.
13. If any servicing or adjustments require the
battery to be disconnected, disconnect the 28. Do not allow anyone to operate the skid steer
(–) negative ground cable. without proper instruction. OSHA requires
that all operators be instructed on the proper
14. When servicing electrical components, dis- operation of the machine before they operate
connect the (–) negative ground cable. the unit.
15. If the electronic instrument cluster (EIC) 29. Do not operate the skid steer in any position
requires removal from the dash area or the other than while in the operator’s seat with
skid steer disconnect the (–) negative ground the seat belt securely fastened.
6 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
30. Before starting the engine, be sure that all 42. Never extend any part of the body outside of
operating controls are in neutral and the the operator’s area.
parking brake is engaged.
43. Always properly tie down the skid steer to a
31. Never operate the skid steer engine in a truck or trailer before transport.
closed building without adequate ventilation.
44. Make sure all bystanders are at a safe
32. Refuel the skid steer outdoors with the distance away from the skid steer before
engine shut off. Replace the fuel cap starting the engine.
securely. Use an approved fuel container. Do
not smoke when handling fuel. Avoid spilling 45. Do not allow anyone near the skid steer while
fuel. the engine is running and the skid steer is
operational.
33. After operating the engine, never touch the
muffler, exhaust pipe, engine or radiator until 46. When using the skid steer to crane objects,
they have had time to cool. do not allow any person to ride on objects
being craned.
34. Dress appropriately - wear relatively tight-fit-
ting clothing when operating the skid steer. 47. Do not use the skid steer as a work platform
Loose or torn clothing can catch in moving for supporting materials.
parts or controls.
48. Do not lift personnel or allow personnel to
35. Before servicing the skid steer or any of its work while standing in the bucket or on other
attached equipment, be sure that the attachments. This is not a man-lift.
attachments are lowered to the ground or
OSHA requirements now make it the
that the boom arms are supported by the
employer’s responsibility to fully instruct
boom lock pins.
each operator in the proper and safe
36. Do not work under overhangs, electric wires, operation of all operative equipment. Both
or where there is danger of a slide. employer and employee should thoroughly
familiarize themselves with the following
37. Wear an approved safety hat when operating sections.
the machine and while in any work area.
F13724
1
ENGINE MODEL AND SERIAL NUMBER
LOCATION
The engine model is located on the left side of the
block at 1, and the engine serial number is located at
2.
2
For the tightening torques for reassembly, use the fol-
lowing hardware torque charts unless the torque is
specified in the instructions.
10 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
NOMINAL UNPLATED PLATED UNPLATED PLATED UNPLATED PLATED GR.B GR.C NOMINAL
SIZE or W/ZnCr or W/ZnCr or W/ZnCr w/GR5 w/GR8 SIZE
PLATED PLATED PLATED BOLT BOLT
SILVER GOLD SILVER GOLD SILVER GOLD
1/4 55* (6.2) 72* (8.1) 86* (9.7) 112* (13) 121* (14) 157* (18) 61* (6.9) 86* (9.8) 1/4
5/16 115* (13) 149* (17) 178* (20) 229* (26) 250* (28) 324* (37) 125* (14) 176* (20) 5/16
3/8 17 (23) 22 (30) 26 (35) 34 (46) 37 (50) 48 (65) 19 (26) 26 (35) 3/8
7/16 27 (37) 35 (47) 42 (57) 54 (73) 59 (80) 77 (104) 30 (41) 42 (57) 7/16
1/2 42 (57) 54 (73) 64 (87) 83 (113) 91 (123) 117 (159) 45 (61) 64 (88) 1/2
9/16 60 (81) 77 (104) 92 (125) 120 (163) 130 (176) 169 (229) 65 (88) 92 (125) 9/16
5/8 83 (112) 107 (145) 128 (174) 165 (224) 180 (244) 233 (316) 90 (122) 127 (172) 5/8
3/4 146 (198) 189 (256) 226 (306) 293 (397) 319 (432) 413 (560) 160 (217) 226 (306) 3/4
7/8 142 (193) 183 (248) 365 (495) 473 (641) 515 (698) 667 (904) 258 (350) 364 (494) 7/8
1 213 (289) 275 (373) 547 (742) 708 (960) 773 (1048) 1000 (1356) 386 (523) 545 (739) 1
LOCKNUTS
GRADE A NO MARK
GRADE B LETTER B
GRADE C LETTER C
GRADE IDENTIFICATION
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 11
M4 15* (1.7) 19* (2.2) 23* (2.6) 30* (3.4) 33* (3.7) 42* (4.8) 16* (1.8)
M6 51* (5.8) 67* (7.6) 79* (8.9) 102* (12) 115* (13) 150* (17) 56* (6.3)
M8 124* (14) 159* (18) 195* (22) 248* (28) 274* (31) 354* (40) 133* (15)
M10 21 (28) 27 (36) 32 (43) 41 (56) 45 (61) 58 (79) 22 (30)
M12 36 (49) 46 (63) 55 (75) 72 (97) 79 (107) 102 (138) 39 (53)
M16 89 (121) 117 (158) 137 (186) 177 (240) 196 (266) 254 (344) 97 (131)
M20 175 (237) 226 (307) 277 (375) 358 (485) 383 (519) 495 (671) 195 (265)
M24 303 (411) 392 (531) 478 (648) 619 (839) 662 (897) 855 (1160) 338 (458)
MANUFACTURER’S IDENTIFICATION
PROPERTY CLASS
MANUFACTURER’S IDENTIFICATION
PIPE THREAD FITTING TORQUE Before installing and tightening pipe fittings, clean
the threads with a clean solvent or Loctite cleaner
Thread Size Torque (Maximum) and apply sealant Loctite no. 567 for all fittings includ-
1/8″ – 27 13 N⋅m (10 ft. lbs.) ing stainless steel or no. 565 for most metal fittings.
For high filtration/zero contamination systems use
1/4″ – 18 16 N⋅m (12 ft. lbs.) no. 545.
3/8″ – 14 22 N⋅m (16 ft. lbs.)
1/2″ – 14 41 N⋅m (30 ft. lbs.)
3/4″ – 14 54 N⋅m (40 ft. lbs.)
SEALANTS
Description Typical Applications Strength Color
Thread Lock Small Low Purple
screws/hardware Medium Blue
Wicking Type Medium Green
Nuts & Bolts High Red
Thread Sealants Hydraulic/Pneumatic Non fouling
Pipe Sealant Controlled strength
Pipe Sealant High Temperature
Silicones Ultra Blue RTV Gasket Non-corrosive Blue
Ultra Blue RTV Gasket Non-corrosive Blue
Ultra Blue RTV Gasket Non-corrosive Black
Ultra Blue RTV Gasket Non-corrosive Black
14 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
4
PROPERLY SUPPORT BOOM ON BOOM
LOCK PINS
Before servicing the machine or any of its attached
equipment, be sure that the attachments are lowered
to the ground or the boom arms are supported by the
boom lock pins, 1.
If the boom is to be raised on boom lock pins, remove
any attachment. Opening a hydraulic line could
cause a mounted attachment to dump over unex-
pectedly.
5
RAISING BOOM WITHOUT HYDRAULIC OIL
FLOW
(Engine or Hydraulic System not functioning)
1. Remove any attachment from the boom
mounting plate.
2. Block the rear of the skid steer under the rear of
the final drive cases, 1, as shown. This will
prevent the front wheels from raising during
boom lifting.
1
19995748
6
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 15
19995749
7
4. With an Operator sitting in the Operator’s seat
with the seat belt buckled.
5. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position. Foot
controls, press the toe of the left foot pedal, boom
control, or hand controls, pivot the left hand con-
trol lever down, into the boom float position.
6. Slowly raise the boom above the boom lock pins,
1.
7. Operator sitting in seat, engage the boom lock 1
pins, 1.
8. Lower the boom and rest on the boom lock pins,
1.
19995750
9. Return the boom control to the “NEUTRAL” posi-
8
tion.
10. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position.
CAUTION
The operator must not leave the operator’s seat until
the boom is resting solidly on the boom lock pins. The
boom could drop suddenly if lifting devices should
fail.
19995748
9
16 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
CAUTION
Attach suitable chains or straps capable of handling
the weight of the boom, about 450 kg (1000 lbs.). At- 2
tach chains securely to prevent them from coming
loose during lifting of the boom. 1
19995749
10
4. Remove the rod end (top) pivot pins, 1, from both
cylinders. Remove retaining hardware, 2, from
pivot pin and boom.
2 1
19995751
11
5. Support the cylinders on the fenders, 1, as
shown.
1
19995752
12
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 17
1
19995754
14
2. Operator sitting in the Operator’s seat with seat
belt buckled.
3. Start the engine and hydraulically extend cylin-
der rods to align cylinder with pivot pin, 1. Stop
engine. 1
4. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position. Foot
controls, press the toe of the left foot pedal, boom
control, or hand controls, pivot the left hand con-
trol lever down, into the boom float position, turn
the ignition key to the “OFF” position.
5. If cylinder and boom are not properly aligned, use
a pry bar to align cylinder and boom.
19995755
15
18 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
17
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 19
3462-07r
19
2. Raise the boom and lower onto boom lockpins,
1.
– Raise boom above boom lockpins.
– Engage boom lockpins. 1
– Stop engine, turn ignition key to “OFF” posi-
tion.
– Turn ignition key to the “ON” position. 1
– Lower boom onto boom lockpins.
– Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position.
3170-04
20
20 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
3410-15
21
4. Open the rear door, 1, raise and latch the top en-
gine shield, 2, in the raised position. 5
5. Remove engine side covers, 3. 2 1
3
6. Remove fenders, 4, rear fender supports, 6, right
and left sides.
7. Remove foam material, 5, from both sides.
4
6 3
19984624
22
8. Disconnect the battery, negative(-) cable, 1.
3171-08
23
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 21
A5378-15
24
10. Allow the air cleaner canister assembly to rest on
the engine as shown at 1.
NOTE: If the unit is equipped with the cab heater, the
water supply lines to the heater core must be discon-
nected and capped.
1
A5378-14
25
11. Raise the seat and lock in the up position, 1.
Make sure the seat pan assembly is latched se-
curely.
12. Remove the front step shield, 2.
1
2
3409-16
26
22 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
3410-03
27
14. Install the lower cab jack support, 1. Hook the
support over the end of the front left final drive
housing at and attach with a 1/2″ x 8″ cap screw, 2
2.
2
2541-07r
28
15. Install the upper cab jack support, 1. Pivot the re-
taining plate, 3, up behind the boom top link and 1
secure with 1/2″ x 1-1/4″ carriage bolt and 1/2″
wing nut. Install retaining bolt, 4, 1/2″ x 2-1/2″ cap
screw through side of cab with a large 1/2″ flat 3
washer, 1/2″ wing nut to the inside of cab and
tighten.
NOTE: Spacer, 2, is not required for the SL65B skid
steers.
4
2
3409-13
29
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 23
2
3
3410-02
17. Loosen the front cab mounting bolts, 2, (one 30
each side) only enough to allow the bolt to rotate
in post and remove the rear front cab bolts, 3, one
each side.
CAUTION
Never remove the front cab bolts, 2, as these are the
pivot bolts during the cab tilting procedure. Removal
of these bolts could cause cab to fall, and may cause
injury and machine damage.
2 2
19984332
31
19. Jack cab and boom assembly over with the
loader properly supported off the ground. Sup-
port the boom at 1, to support the boom and cab
to prevent tipping of the skid steer when heavy
components, engine, hydrostatic pumps etc. are
removed from the lower frame. Jack travel will
limit the travel of the cab assembly to prevent
over travel. Be sure all wire harnesses, hydraulic
hoses, and throttle cable clear any obstructions
during cab tilting.
1
3410-07
32
24 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
2 2
19984332
34
9. Torque the front bolts, 1, to 160 ft. lbs. (217 N·m).
10. Reinstall the foam, 2, fenders, 3, and front step
shield, 4.
WARNING
Never attempt to tilt the skid steer cab without proper 2
instructions and using the proper tool. See the ser-
vice manual and/or your dealer. 4
Never attempt to operate or move the skid steer with-
out first installing and properly tightening all cab re- 1
taining hardware.
1 3
CAUTION 3410-15
Reinstall all shields that were removed for servicing 35
and adjustment procedures.
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 25
36
CRANING THE SKID STEER
If the skid steer is inoperative and located in an area
where it cannot be loaded onto a truck or trailer, the
unit may be craned to load the unit.
To crane the loader, only use chain or cable with a
rated capacity to handle the weight of the model skid
steer being craned. Refer to the “Specifications” sec-
tion of the operator’s manual for the operating weight
of the model loader being craned. Use three chains,
minimum of 12′ (3.66 m) long, to prevent sharp
angles and damage to the loader cab, boom, and
lifting chains.
37
Remove any attachment except a standard bucket
from the loader boom attaching plate.
CAUTION
Do not lift any attachments on the loader mounting
plate that weigh 600 lbs. (272 kg) or more. lift such
attachments separately.
38
26 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
39
The front lifting point is located in the center of the
main frame, 1.
40
The lifting chains or cables must be minimum, 12′
(3.66 m). The lifting hook point must be minimum of
75″ (1.9 m) above the cab, 1, to prevent the chains
or cables from damaging the loader frame or cab.
WARNING
Always use properly rated lifting devices to prevent
personal injury or damage to the loader.
41
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 27
CAUTION
When craning (lifting or lowering) a skid steer, follow
these precautions: 6. Do not attach lifting devices to the loader
1. No riders (including the operator) in or on the boom or attachments attached to the boom
machine while lifting or lowering. mounting plate.
2. Do not lift any attachments on the loader 7. Make sure the loader boom is in the
boom mounting plate that weigh 600 lbs. (272 completely lowered position.
kg) or more. Lift such attachments separate-
8. Make sure that any attachment to be lifted on
ly.
the skid steer is securely fastened to the
3. Always use a chain, cable, etc. capable of loader boom mounting plate with the
safely hoisting the weight of the skid steer. over-center handles and pins fully engaged.
Pivot the attachment fully back.
4. Before hoisting the skid steer, always inspect
the lifting chain, cable, etc. and the lifting 9. Make sure that the engine is off and the
points on the main frame, to insure they are parking brake is engaged before lifting.
in good condition. if worn or damaged, do not
10. Keep bystanders away from the machine a
use.
safe distance while lifting.
5. Do not lift the skid steer with any frame-
mounted attachments such as a backhoe or
rear stabilizers.
28 SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1
SPECIAL TOOLS
Tool Number Order From Description SL65B
86590084 Cab Tilting Tool ***
Engine
FNH02136 OTC Valve Guide Ream kit *
FNH01301 OTC Rear Crank Shaft Seal Installer ***
FNH01442 OTC Cam Shaft Bearing Installation *
Tool and Handle
FNH01255
FNH09539 OTC Cam Shaft pulley, puller and *
FNH09212 OTC shaft protector
FNH09539 is also used to
remove water pump pulley
FNH02134 OTC Crank shaft timing gear puller *
FNH01237 OTC and adapter
Hydraulic System
238 Bar (3500 Psi) Test Gauge OTC Main system pressure ***
Flow meter OTC Main system/Hydrostatic pumps ***
3/4″ –16 UNF Oring fitting Local Main system at Boom cylinder ***
1/2″ Quick coupler Main system at Auxiliary boom *
couplers
FNH22ESS95 OTC Hydraulic tank pressuring tool *
*Recommend Tool
***Essential Tool
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 29
SPECIFICATIONS
MODEL SL65B
MODEL SL65B
CAPACITIES
Cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.5 US. qt. (14.7 L)
Cooling system pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . radiator cap 13 psi (89.5 kpa)
Engine crankcase w/filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 US. qt. (6.6L)
Fuel tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 US. Gal. (68 L)
Hydraulic system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.3 US. Gal. (42.6 L)
Engine gearbox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.4 US. qt. (1.32 L)
Common gearbox and final drive chain case (ea.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.6 US. qt. (9.1 L)
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BCI PC31 - 12V 925 amps @ 0° F (-18° C)
Alternator capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 amps
Starter switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Key start and relay
Ignition system protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuse 15 amps
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
Pump - Make or type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gear pump
Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.5 US. GPM (70 LPM) @2350 RPM @1000 PSI (68 bar)
Optional high flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32.3 US. GPM (122.8 LPM) @ 2350 RPM @ 1000 PSI (68 bar)
Hydraulic system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.3 US. gal. (42.6 L)
Hydraulic fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . API Service SH/CG4 10W-30
Control valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 Spool Open Center
Main system relief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2500 PSI - 2600 PSI (170 - 176 bar)
Circuit relief - boom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3500 PSI (238 bar)
BOOM CYLINDERS
Double-acting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5″(6.4cm) Bore; 24.06″(61.1cm) Stroke
Raise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.6 seconds
Lower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.5 seconds
BUCKET CYLINDERS
Double-acting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.5″ (6.4 cm) Bore
Cycle time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.6″(44.7cm) Stroke
Dump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.4 seconds
Curl . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.8 seconds
HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSIONS
Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Variable displacement piston type
Motor (with single speed) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fixed displacement piston type
Motor (with 2-speed) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Variable displacement piston type
Charge pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 - 300 PSI (17 - 20.4 bar)
Relief pressure (transmission) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5000 PSI (344.7 bar)
Oil type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SAE 10W-30 API SH/CG4
TRAVEL SPEEDS - 12.00 X 16.5 Tyres
Low range - MAX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2 MPH (11.6 KPH)
SL65B equipped with factory 2-speed
High range - MAX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11.4 MPH (18.3 KPH)
SECTION 00 – GENERAL INFORMATION – CHAPTER 1 31
MODEL SL65B
42
DIMENSIONS - SL65B WITH 72, DIRT AND FOUNDRY BUCKET AND 12 X 16.5 TYRES - IN. (CM)
43
DIMENSIONS - SL65B WITH 72, DIRT AND FOUNDRY BUCKET AND12 X 16.5 TYRES - IN. (CM)
Op. 10 000
Keep away from parts which turn during operation.
INTRODUCTION Note that fans cannot be seen clearly while the en-
gine is running.
This engine section has two parts to cover the two en-
gines. Refer to the chapter that pertains to the engine Do not run the engine with any safety guards re-
being serviced. moved.
Chapter 1 - SL65B 332T/JF engine (3-cylinder, Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine is
turbocharged) hot and the coolant is under pressure, as dangerous
hot coolant can be discharged.
Do not use salt water in the fresh water cooling sys-
tem or any other coolant which can cause corrosion.
Keep sparks or fire away from batteries (especially
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS during charge) or combustion can occur. The battery
CAUTION fluid can burn and is also dangerous to the skin and
Do not change the specification of the engine. especially the eyes.
Do not smoke when you put fuel in the tank. Disconnect the battery terminals before you make a
repair to the electrical system.
Clean away any fuel which has spilled and move ma-
terial which has fuel contamination to a safe place. Only one person must be in control of the engine.
Do not put fuel in the tank during engine operation Ensure the engine is only operated from the control
(unless absolutely necessary). panel or operator’s position.
Never clean, lubricate, or adjust the engine during If your skin comes into contact with high-pressure
operation (unless you have had the correct training fuel, get medical assistance immediately.
when extreme caution must be used to prevent in- Diesel fuel and used engine oils can cause skin dam-
jury). age to some persons. Use protection on the hands
Do not make any adjustments you do not under- (gloves or special skin protection solutions).
stand. Do not move equipment unless the brakes are in
Ensure the engine is not in a position to cause a con- good condition.
centration of toxic emissions. Ensure that the transmission drive control is in neu-
Persons in the area must be kept clear during engine tral position before the engine is started.
and equipment or vehicle operation. Do not use ether to start the engine.
Do not permit loose clothing or long hair near parts
which move.
4 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
ENGINE DESCRIPTION
The LS180 skid steer is equipped with a 332T/JF,
turbocharged diesel engine, 60 SAE net HP, 192
cubic inch displacement.
The 332T/JF series is a three-cylinder, four-stroke,
liquid-cooled and turbocharged diesel engine, de-
signed to provide fuel efficiency, quiet operation, and
durable performance. The engine features cross flow
cylinder heads with the inlet and exhaust manifolds
on opposite sides of the head. The combustion
chamber is formed in the crown of the piston. The pis-
ton has three compression rings and one oil control
ring, all located above the piston pin. The cylinder
head assembly incorporates the valves, valve
springs, and spring retainers. Valve guides are an
integral part of the cylinder head with replaceable
valve seats pressed into the valve ports.
ENGINE MODEL AND SERIAL NUMBER
LOCATION
The engine model number, serial number, date of
manufacture, and other important information are lo-
cated on the nameplate on the rear of the engine
valve cover.
19995962
1
CYLINDER HEAD AND VALVES
The cylinder head casting contains the following de-
tail:
Larger inlet ports, 2, feature a snail shell form
which swirls inducted air, improving the air/fuel
mixing and the resultant quality of combustion.
This design contributes to performance and fuel
efficiency.
The inlet valves, 4, and valve seats have a 29.5°
face angle and a 30° seat angle, respectively.
The exhaust valves and valve seats have a 44.5°
face angle and a 45° seat angle, respectively.
The turbocharged engine incorporates heavy-
duty rocker shafts. 2
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 5
3
CYLINDER BLOCK
The cylinder block of the turbocharged engine con-
tains oil jets, 1, fed from the main bearing journals to
provide under piston cooling and additional lubrica-
tion.
1
5
3 6
4 7
4
PISTONS AND CONNECTING RODS the combustion bowl. This configuration aids the
Effective with engine serial number 532563, a piston swirl of the incoming air from the cylinder head, im-
change was made. The early piston is fitted with proving fuel/air mixing.
three compression rings, 1, 2, and 3, and oil control The connecting rods are machined from high-
ring, 4, with expander. The later piston is fitted with strength forged steel. The big end bearings are re-
a keystone top compression ring, 5; a second com- newable, steel-backed, copper/lead alloy overlay
pression ring, 6; and an oil control ring, 7, with expan- with tin plating. The small end bearings are a press
der. Both pistons are of the “Mexican Hat” type, so fit plain bush of tin-backed lead/bronze.
called because of the raised section in the middle of
6 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
CRANKSHAFT AND MAIN BEARINGS The timing gears are lubricated by oil from the cam
The crankshaft is a chrome-molybdenum steel forg- follower chamber and the pressure lubricated cam-
ing, fully machined, static, and dynamically balanced shaft drive gear bushing.
with integral counterweights. All bearing surfaces are Cylinder walls, pistons, and piston pins are splash lu-
induction hardened. Axial location is maintained by bricated by the connecting rods and rotating crank-
thrust washers. The main journals run in replaceable shaft as well as by oil jets fed from the main bearing
steel-backed cast copper/lead alloy bearings. The journals.
front of the crankshaft is keyed. An intermittent flow of oil is directed to the valve
rocker arm shaft assembly via a drilled passage in
CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEAR TRAIN the cylinder block located vertically above the No. 1
The camshaft is made of forged steel and is induction camshaft bearing. This drilling aligns with a corre-
hardened. Friction bearings support the camshaft. sponding hole in the cylinder head. As the camshaft
The camshaft is lubricated by oil pressure from the turns, holes in the camshaft and camshaft bearing
main oil gallery. align and a regulated stream of oil is directed to the
cylinder head and on up the rocker arm shaft support
The timing gear train consists of three helical gears;
bolt to the rocker shaft. The oil flows from the shaft
the crankshaft gear (located by a woodruff key), the
through drilled holes in each rocker arm bushing to
idler gear, and the camshaft gear.
lubricate both ends of the arms. Excess oil flows
down the pushrods and assists in lubricating the cam
LUBRICATION SYSTEM followers before draining back into the pan through
Lubrication of the engine is maintained by a rotor- cored openings in the block.
type oil pump mounted at the base of the engine
block. The oil pump is driven from the camshaft and COOLING SYSTEM
draws oil from the engine sump through a wire mesh
A belt-driven centrifugal water pump circulates cool-
screen.
ant via the internal water passages. The coolant is
A spring-loaded relief valve in the pump body limits radiator-cooled and temperature controlled by a con-
the pressure in the system by directing excess oil ventional thermostat.
back to the intake side of the pump.
Oil passes from the pump to an external, throw-away, AIR INTAKE AND EXHAUST SYSTEM
spin on type filter incorporating a relief valve which
The air intake manifold is located on the left side of
permits oil to be bypassed if filter blockage occurs;
the engine. Its unique design provides accurate
therefore ensuring engine lubrication at all times.
alignment with the cylinder head ports, resulting in
Oil flows from the filter to the main oil gallery which maximum engine performance. The exhaust mani-
runs the length of the cylinder block and intersects fold, located on the right side of the engine, houses
the camshaft follower chambers. the turbocharger and muffler system.
The main gallery also supplies oil to the crankshaft
main bearings and to the connecting rod journals via FUEL SYSTEM
drillings in the crankshaft. Drilled passages from
A flange-mounted, Lucas CAV DP200 Series (em-
each main bearing direct oil to the camshaft bear-
missionized) fuel injection pump is mounted to the
ings.
cylinder block front thrust plate. The pump is oper-
The camshaft drive gear bushing is pressure lubri- ated by three helical gears; the crankshaft gear, idler
cated through a drilled passage from the front main gear, and the injection pump drive gear.
bearing. The gear has small oil passages machined
on both sides which allow the oil to escape.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 7
Model SL65B
Thermostat
Opening Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76°C (168°F)
Recommended Engine Fluids
Lubricating Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SAE 10W - 30 API SH/CG4
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Use clean, quality No. 1-D or No. 2-D fuel (ASTM D975).
Use No. 1-D if the ambient temperature is expected to be less
than 4°C (40°F) or if the loader is to be used at an altitude
exceeding 1524 m (5000′).
The sulfur content of the fuel should be no more than 0.5%.
The sediment and water content should not exceed 0.5%.
To prevent fuel flow problems in cold weather, use No. 1 - 2 diesel
fuel with a pour point of at least 10°F below the expected ambient
temperature.
Minimum cetane number is 40. Lower temperature or high
altitude operation may require the use of fuel with a higher cetane
number.
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . Clean soft water. Maximum antifreeze concentration 50% with 5% corrosion inhibitor
10 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
TROUBLESHOOTING - SL65B
ENGINE SYSTEM
PROBLEM POSSIBLE CAUSES CORRECTION
Engine will crank but does not Faulty key switch Correct the connection and/or
start replace switch
Blown 5-amp electronic ignition Replace fuse
fuse (cab fuse panel)
Fuel solenoid not operating Check solenoid for battery voltage
and correct
Insufficient charging or complete Charge or replace battery
discharging of the battery
Lack of fuel Supply fuel
Air mixed in the fuel system Bleed the air
Clogged fuel filter Replace
Irregular and faulty fuel supply Repair in an authorized service
(injection pump trouble) shop
Improper viscosity of the Inspect and replace
lubricating oil
Clogged air cleaner Clean or replace
No compression Overhaul engine
Engine will not crank or start Seat belt not fastened Buckle seat belt
Faulty key switch Correct the connection or replace
the switch
Insufficient charging or complete Charge or replace battery
discharging of the battery
Blown 5-amp electronic battery Replace fuse
fuse (engine fuse panel)
Blown 15-amp key main fuse Replace fuse
(engine fuse panel)
Engine runs erratically Air mixed in the fuel system Bleed the air from the system
Uneven fuel injection (faulty fuel Repair at authorized shop
injection pump)
Clogged fuel filter Replace
Defective governor Check and correct
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 11
Engine overheats Lack of cooling water Supply water, inspect for leakage
and correct
Loose or slipping fan belt Remove oil, dust, etc. and tighten
Exhaust (white or blue) Excess engine oil Inspect and correct the level
smoke
Engine oil viscosity too low Inspect and replace the oil to
correct one
Faulty injection timing Too late: correct
Engine knocks Diluted or thin oil Drain and refill with specified oil
and replace filter. Determine
cause of dilution
Insufficient oil supply Check oil level and replenish as
necessary. Overhaul or replace
pump as necessary. Check that
oil pump filter is not clogged
Low engine oil pressure Overhaul pump or relief valve as
necessary
Excessive crankshaft end play Install new thrust bearing liner
Excessive flywheel or ring gear Skim flywheel or fit new ring gear
run-out
Excessive connecting rod or main Install new bearing inserts
bearing clearance
Bent or twisted connecting rods Replace connecting rods
Crankshaft journals out-of-round Grind crankshaft and fit undersize
bearing inserts
Excessive piston-to-cylinder bore Bore engine block and fit new
clearance pistons
Excessive piston ring clearance Fit new piston rings
Broken rings Fit new rings. Check bores and
pistons for damage
Excessive piston pin clearance Fit new piston pin and bushing
Piston pin retainer loose or Install new retainer. Check bore
missing and pistons for damage
Install new thrust plate
Excessive camshaft end play
Replace timing gear
Imperfections on timing gear teeth
Replace timing gear
Excessive timing gear backlash
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 13
White exhaust smoke Oil return pipe is clogged or Repair or replace the pipe
distorted, causing the lube oil to
leak into turbine and blower
Seal rings are abnormally worn or Disassemble and repair
broken due to worn-down bearings
Engine lacks output power Gas leakage in the exhaust line Check and repair
Air leakage in the blower outlet Check and repair
side, resulting in reduced boost
pressure
Clean or replace
A clogged element in the air
cleaner Disassemble and repair or
replace damaged parts
The turbocharger is internally
fouled with foreign matter or its
running parts are damaged
Abnormal running noise Disassemble and clean
Restrictions in exhaust gas
passage, particularly due to the
nozzle ring approaching a clogged
condition Disassemble and clean
Restrictions in the air outlet side of
the blower, causing the air to
surge at blower wheel when the
engine accelerates Disassemble and repair or
replace damaged parts
The casing is being rubbed by
turbine wheel or blower wheel
Repeated turbocharger Refer to “Important” decal to right
bearing failure of ignition switch
Improper operation
Change operating practices or
adjust engine idle RPM
Frequent stalling
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 15
Pinion fails to advance Wiring Open circuit, battery and Repair or replace
when key switch is switch terminal connec-
closed tions
Open circuit, fuse Replace fuse
Key switch No contact Repair or replace
Starter motor Sleeve bearing burnt out Repair or replace
Lever spring or shaft lever Replace
broken
Magnetic switch Magnetic switch plunger Repair or replace
movement defective or coil
open or shorted.
Motor rotates before Starting motor Lever spring weak, shift Replace
pinion meshes with lever damaged
ring gear
Slip ring defective Replace
Pinion teeth worn Replace
Pinion push out position Replace
defective
Engine Ring gear worn Replace
Starter solenoid Starter solenoid defective Replace
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 17
FAULT POSSIBLE
PROBLEM LOCATION CAUSES CORRECTION
Pinion meshes with Battery In discharged state Recharge or replace
ring gear but starting
motor fails to turn Wiring Line connecting starter Repair or replace
solenoid switch to battery
broken or defective ground.
Lead wire connecting starter Repair or replace
solenoid to motor tightened
improperly.
Starting motor Ball bearing locked Replace
Installation defective Reinstall
Brush worn Replace
Brush spring defective Replace
Commutator dirty Clean
Armature or field coil Repair or replace
defective
Field coil to brush Repair
connection defective
Starter solenoid Contact not touching Replace
properly
Contact contacting surface Replace
roughened
FAULT POSSIBLE
PROBLEM LOCATION CAUSES CORRECTION
Insufficient charging Wiring Loose connection or short Repair
circuit
Alternator Loose drive belt Repair
Short in rotor coil Replace
Short in stator coil Replace
Defective rectifier Replace
Insufficient brush contact Repair or replace
Regulator Defective regulator Replace
Loose connection at Repair
alternator and regulator
SPECIFICATIONS
SERVICE STANDARDS - SL65B
CYLINDER BLOCK
VALVE SPRINGS
VALVE TIMING
Number of Teeth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
End Play . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.28 mm (0.001″ - 0.011″)
Bushing Inside Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50.813 - 50.838 mm (2.005″ - 2.0015″)
Adapter Outside Diameter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50.762 - 50.775 mm (1.9985″ - 1.9990″)
Backlash with Crankshaft Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.23 mm (0.001″ - 0.009″)
Backlash with Camshaft Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.23 mm (0.001″ - 0.009″)
Backlash with Fuel Injection Pump Drive Gear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.025 - 0.30 mm (0.001″ - 0.012″)
CAMSHAFT GEAR
Number of Teeth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Timing Gear Backlash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.08 - 0.20 mm (0.003″ - 0.008″)
ROCKER ARM SHAFT
PISTON PIN
Type
Top Compression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Keystone Tapered Sides-Barrel Faced
Second Compression . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lower Side Internal Chamfer-Tapered Face
Oil Control Ring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Slotted with Expander Ring
Side Face Clearance to Ring Groove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.075 - 0.125 mm (0.00295″ - 0.00485″)
Ring Gap Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.40 - 0.90 mm (0.016″ - 0.036″)
CRANKSHAFT
Number of Teeth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
MAIN BEARING
When grinding a crankshaft, the main and crankpin journal diameters should be reduced the same amount as
the undersize bearings used. The following dimensions apply. The rear end of the crankshaft should be located
on the 60° chamfer of the pilot bearing bore.
Undersize Bearing
When using diesel fuel with sulphur content between 1.0% and 1.3% use only oils listed above but reduce the
oil and filter change period to every 25 hours.
Use of diesel fuel with a sulphur content above 1.3% is not recommended.
THERMOSTAT
WATER PUMP
Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Centrifugal
Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . V-belt
Drive Belt Deflection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 mm (0.375″) midway between pulleys
with a force of 1 kg (2 lbs.) applied
COOLING FLUID
Use an antifreeze that meets ESE-M97B - 18C/D or SSM - 97B - 9101A specifications. Mix with an equal amount
of clean water. Add Inhibitor, FW - 15, to the mixture to yield a 5% concentration.
FUEL INJECTOR SPECIFICATIONS
NOMINAL UNPLATED PLATED UNPLATED PLATED UNPLATED PLATED GR.B GR.C NOMINAL
SIZE or W/ZnCr or W/ZnCr or W/ZnCr w/GR5 w/GR8 SIZE
PLATED PLATED PLATED BOLT BOLT
SILVER GOLD SILVER GOLD SILVER GOLD
1/4 55* (6.2) 72* (8.1) 86* (9.7) 112* (13) 121* (14) 157* (18) 61* (6.9) 86* (9.8) 1/4
5/16 115* (13) 149* (17) 178* (20) 229* (26) 250* (28) 324* (37) 125* (14) 176* (20) 5/16
3/8 17 (23) 22 (30) 26 (35) 34 (46) 37 (50) 48 (65) 19 (26) 26 (35) 3/8
7/16 27 (37) 35 (47) 42 (57) 54 (73) 59 (80) 77 (104) 30 (41) 42 (57) 7/16
1/2 42 (57) 54 (73) 64 (87) 83 (113) 91 (123) 117 (159) 45 (61) 64 (88) 1/2
9/16 60 (81) 77 (104) 92 (125) 120 (163) 130 (176) 169 (229) 65 (88) 92 (125) 9/16
5/8 83 (112) 107 (145) 128 (174) 165 (224) 180 (244) 233 (316) 90 (122) 127 (172) 5/8
3/4 146 (198) 189 (256) 226 (306) 293 (397) 319 (432) 413 (560) 160 (217) 226 (306) 3/4
7/8 142 (193) 183 (248) 365 (495) 473 (641) 515 (698) 667 (904) 258 (350) 364 (494) 7/8
1 213 (289) 275 (373) 547 (742) 708 (960) 773 (1048) 1000 (1356) 386 (523) 545 (739) 1
LOCKNUTS
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
N·m kgm ft. lbs.
Main Bearing Bolts 163 14 120
Connecting Rod Nuts 85 9 63
Cylinder Head Bolts (with Engine Cold) 150 15 110
Intake Manifold-to-Cylinder Head 35 4 26
Exhaust Manifold-to-Cylinder Head 38 4 28
Exhaust Pipe-to-Flange 31 4 23
Flywheel-to-Crankshaft 217 22 160
Oil Pan Drain Plug 41 4 30
Valve Rocker Cover Bolts 18 2 13
Crankshaft Pulley-to-Crankshaft 224 23 165
Self-Locking Screw-Valve Rocker Arm 24 3 18
Injector Attachment Bolts 23 2 17
Oil Pump-to-Block 49 5 36
Water Pump-to-Cylinder Block 35 4 26
Water Pump Cover-to-Pump 27 3 20
Oil Pan-to-Cylinder Block (Stamped) 30 3 22
Injector Line Nuts 27 3 20
Leak-off Tube Banjo Fitting Bolts 8 1 6
Injection Pump-to-Front Adapter Plate 24 3 18
Camshaft Drive Gear-to-Block 140 14 103
Front Adapter Plate-to-Cylinder Block 19 2 14
Front Cover-to-Front Adapter Plate 22 2 16
Camshaft Gear Bolts 58 6 43
Oil Filter Retaining Bolts 65 7 48
Oil Filter Mounting Bolt Insert 34 4 25
Starting Motor-to-Rear Adapter Plate 31 3 23
Governor Drive Gear Nut 122 13 90
Oil Pump Gear Stop 95 10 70
Oil Pressure Switch Assembly 31 3 23
Turbocharger-to-Exhaust Manifold 44 5 33
Fan-to-Pulley Bolts 22 2 16
28 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
DK GN/O
W D– B+
2 3
L B K D/ R
L B K D/ Y
R/ UP
B/ Y
B
4 T PU/O B
DK GN/O
13 LT BL/W
B R
5
PU/LT GN
B/Y
B/ L B TL
B
1
B B
6
EM1 12
B B
2
PU/O PK
3 M
LT BL/W
10 11
LT BL/O B B/Y
R 7
9 M
L B K D/ R
B
R/ W
B
B
B
R/DK BL
R
W/R
B 8
BSC0931A
5
ENGINE ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS - SL65B
1. Hydraulic Oil Filter Switch 8. Chassis ground
2. Engine Oil Pressure Switch 9. Starter
3. Alternator 10. Cold Advance Unit
4. Cold Start Advance switch 11. Fuel Solenoid
5. Engine Coolant Temperature Sender 12. Fuel Pump
6. Heater Plug 13. Battery
7. Air Filter Vacuum Switch
30 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 001 10
7
9. Disconnect the air hoses, 1 and 2. Remove sup-
port rod hardware at 3. Remove air cleaner can-
ister support hardware at 4. 2
3
19984625
8
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 31
9
12. Loosen clamps, 1, and remove the fuel tank filler
neck, 2.
2
10
13. Remove the rear door latch bracket, 1, by remov-
ing the two capscrews, 2.
1
19984501
11
32 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
19984502
12
15. Disconnect the engine main harness connector,
1. Remove ground strap, 2.
1
13
16. Disconnect throttle cable, 1.
19995957
14
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 33
1
2
19995956
15
18. Remove the fan from the water pump shaft to
prevent damage during the removal process.
19. Remove the hydrostatic pumps from the trans- 1
mission gearbox. Refer to Section 5 for the hy-
drostatic pump removal procedure.
20. Remove ground wire connections, 1, and wire
harness clamps, 2, from the transmission gear- 2
box.
16
21. Attach a chain or cable to the engine lift eyes at
1, and hook to a suitable lifting device to support 1
the engine.
17
34 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
18
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 35
Removal
NOTE: The cylinder head can be removed with the
engine installed in the machine.
1. Disconnect the battery.
2
2. Remove the hood and side panel assemblies.
1
3. Drain the radiator and cylinder block. Remove
the upper radiator hose.
4. Remove the air cleaner and bracket assembly, 1,
disconnecting the outlet hose at the turbo-
charger, 2, and the air cleaner restriction indica- 3
tor switch electrical connections. Remove the
hose from the turbocharger outlet to the inlet to 4
the intake manifold, 3. 5
5. Disconnect and remove the valve rocker cover
ventilation tube, 4.
6. Remove the muffler, 5.
19
7. Remove the alternator, 1, and oil pressure
sender switch electrical connection, 2.
20
8. Remove the turbocharger oil supply and return
lines, 1. Remove the turbocharger, 2.
2
9. Remove the exhaust manifold, 3, and gasket.
1
3
21
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 37
22
13. Remove the injector lines, 1, from the injection
pump and the injectors. Remove the fuel leakoff
line from the injection pump, 2. Cap all openings 2
to prevent dirt entry.
14. Disconnect the fuel and electrical connections at
the intake manifold heater located at the inlet to
the manifold.
15. Disconnect and plug the heater hoses.
16. Remove the retaining bolts and lock washers.
Remove the intake manifold and gasket.
17. Remove the rocker arm cover from the engine. 1
19995958
23
38 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
3 2
25
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 39
Op. 10 121 21
Cylinder Head
2. Clean the head and remove carbon deposits
from around the valve heads.
3. Using a valve spring compressor, 1, remove the
retainer locks, 2; spring retainers/ rotators;
springs, 3; and seals from each valve.
4. Withdraw the valves and place in a numbered
rack together with the valve rotators.
26
9 10
8
7
1
2
3
27
1. Intake valve spring retainer lock 6. Exhaust valve
2. Intake valve spring retainer 7. Exhaust valve spring
3. Intake valve seal 8. Exhaust valve seal
4. Intake valve spring 9. Exhaust valve spring retainer
5. Intake valve 10. Exhaust valve spring retainer locks
40 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 106 20
28
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
Op. 10 101 21
Cylinder Head
1. Scrape all gasket surfaces clean, then wash the
cylinder head in a suitable solvent and thorough-
ly dry with a lint-free cloth or compressed air.
2. Inspect the cylinder head for damage and, if
necessary, remove nicks and burrs from the
gasket faces using a suitable abrasive. Ensure
all traces of abrasive material are removed after
repair.
29
3. Use a straightedge, 1, to check the flatness of the
cylinder head in all directions. Resurface or re-
place if found warped beyond 0.08 mm (0.003
in.) in any area.
4. After skimming the head, check whether any cyl-
inder head bolts are bottoming by mounting the
cylinder head on the block without a gasket and
without any of the pistons at T.D.C. Install all the
bolts finger tight and ensure the rocker shaft sup-
ports and flat washers are fitted with the long
bolts. If a 0.25 mm (0.010″) feeler gauge can be
inserted under the bolt head, then the bolts are
bottoming and the cylinder block thread must be
increased in depth. Use a 1/2″ x 13 UNC - 2A
thread tap.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 41
Op. 10 101 55
Valve Seats
5. Examine the valve seat inserts and reface if pitted.
Replace damaged inserts. If necessary, install an
oversize insert by machining the seat counterbore
in the cylinder head. Inserts are available in 0.254
mm (0.010 in.), 0.508 mm (0.020 in.) and 0.762
mm (0.030 in.) oversize. The insert must be
chilled in dry ice prior to installation.
NOTE: Valve seat inserts of 0.25 mm (0.010″) and
0.5 mm (0.020″) oversize on diameter are some-
times installed in cylinder heads in production.
Heads fitted with oversize inserts are stamped S010
or S020 on the exhaust manifold side in line with the 30
valve seat concerned.
When replacing exhaust valve seat inserts, en-
sure the replacement inserts are of the correct
type as the size and material specification varies
for the different engine types.
6. Check the width of the valve seat inserts and, if
necessary, reface by grinding to the dimensions
shown.
Valve Seat Angle: 45.0° - 45.3° for exhaust valve
seats. Intake valve seat to be 30.0° - 30.3°
Valve Seat Width: Intake 2.032 - 2.590 mm
(0.080″ - 0.102″) Exhaust 2.133 - 2.692 mm
(0.084″ - 0.106″)
NOTE: Refacing of the valve seat should always be
coordinated with refacing of the valve to ensure a
compression tight fit.
Op. 10 101 32
Valves
7. Examine the valve face and, if pitted, replace or
reface by grinding to the dimension shown. Be-
fore refacing the valve, ensure the valve stem is
not bent or worn and check that the valve seat
runout, measured at right angles to the seat,
does not exceed a total of 0.038 mm (0.0015″).
1 Exhaust valves
2 Intake valves
3 Dimension after Refacing:
1.58 mm (0.062″) Minimum
4 Dimension after Refacing:
31
0.79 mm (0.031″) minimum
IMPORTANT: The finished valve seat should contact
the center of the valve face. Using the refaced or new
valve, check the seat using Prussian blue. Rotate the
valve with a light pressure. If the blue is transferred
to the middle of the valve face, the contact is correct.
42 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Valve Guides
8. Using a telescopic gauge, 1, and micrometer,
measure the valve-to-guide clearance. If the in-
take side clearance exceeds 0.069 mm (0.0027
in.) or the exhaust side clearance exceeds 0.094
mm (0.0037 in.), ream the valve guide, 2, to fit the
next oversize valve.
NOTE: Production cylinder heads may have one or
more 0.38 mm (0.015) oversize valve guides and
valves installed. Such cylinder heads have 15 or
V015/OS stamped on the exhaust manifold side of
the head opposite the valve(s) concerned.
9. Use Kit No. FNH02136 to ream out the valve
guide to accept an oversize valve. The kit con- 32
tains three reamer and pilot combinations as fol-
lows:
0.076 mm (0.003″) Oversize Reamer and Stan-
dard Diameter Pilot
0.38 mm (0.015″) Oversize Reamer and 0.076
mm (0.003″) Oversize Pilot
0.76 mm (0.030″) Oversize Reamer and 0.38
mm (0.015″) Oversize Pilot
When going from a standard valve stem to an
oversize, always use the reamers in sequence.
After reaming a valve guide, always check the
valve seating and reface if necessary.
Valve Springs
10. Replace worn or damaged valve springs. Check
for squareness and reject if out-of-squareness,
1, exceeds 1.5 mm (0.06″).
11. Place the valve springs on a flat surface.
Measure the free-length of the spring. Replace
the spring if less than 54.6 mm (2.15 in.).
12. Place the springs in a suitable spring load tester
and measure the spring load rating. Replace
springs that do not meet the following specifica-
tions.
Load at 1.74 in. length (44.2 mm) 27.7 - 31.3 kg
(61 - 69 lbs).
33
Load at 1.32 in. length (33.53 mm) 57.8 - 63.1 kg
(125 - 139 lbs).
13. Check that the valve spring retainer locks are in
good condition and the exhaust valve rotators
are not binding or worn.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 43
REASSEMBLY
CYLINDER HEAD
1. Insert each valve in the guide bore from which it
was removed and lap in position to ensure an
even seat around the valve. Withdraw the valve
and ensure removal of all traces of lapping com-
pound.
2. Use a valve spring compressor to reassemble
the valves, valve springs, retainers, and retainer
locks. For the exhaust valves install a new seal-
ing ring in the second groove from the top of the
valve stem.
NOTE: Turbocharged engines have no seals fitted to
the intake valves.
Thermostat
3. Install the thermostat (spring end toward the
head), coolant outlet, and a new gasket.
Rocker Shaft Assembly
4. Coat all components with engine oil and position 1
the notch, 1, on the front of the rocker shaft up-
wards to correctly locate the oil holes.
INSTALLATION
Installation of the cylinder head and related compo-
nents follows the removal procedure in reverse. On
installation observe the following requirements:
Install new cylinder head, intake, and exhaust mani-
fold gaskets.
Ensure washers are installed under the heads of the
cylinder head retaining bolts. Tighten the cylinder
head bolts in the sequence shown and progressively
in three steps as follows:
1) Torque to 122 N·m (90 ft. lbs.).
2) Torque to 135 N·m (100 ft. lbs.).
3) Torque to 149 N·m (110 ft. lbs.). 35
NOTE: The cylinder head bolts should be torqued
only when the engine is cold.
Rotate the engine and set the valve lash on the ex-
haust side to 0.43 - 0.53 mm (0.017 - 0.021 in.), and 1
on the intake side to 0.36 - 0.46 mm (0.014 - 0.018
in. ), using the adjuster screw, 1, and a feeler gauge,
2.
Install the injectors with new seat washers and cork
seals. Tighten the attaching bolts to 23 N⋅m (17 ft.
lbs.).
Install the injector lines and leak-off pipe with new 2
washers. Tighten the lines to 27 N⋅m (20 ft. lbs.).
Tighten the leak-off pipe to 8 N⋅m (6 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: Hold the leak-off plastic tube securely to pre-
vent pivoting when tightening the banjo fitting bolts to
the correct torque. See “Specifications Service Stan- 36
dards” in this section.
Use new lock tabs for the exhaust manifold retaining
bolts and bend the tabs to effect retention. Tighten
the attaching bolts to 38 N⋅m (28 ft. lbs.).
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 45
Op. 10 105 10
Removal
NOTE: The connecting rods and pistons can only be
removed after prior removal of the engine cylinder
head, oil pan and oil pump assembly as described in
this section.
1. If necessary, remove any ridge from the top of the
cylinder bores with a cylinder ridge, 1, reamer or
hand scraper. Do not cut down into the piston ring
travel area. 37
2. With the piston at the bottom of its stroke, remove
the nuts from the bearing cap bolts and remove
the bearing cap, 2, and liner, 1.
3. Use the handle end of a hammer to push the pis-
ton and rod assembly out of the top of the block.
Remove the bearing liner from the connecting
rod.
4. Turn the crankshaft to bring each piston to the
bottom of its stroke and repeat this procedure.
Keep the bearing caps and liners with their re-
spective connecting rods.
38
Op. 10 105 22
Disassembly
1. Remove the piston pin retainer (snap ring) from
each side of the piston and remove the pin.
2. Use an expander to remove the piston rings.
39
46 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
40
Inspection And Wear
1. Wash the piston and connecting rod assembly in
a suitable solvent and dry with a clean lint-free
cloth or compressed air.
2. Inspect the piston ring lands, skirts, and pin
bosses for damage. Check for separation of the
top ring insert from the piston.
3. Clean the ring grooves and using a new ring, 1,
and feeler gauge, 2, check the piston ring lands
for wear. Replace rings if the clearance is not
within 0.075 - 0.125 mm (0.00295 - 0.00485 in.).
41
4. Check the connecting rod components for dam-
age and place each connecting rod, 2, in an 1
alignment fixture to check for distortion. Replace 3
if distorted beyond the following: Max. twist –
0.30 mm (0.012 in.), Max. bend – 0.10 mm (0.004
in.)
5. Measure the outside diameter of the piston pin
and the inside diameter of the connecting rod
bushing. If the clearance is not within 0.013 -
0.018 mm (0.0005 - 0.0007 in.), press out the
connecting rod bushing and install a new bushing
using a press, 1, and a suitable adapter, 3.
2
42
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 47
11. If the cylinders are outside specification or the Bores to take 0.10 mm (0.004″) oversize pistons
walls are damaged, the cylinders should be need only be honed. All honing should be done
honed or bored to fit the next oversize pistons. with a rigid hone having a grit size of 150 - 220.
The finished bore size can be determined by After reboring and honing, thoroughly wash and
measuring the piston diameter at right angles to dry the cylinder block and coat the walls with en-
the piston pin and adding the appropriate piston- gine oil.
to-bore clearance. See “Specifications Service 12. For cylinders with severely damaged walls or to
Standards” in this section. Always bore the cylin- which maximum oversize pistons have already
der with the most wear first to determine the over- been installed, cylinder liners are available for
size pistons required. Oversize pistons are avail- sleeving the bore. A lipped, thin wall sleeve is
able as follows: used in engines with a 111.8 mm (4.4″) bore.
0.10 mm (0.004″)
0.51 mm (0.020″)
0.76 mm (0.030″)
1.0 mm (0.040″)
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 49
REASSEMBLY
NOTE: Prior to reassembly, check the cylinder bores
for taper and out-of-round as previously described in
this section.
1. Prior to reassembly, check the piston-to-bore
clearance as follows:
Measure the cylinder bore diameter in a cros-
swise direction, then measure the piston diam-
eter at right angles to the piston pin.
Subtract the piston diameter from the bore diam-
eter and the resultant figure should be within the
0.162 - 0.196 mm (0.0064 - 0.0072 in.).
NOTE: Pistons are available in both standard and
oversizes. New pistons should be installed if the
clearance exceeds the specified limits.
If the clearance is greater than specified, try a
similar new piston. If the clearance still exceeds
the specified limit, measure the other cylinder
bores and pistons and determine the cylinder
with the greatest clearance. Based on the
greatest clearance, rebore the cylinders to take
the next oversize piston as previously described
in this section.
If the clearance is less than specified, hone the
bore to obtain the desired clearance as previous-
ly described in this section.
2. Lubricate all components with engine oil, then
assemble the piston to the connecting rod with
the notch, 1, on the piston crown aligned with the
pip, 2, on the connecting rod and install the piston
pin and retainers (snap rings).
47
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 51
INSTALLATION
NOTE: Before installing a piston and new rings into
a used cylinder bore, remove the high polish on the
cylinder wall by passing a hone lightly through the
cylinder or by making a figure-eight pattern with very
fine emery cloth dipped in a mixture of fuel and lubri-
cating oil. After honing, thoroughly wash and dry the
bores and coat the walls with oil.
1. Select the correct bearing liners, as described
later in this section, and install in the connecting
rod and cap. Ensure the bearing liner tang lo-
cates in the slots of the rod and cap.
2. Turn the crankshaft to position the No. 1 crankpin
at the bottom of the stroke. Oil the pistons, rings, 49
cylinder bore, and bearing liners. Use a com-
pressor, 2, to install the piston into the cylinder.
Ensure the notch on the top of the piston is to-
ward the front of the engine.
3. Using a hammer handle, 1, push the piston into
the bore until the connecting rod bearing liner
seats on the crankpin. Install the connecting rod
bearing cap with the number on the cap on the
same side as the number on the rod. Install new
nuts and tighten to 55 N⋅m (63 ft. lbs.).
4. Use feeler gauges to check the side clearance of
each connecting rod. Replace or repair if not
within 0.18 - 0.33 mm (0.007 - 0.013 in.).
5. Install the remaining piston and rod assemblies
in the same manner.
6. Install the oil pump, oil pan sump, and cylinder
head as previously described in this section.
7. Fill the engine with the correct grade and quantity
of oil and the radiator with coolant. See “Specifi-
cations Service Standards” in this section.
8. Start the engine and check for leaks.
50
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 53
Op. 10 103 10
Removal
1. Remove the oil pan, the oil pump and intermedi-
ate shaft as described earlier in this section.
2. Remove the main bearing cap from the journal to 1
which the new bearing liners are to be installed. 2
Always install one set of bearings at a time, leav-
ing the other main bearing caps securely in
place.
3. Install a bearing liner removal tool in the crank-
51
shaft journal oil passage. Slowly turn the crank-
shaft counterclockwise until the tool forces the
bearing out of the cylinder block.
NOTE: If a bearing liner removal tool, 2, is not avail-
able, a suitable tool may be fabricated from a 1 (25
mm) x 1/8 (3 mm) split pin as shown. The shorter pin
is used to remove the thrust bearing insert, 1.
Flatten and bend the head to 30° to conform to
the angle of the oil passage in the crankshaft.
Inspection And Repair
1. Thoroughly clean the bearing liners, journals,
and caps.
2. Bearing liners with scored, chipped or worn sur-
faces must be replaced. If new liners are to be in-
stalled, check the clearances as described later
in this procedure.
54 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
2. Standard size liners are color coded red or blue dersize bearings. See “Specifications Service
and are available in a copper lead or aluminum Standards” in this section.
tin alloy. See “Specifications Service Standards” 3. Position the bearing liners in the block and caps
in this section. and coat with oil. If the crankshaft has been refin-
IMPORTANT: The engine may be assembled with ished, fit the correct undersize main bearing
liners of different material, but liners of the same ma- liners. Ensure the bearing surfaces are clean and
terial must be installed on the same journal. the bearing liner tangs align with the slots in the
The red liners have a thinner wall section than the block and cap.
blue liners and provide greater clearance. A com- 4. Align the timing mark on the crankshaft gear with
bination of red and blue liners may be required to that of the camshaft drive gear and install the
obtain the desired clearance. If the clearance is crankshaft and all bearing caps except for the
greater than specified when two blue liners are rear main bearing. Install the thrust bearing cap
used, a 0.05 mm (0.002″) undersize liner with with the bolts finger tight. Pry the crankshaft for-
either red, blue or another 0.05 mm (0.002″) un- ward and the thrust bearing cap rearward to align
dersize liner should be installed. If any of these the thrust surfaces and tighten the bolts to the
combinations of liners do not produce the speci- specified torque, keeping the bearing cap in the
fied clearance, refinish the crankshaft and fit un- correct position.
58 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
54
6. Wipe the mating surfaces of the block and rear
main bearing cap, 1, and apply a light coat of 1
sealing compound, 2, to both surfaces. Install
new side seals in the rear main bearing cap to
project slightly beyond the block face of the cap
and assemble the cap to the block. Tighten the
bearing cap bolts and cut the side seals to allow
a projection of 0.4 mm (0.016″) above the sump
pan flange.
55
7. Apply a light coating of high-temperature grease
to the rear oil seal bore, seal and journal. Use
Tool No. FNH01301 and three flywheel retaining
bolts to install the seal. Tighten the three bolts
evenly and in sequence.
56
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 59
Installation
1. Installation of the components to effect complete
reassembly of the engine follows the removal
procedure in reverse.
CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEAR TRAIN
CAMSHAFT
Op. 10 106 40
Removal
NOTE: The camshaft bearings and/or tappets can
only be serviced with the engine removed from the
skid steer and mounted on an engine stand. See en-
gine removal and engine mounting procedures in this
section.
1. Remove the engine front cover and cylinder
head.
2. Remove the oil pump drive gear and shaft.
3. Check the camshaft end play as described later
in this section. If the clearance exceeds the
specified limit, see “Specifications Service Stan-
dards” in this section. Install a new thrust plate
during reassembly.
4. Invert the engine on the stand and remove the oil
pan if the camshaft bearings and/or the tappets
are to be removed.
60 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Camshaft Bearings
1. Inspect the camshaft bearings for pitting or scor-
ing. Measure the clearance between the internal
diameter of the bearings and the outside diam-
eter of the respective camshaft journals.
If the clearance exceeds the specified limit, see
“Specifications Service Standards” in this sec-
tion, remove and install new bearings, 1, using
Remover/Replacer Tool No. FNH01255, 3, and
Handle, Tool No. FNH 01442, 4.
2. Camshaft Bearing Removal:
Position Tool No. FNH01255 against the cam-
shaft bearing to be removed and attach handle
Tool No. FNH01442. Drive the camshaft bearing 59
from the bearing bore.
3. Camshaft Bearing Installation:
Align the oil holes of the new camshaft bearing
with the oil holes in the engine block, 2, then drive
the new bearing into place using Tool No.
FNH01255 and Handle, Tool No. FNH01442.
NOTE: A positive alignment check can only be made
with the crankshaft removed, when a 4.6 mm (0.18)
diameter rod may be passed down the oil passage
from the crankshaft main bearing. The liner is cor-
rectly positioned when the end of the rod passes
through the oil hole in the liner.
Installation
Installation of the camshaft follows the removal pro-
cedure in reverse. On installation, observe the fol-
lowing requirements:
Apply petroleum jelly to each tappet foot and coat the
tappet body with oil. Install the tappets in the bores
from which they were removed.
Oil the camshaft journals and apply petroleum jelly to
the cam lobes before carefully installing the camshaft
into the engine.
Install the spacer and a new key on the front of the
camshaft.
Align the camshaft drive gear timing mark and re-
check the camshaft end play.
62 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
TIMING GEAR
Op. 10 106
Removal
NOTE: The engine front cover and timing gears can
only be serviced after removing the radiator and oil
cooler assembly. See “Engine Removal” procedure
in this section.
1. Drain the engine oil and remove the oil pan.
2. If the fuel pump will not be removed, rotate the
engine in the normal direction of rotation to 29°
BTDC compression stroke. Lock the pump lock-
60
ing tag using the bolt to 13 N⋅m (9.6 ft. lbs.). Lock-
ing tab location “1” is unlocked, and location “2”
is locked.
NOTE: If the fuel pump will be disassembled, fuel
pump timing adjustment will be necessary.
3. Remove the fan drive belt and withdraw the bolt
and washer from the center of the crankshaft
pulley.
Op. 10 106 66
4. Using Puller No. FNH09539, 3, and Shaft Protec-
tor No. FNH09212, 1, remove crankshaft pulley,
4.
5. Withdraw the retaining bolts, then remove the
front cover and gasket. Remove the oil slinger.
61
6. Before removing the timing gears, measure the
backlash between each set of mating gears.
Op. 10 106 60
1 Camshaft gear
Op. 10 106 68
2 Crankshaft gear
3 Camshaft drive gear
4 Injection pump drive gear
62
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 63
63
7. Pry the camshaft gear, 3, away from the thrust
plate, 4, using a pry bar, 1. Use a dial indicator or
feeler gauges, 2, to measure the clearance. Re-
place the gears if the camshaft end play exceeds
the specified limits, see “Specifications Service
Standards” in this section.
64
8. Remove the fuel injection pump drive gear, cam-
shaft drive gear and adapter, and the camshaft 1
gear. Use Tool No. FNH02134, puller, with
FNH01237, adapter, 1, to remove the crankshaft
gear.
NOTE: The crankshaft gear should only be removed
if it shows signs of wear.
65
64 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
67
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 65
68
NOTE: All engines with a rotary (distributor) type fuel
injection pump have a common fuel injection pump 1
drive gear. This gear features two timing marks
identified by numerals 3 and 4 for 3- and 4-cylinder
engines, respectively. When installing the pump
drive gear, 1, ensure the 3-cylinder timing mark 4
aligns with the camshaft drive gear, 2, timing mark.
5. Install a new dust seal in the front cover. Lubri-
cate the oil seal with petroleum jelly and use a 3
Tool FNH09210 adapter to press the seal into the
front cover.
6. Locate the oil slinger onto the crankshaft with the 2
dished face outward.
7. Position a new gasket on the engine front plate 69
and install the front cover ensuring the cover
aligns with the dowel pins. Tighten the bolts to the
specified torque.
8. Lubricate the crankshaft pulley spacer and slide
over the key. Replace the pulley hub and tap onto
the crankshaft. Tighten the securing bolt to the
specified torque. See “Specifications Service
Standards” in this section.
9. Install the oil pan with a new gasket and tighten
the bolts to the specified torque. See “Specifica-
tions Service Standards” in this section.
10. Refill the engine with the correct grade and quan-
tity of oil. See “Specifications Service Standards”
in this section.
66 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
ENGINE TIMING
1. Remove the rocker cover and observe the valves 1
and rocker arms of the No. 1 cylinder while rotat-
ing the engine. Rotate the engine until the ex-
haust valve moves fully open then begins to
close.
70
When the exhaust valve is nearly closed, the in-
take valve begins to open. This is Top Dead
Center (TDC) for the exhaust stroke.
NOTE: If the tappets are set to the proper specifica-
tions, the intake valve opens at 12 before TDC and
the exhaust valve closes at 12 after TDC. This is re-
ferred to as “valve overlap.”
19993686
71
2. Mark the flywheel or pulley with chalk and con-
tinue to rotate the engine clockwise. Rotate one
full turn (360°) minus 29° of advance (331° total).
This position is the No. 1 piston to nearly TDC on
the compression stroke.
19993687
72
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 67
19992950
73
4. Use a suitable valve spring compressor to re-
move the valve keepers from either thr intake or
exhaust valve on the #1 cylinder. This allows the
valve to drop slightly if the piston is at top center.
Lightly tap the end of the valve with a soft mallet
to be sure that the valve is against the piston.
IMPORTANT: Do not strike the valve with a metal
hammer or other similar tool. Striking the valve stem
with too much force will damage it, requiring expens-
ive valve repair and replacement.
19993689
74
68 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
19993690
76
10. Reinstall the rocker arm and shaft assembly.
Tighten the bolts to 217 N⋅m (160 ft. lbs.) and set
the valve clearances.
Intake Valve Lash:
0.36 - 0.46 mm (0.014 - 0.018 in.)
Exhaust Valve Lash:
0.43 - 0.53 mm (0.017 - 0.021 in.)
Turn the engine at least two full revolutions to en-
sure that all valves open and close fully.
19992950
77
11. Reinstall the rocker cover with its gasket. Tighten
the rocker cover bolts to 20 - 27 N⋅m (15 - 20 ft. 1
lbs.).
78
70 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 400
Op. 10 406 10
2 1
Removal
1. Drain the engine coolant system.
2. Lift up on the two handles, 1, to move the radiator
rearward.
3. Remove the upper and lower radiator hoses. 79
4. Remove the radiator overflow hose to the over-
flow tank.
5. Remove two cap screws and spacers, 2. Re-
move the radiator.
Installation
Installation of the radiator follows the removal
procedure in reverse. On installation, observe
the following requirements:
Depending upon the weather conditions, ensure
the correct grade and quantity of antifreeze is
added to the coolant. See “Specifications Ser-
vice Standards” in this section.
Run the engine for several minutes and check
the radiator and connections for leaks.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 71
Op. 10 402 30
1
THERMOSTAT REMOVAL
1. Drain the cooling system to below the level of the
coolant outlet connection, 1.
2. Remove the coolant outlet connection retaining
bolts and slide the connection with the hose at-
tached to one side.
3. Remove the thermostat, 3, and gasket, 2.
Installation
Installation of the thermostat follows the removal pro-
cedure in reverse. On installation observe the follow-
ing requirements:
Coat a new coolant outlet connection gasket with
sealer and position on the cylinder head or manifold
prior to installing the thermostat.
Coat the edge of the thermostat with grease and in-
stall with the heat element located in the cylinder
head.
72 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 402 10
81
3. Remove the upper and lower radiator hoses, 1,
from the engine block and plug the hoses with
plastic plugs. 3
4. Remove cap screws and nuts, 2. Slide fan
shroud, 3, forward to access the oil cooler line
connection. 1
5. Disconnect the oil cooler bottom left line and cap
to prevent loss of oil.
2
82
6. Remove the hydraulic oil filter restriction switch
wires, 1, and harness clamps, 2.
7. Disconnect hydraulic line, 3, from the oil filter
base.
1
2
83
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 73
84
9. Remove the rear door latch bracket, 1, by remov-
ing the two capscrews, 2.
1
19984501
85
10. Remove eight mounting cap screws, 1, (four
screws on each side). Remove the radiator/oil
cooler assembly from the skid steer.
NOTE: The radiator/oil cooler assembly is heavy and
may require a lifting device to remove.
11. Remove the alternator drive belt.
12. Withdraw the four bolts which pass through the 1
water pump into the block and remove the pump.
19984502
86
74 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 402 28
4
Disassembly
1. Withdraw the attaching bolts and remove the fan 1
from the pump pulley, 1.
2. Use Puller Tool No. FNH09539, 2, and a sleeve,
3, slightly smaller than the pulley shaft to remove
the pump pulley, 1.
3. Remove the retaining bolts, then separate the
pump covers, 4, and discard the gasket.
3 2
87
4. Use a sleeve, 1, with a diameter slightly smaller
than the bearing shaft to press the shaft and
bearing assembly, 2, out of the impeller, 3, and
pump housing, 4.
1
4 2
88
5. Use a suitable sleeve and press the seal assem-
bly, 1, out of the impeller side, 2, of the pump 2
housing. Discard the seal assembly, 1.
Reassembly
1. Use a sleeve, 1, which passes over the shaft and 1
rests on the outside diameter of the bearing, to
press the bearing and shaft assembly, 2, into the
housing until the bearing is flush with the face of 2
the housing. Use a straightedge to check the final
position.
90
2. Turn the pump housing over and position in a
press, 1, with the seal bore facing upwards. 1
3. Coat the outer diameter of the seal flange with a
thin application of thread sealer and position the
seal assembly over the shaft in the center bore
of the housing.
4. Place Tool No. FNH04672, 3, over the shaft and
onto the seal assembly, 2. Press the seal into the
bore until the flange is flush with the top of the
housing. 2
3
91
5. Support the shaft on a block of wood and use a
length of pipe of suitable internal diameter to
press the impeller, 1, onto the shaft, 2, and flush 1
with the rear face of the housing. Check the final
position with a straightedge.
92
76 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 304 2. Inspect the sump for cracks, damaged drain plug
threads, or distorted gasket surface.
LUBRICATION SYSTEM - SL65B
Installation
Op. 10 102 10 On installation, observe the following requirements:
Ensure the gasket surfaces on the oil pan and
OIL PAN REMOVAL block are clean.
The oil pan can be removed with the engine installed Install a new gasket and apply a thin film of sealer
in the skid steer by first removing the rear engine to the gasket, front cover, and oil pan.
belly pan. This allows ready access to the pan secur- Position the oil pan and install a bolt finger tight
ing bolts. at each corner.
Install the remaining bolts, tighten the rear bolts
Inspection And Repair first, then tighten from the middle outward in each
1. Scrape all gasket material from the gasket sur- direction to the specified torque.
face, then wash the oil pan sump in a suitable sol- Fill the engine with the correct grade and quantity
vent and dry with a clean lint-free cloth or com- of oil.
pressed air. Operate the engine and check for oil leaks.
78 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 304 34
1. Remove the oil pan as described earlier in this
section. 4 1
2. Remove oil pump retaining bolts, 3. Remove the
oil pump, 4, with the filter screen, 1. Withdraw the
intermediate shaft, 2.
3 2
94
3. Remove the engine oil filter, 1.
4. Remove plug, 2, then withdraw the drive shaft
adapter assembly and the oil pump drive gear.
95
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 79
14
13
12 1
9 10 11
6 2
3
6 4
8 7
5
96
Disassembly
1. Remove the pump screen. 1. Oil pump retaining bolts
2. Plug
2. Withdraw the retaining screw and washer as-
3. Drive shaft adapter mounting base
semblies, then separate the inner and outer
4. Oil pump drive shaft and gear assembly
covers from the body and extract the rotor and
5. ntermediate shaft
shaft assembly.
6. Screw and washer assemblies
3. Insert a self-tapping screw into the relief valve 7. Screen
plug and pull the plug out of the body. Withdraw 8. Spring
the relief valve and spring. 9. Outer cover
10. nner cover
11. nner rotor and shaft assembly
12. Outer rotor
13. Body
14. Pressure relief valve assembly
80 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
97
4. Use feeler gauges, 3, to measure the clearance
between the periphery of the outer rotor, 1, and
the pump body, 2.
5. Check the relief valve spring tension. See “Spec-
ifications Service Standards” in this section.
6. Inspect the relief valve for wear and check for
freedom of movement within the bore.
7. Check the oil pump drive gear for worn or dam-
aged teeth.
8. Examine the intermediate drive shaft socket
ends for wear.
Reassembly
98
Reassembly of the oil pump components follows the
disassembly procedure in reverse. On reassembly,
observe the following requirements.
Oil all the parts.
The inner rotor and shaft assembly and the outer
rotor are serviced as an assembly.
Prior to installation, introduce clean engine oil
into the inlet port and rotate the pump shaft by
hand.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 81
Installation
Installation of the oil pump follows the removal pro-
cedure in reverse. On installation, observe the fol-
lowing requirements.
Apply silicone sealant to the mating surface of
plug, 1.
Remove all traces of seal material from the locat-
ing surface, then install a new oil filter and seal.
Apply a light, even coat of clean engine oil to the
seal surface prior to installation. Hand tighten the 1
filter until the seal contacts the locating surface,
then tighten an additional one-half to three-
quarters of a turn.
IMPORTANT: Never use a tool to tighten the spin-on 99
filter.
Op. 10 304 06
19987124
100
Push the end of the rubber tube, 1, to make sure it
contacts the engine block, 2.
1
2
19987125
101
82 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 200
FUEL SYSTEM
The diesel fuel system consists of a fuel tank, electric
lift pump, fuel filter/sediment separator, DPS 200
series fuel injection pump, fuel injectors and inter
connecting fuel lines. A dry type air cleaner removes
dirt and contaminants from the air intake.
DP203
The fuel is drawn from the fuel tank, through the sedi-
ment separator and fuel filter by the electric lift pump,
and then fed into the injection pump.
The transfer pump delivers fuel to the injection pump
to supply fuel at high pressure to each injector and
also provides extra fuel which lubricates and cools
the injection pump. This extra fuel is recirculated via
a fitting on the fuel injection pump governor control
housing to the fuel tank by means of the injector leak
off line.
The excess fuel that leaks past the needle valve of
the injectors is directed back into the fuel tank at the
filler neck by means of the injection leak off line.
FUEL TANK
A plastic fuel tank, 1, is located on the lower left rear
of the machine.
1
19982962
102
Op. 10 210 21
2
ELECTRIC LIFT PUMP
Mounted on the left hand side of the engine above the
fuel filter is an electrical lift pump, 1. The pump draws 1
fuel through the sediment separator, 2, and the fuel
filter, 3. The fuel is then pressurized and fed into the
fuel injection pump.
19982965
103
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 83
Op. 10 206 10
FUEL FILTER
The filter, 1, positioned on theright hand side of the
engine behind the injection pump directs the fuel
through the filter head to be directed down through
the filter paper into the base chamber. The filtered 1
fuel then flows up the center tube of the element to
the filter head outlet and flows onto the injection
pump.
The drain plug, 2, permits contaminated fuel to be 2
drained from the filter.
19982974
104
THERMOSTART
To aid engine starting in cold weather conditions, a
thermostart system incorporating an integral reser-
voir system is available.
The thermostart system is made up of a plug assem-
bly screwed intothe intake manHold, afuel line con-
nected to the injector leak off tube and an electrical
circuit, connected to the ignition switch.
The plug assembly, 1, consists of a check valve and
electrically heated element.
Fuel is gravity fed to the plug assembly and, when op-
erating the key starVstop switch and the thermostart
switch, the heater and “igniter” coils are both ener-
gized. The “heater” coil opens a check valve which al- 105
lows diesel fuel to flow through the thermostart. The
fuel is ignited by the “igniter” coil in the manifold, heat-
ing the intake manifold air prior to H entering the com-
bustion chamber.
When the thermostart switch is released to the off
position, the electrical current is disconnected from
the thermostart and the check valve closes.
Op. 10 246 14
FUEL PUMP
The fuel injection pump fitted to these vehicles is the
DP203 (emissionized) type. The fuel pump, which is
fed by an electric lift pumper, supplies fuel at high
pressure to the fuel injectors.
106
84 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 218 34
INJECTORS
The fuel injectors, 1, mounted in the cylinder head
supply fuel in the form of a spray pattern into the cylin-
der bores. The controlled amounts of fuel ensure
optimum engine performance throughout the operat-
ing ranae.
107
ADJUSTMENTS
1
19983007
108
2. Install a key, 1, P/N 74145S, into the slot in the
fuel injection pump drive shaft, 2.
2
19983002
109
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 85
19983005
111
6. Rotate the pump until the timing mark, 1, on the
pump flange is centered in the marker (pointer)
slot, 2.
1
2
19983006
112
86 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
19983005
115
7. Slide the pointer bar until it aligns with the timing
mark, 1, on the pump flange.
8. If the reading is 29°, the pump is properly timed.
If the reading differs, the pump is out of time. Fol-
low the procedure in “Injection Pump Lock Tim-
ing” to retime the pump. Each degree the pump
1
varies from the proper timing equals two engine
degrees of timing.
19983006
116
INSTALLING THE INJECTION PUMP
1. Place the locked, pre timed fuel Injection pump
on the engine. The mounting bolts install from in-
side the front cover. Two bolts thread into the
pump flange, while the third bolt uses a nut on the
outside of the pump flange. Tighten to 20 - 25 Nm
(15 - 18 ft Ibs).
IMPORTANT: Use an O ring, P/N 14437585, on each
mounting bolt prior to inserting if through the mount-
ing holes. Failure to install new O rings on the bolts
may allow engine lubricant to leak out.
2. Place the washer and retaining nut on the gear,
leaving the nut loose for now. 19983009
117
88 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
19983010
118
4. Unlock the fuel pump by loosening the lock
screw, 1, and installing or realigning the washer
so that the small opening is under the screw
head. Retighten the lock screw to 11 - 13 Nm (8
- 10 ft Ibs). Do not overtighten.
5. Reinstall all fuel lines, tubing, access covers and
other hardware that was removed during service.
Use proper gaskets or sealants, and tighten all
hardware to the appropriate torque.
6. Prime the fuel system and start the engine. In-
spect the fuel system and repair any leaks.
NOTE: Always run the engine and inspect all con- 1
nections and components to be sure they function 19983007
properly before returning the unit to service. 119
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 89
Op. 10 218 34
INJECTORS
Coupled to the fuel injection pump are low inertia type
injectors. The turbocharged engine incorporates five
hole nozzle low inertia injectors. The overhaul pro-
cedure for the low inertia injector is described below.
1. Fuel inlet
2. Shims
3. Spring seat
4. Nozzle valve
5. Nozzle valve seat
6. Nozzle tip
7. Nozzle retaining nut 122
8. Nozzle
9. Doweled adapter plate
10. Spring
11. njector body
12. Leak-off line
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 91
123
FUEL INJECTOR OVERHAUL
Op. 10 218 34
Disassembly 1. Injector body
1. Place the injector in a holding fixture with the 2. Copper sealing washers
nozzle uppermost. Do not clamp the injector 3. Leak-off line connector
body in a vise. Remove the nozzle retaining nut 4. Shims
complete with the nozzle body, nozzle valve, and 5. Spring seat
the doweled adapter plate. 6. Nozzle valve
7. Nozzle
2. Remove the injector body, 1, from the holding fix-
8. Nozzle retaining nut
ture, invert and carefully remove the spring seat,
5, spring, 10, and adjustment shims, 4. To avoid 9. Doweled adapter plate
damage, place all dismantled components in 10. Spring
suitable baths of clean fuel oil.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 93
125
94 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Reassembly
1. Ensure all parts are absolutely clean and undam-
aged prior to reassembly. Rinse all parts in clean
fuel oil and assemble the components while still
wet.
2. Place the shims, spring and spring seat into the
injector body bore. Place the injector body into
the holding fixture.
3. Assemble the nozzle valve into the nozzle body
and then position the doweled adapter plate onto
the nozzle body. Insert this assembly into the
nozzle retaining nut.
4. Carefully assemble the doweled adapter plate, 2,
and the nozzle retaining nut assembly onto the
injector body, 1, and tighten the retaining nut to 1
48 N·m (35 ft. lbs.).
127
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 95
Op. 10 210 21
1
ELECTRIC LIFT PUMP - SL65B
The pump, 1, is mounted into the head of the fuel filter
and is activated via the key-start switch.
The fuel is drawn up from the tank through the separ-
ator and filter assemblies and then out to the FIP
inlet.
A5378 - 07
128
1. With the key start on, check for 12V at the electri-
cal copnnector of the pump, 1. If 12V is not pres-
ent, check fuses, relay and wiring.
2. If there is no/little delivery, and voltage and fuel 1
are present at the pump, the pump should be re-
placed.
19995959
129
Removal
1. Disconnect battery.
2. Remove the two wires from the pump.
3. Unscrew the filter head/pump assembly connec-
tion and lift away from filter assembly.
Installation is reverse procedure, ensure O rings, 1,
are serviceable.
130
96 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Pump Testing
Fuel pump may be checked on the vehicle.
Ensure initially that the filter is serviceable and there
are no other restrictions between the fuel tank and
filters.
Disconnect the filter outlet to pump tube and recon-
nect to the filter, allowing the outlet to be positioned
into a suitable measuring jar.
Turn the key start to the first position for a measured
amount of time and record the fuel delivered.
Compare against specification.
131
Air in the fuel from pump outlet 1. Blocked fuel tank breather 1. Clear blockage
2. Loose fuel connections 2. Check and tighten
3. Fuel Pump Diaphragm 3. Replace Pump
perforated
4. Fuel pump body seam 4. Replace Pump
. . leaking
5. Pump Worn 5. Replace Pump
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 97
Op. 10 216 10
REMOVAL
1. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Refer to Section 1 for more de-
tailed information on properly supporting the skid
steer.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the loader causing serious injury or
damage to the equipment.
1
3
2
19995956
132
7. Remove cap screws, 2. Remove bracket, 1.
1 2
133
98 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
134
INSPECTION
If the fuel tank shows signs of contact by block protru-
sion, 2, the protrusion can be ground flat with the sur-
rounding area.
DO NOT grind the block beyond flat with the sur-
rounding web (dotted line).
135
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 99
INSTALLATION NOTE: For machines with restricted fill flow, new re-
1. Install the fuel tank into the loader and secure placement tubes can be obtained through the Ser-
with retaining hardware. vice Parts System. No additional parts are needed.
NOTE: Use silicone sealant on the two cap screws NOTE: To replace the tube, loosen the hose clamp,
holding the front retaining bracket to the final drive retaining the fill tube to the connector hose, and re-
case. move the old tube. Insert the new fill tube (part
#86542122) into the connector hose, until it contacts
2. Install the fuel lines and fuel level sender wires. the inlet to the fuel tank, and retighten the hose
3. Install the fuel tank filler neck. Tighten the hose clamp.
clamp. 4. Fill the fuel tank.
NOTE: NOTE: A redesigned fill tube was introduced 5. Install the engine belly pan and left side shield.
into production during July of 1997. This tube allows
free flow of fuel into the tank, without the restrictions 6. Lower the skid steer.
of the previous tube.
100 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 202 40
Removal
To service the engine air cleaner, the boom must be
raised and supported on the boom lock pins, 1.
The air cleaner, 2, is accessed by opening the rear
3
door and top engine cover and left engine side shield. 19984608
The air cleaner assembly uses two elements, a pri- 136
mary element and a safety element.
Disconnect the outlet hose, 3, and inlet hose, 4.
To access the air filter elements, loosen the three
clamps, 1, and unlatching end cap from air cleaner 1
body. 3
To remove the primary element, remove the end cap,
2. This exposes the primary element, 3.
1 1
2
19984609
137
Inspection
1. Pull the primary element, 1, from the canister. 1
Clean any loose dirt from the canister and inspect
the end of the canister for dirt that may prevent
the new element from sealing properly. Replace
the primary element when the EIC indicates air
cleaner restriction. Do not attempt to remove the
element when the engine is running because dirt
will be sucked into the engine. Do not attempt to
clean the element by beating or rapping it.
IMPORTANT: Do not attempt to remove the element
when the engine is running because dirt will be
sucked into the engine. Change the air cleaner el- 19984610
ement if a loss of power is noted. When installing a 138
new element make sure it seals properly in the can-
ister.
IMPORTANT: Clean any dirt and dust from the can-
ister before reinstalling the cleaner element. Make
sure the inner end of the canister is clean and free of
dirt to insure the element will seal properly to prevent
dirt from entering the intake of the engine. Failure of
a good seal between the filter and canister may
cause major engine damage.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 101
140
102 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Reinstallation
Install a new primary element and/or safety element
by inserting the open end of the elements, 1, into the 1
canister, 2. Push the elements into the canister firmly
for proper sealing inside the canister.
19984612
141
Reinstall the end cap, 1, by positioning the top of the
4 3 6 4
end cap at 2. Seat the end cap into the lip on the can- 5 2
ister at 3, pushing the elements and end cap into
position.
Relatch the clamps, 4, by catching the top clamp into 3
a slot in the canister lip at 5. Relatch the second two
clamps after the top is clamped securely.
Reconnect the inlet hose, 6, and outlet hose, 7, to the
canister. 1
4 7
19984613
142
EXHAUST MUFFLER
1
3
Op. 10 254 40
Removal
2
1. Remove the right side engine shield to access
the exhaust muffler.
2. Remove four cap screws, 2. Remove the exhaust
muffler, 1, and gasket, 3.
Inspection
Check for damage to the housing and mounting
flange. 143
Installation
After installing a new gasket, reverse the procedure
previously outlined.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 103
TURBOCHARGER
4 1
Op. 10 250 30
Removal
1. Remove the left side engine shield.
2. Remove the exhaust muffler.
3. Disconnect the air cleaner to the turbocharger
tube and the turbocharger, 1, to intake manifold
tube, 4.
4. Disconnect the oil supply and return tubes, 2, 3 2
from the turbocharger, 1. Cap the ends of the
tubes and oil ports of the turbocharger to prevent 144
entry of foreign material.
NOTE: Before removing and cleaning the unit, look
for signs of oil and/or gas leakage, also wheel dam-
age, which may not be evident after cleaning.
5. Remove the turbocharger and gasket from the
exhaust manifold, 3. Cover the opening in the ex-
haust manifold to prevent the entry of dirt which
could cause damage to the turbine wheel blades
after installation and startup.
Disassembly
1. Clean the exterior of the turbocharger using a
non-caustic cleaning solvent to remove accumu-
lated surface matter before disassembly.
2. Mark the compressor housing, turbine housing,
and center housing with a punch or scribe to fa-
cilitate correct positioning of the housings during
reassembly.
145
3. Remove the compressor housing C clip from the
center housing intake side.
146
104 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
147
148
NOTE: Exercise care when removing the com- Exploded View of Turbocharger
pressor housing to avoid damaging the compressor 1. Turbine housing
wheel blades. 2. Retainer plates
Tap the turbine housing with a soft-faced hammer if 3. Retainer bolts
force is needed to remove. 4. Center housing and rotating assembly (CHRA)
5. C clip
6. O ring
7. Compressor housing
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 105
Reassembly
1. Replace the following with factory- authorized
parts only at each overhaul or whenever parts
are removed.
Snap ring, compressor housing retainer
O ring seal, compressor housing
Retainer plates, turbine housing
Bolts, turbine housing retainers
108 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
Installation
1. Prior to installation, fill the turbocharger center
housing with new clean oil and rotate the main
shaft to lubricate the bearings.
2. Installation of the turbocharger follows the re-
moval procedure in reverse. Install a new mani-
fold gasket and tighten to 41 - 47 N·m (30 - 35 ft.
lbs.).
3. Replace the washers and reconnect the oil feed
1
tube banjo bolt, 1, and torque to 30 - 40 N·m (22
- 30 ft. lbs.).
– Oil feed tube to turbocharger (banjo bolt)
– Oil feed tube to filter head connector 4
– Connect to filter head
– Oil return tube from turbocharger to block 3
– Oil return tube to block connector
– Oil return connector to block 5
4. The oil feed tube connector to oil filter head as-
sembly, 3, if disturbed, should be refitted. Apply 6 2
sealer to connector. See “Specifications Service
Standards” in this section and torque to 54 - 81 152
N·m (40 - 60 ft. lbs.).
5. Apply sealer. See “Specifications Service Stan-
dards” in this section. Assemble the oil feed tube
to the oil filter head connector, 2, and tighten to
18 - 20 N·m (13 - 15 ft. lbs.).
6. Place a suitable receptacle below the oil outlet
port and with the electrical solenoid wire dis-
connected at the fuel injection pump, crank
the engine until oil flows from the outlet port.
7. Reconnect the oil outlet tube, 4, using a new
gasket and tighten the retaining bolts at the
turbocharger to 20 - 25 N·m (15 - 18 ft. lbs.).
8. Tighten the oil return tube to cylinder block con-
nector, 5, to 54 - 81 N·m (45 - 50 ft. lbs.).
9. If disturbed, oil return tube to block connector, 6,
should have sealer applied. See “Specifications
Service Standards” in this section. Torque to 27
N·m (20 ft. lbs.).
110 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
10. Reconnect the air inlet and outlet tubes with the
hose clamps and torque to 1.7 - 2.3 N·m (15 -
20 in. lbs.).
11. Reconnect the fuel injection pump solenoid wire.
12. Check the engine oil level and add oil if required.
Idle the engine and check all tubes and gaskets
for leaks.
13. Run the engine at rated speed and listen for
sounds of metallic contact from the turbocharger.
If any noise is apparent, stop the engine immedi-
ately and correct the cause.
NOTE: After the unit has reached operating tem-
peratures, the rotating assembly should coast freely
to a stop after the engine is stopped. If the rotating as-
sembly jerks to a sudden stop, the cause should be
corrected immediately.
Turbocharger Leaking Oil at Pressure Hose
Connection
Oil leakage in the area of the connecting hose be-
tween the turbocharger and crossover tube to the in-
take manifold at 1. This is a result of oil weeping out
the joint between the turbocharger and the hose.
A small amount of oil blow-by is normal in this turbo-
charger skid steer application. Due to the extremely
high speeds in a turbocharger, the turbine shaft rides
on a film of oil. It is a fluid bearing, not a metal bearing,
which supports the shaft and keeps it cool. At the
ends of the shaft, the oil is not fully sealed with a typi-
cal rubber lip seal. A labyrinth seal is used for the
shaft to allow the high rotational speed. The labyrinth 153
seal can protect against oil splashing out, but it will
allow pressurized oil to pass by it. When the turbo-
charger is running, excessive oil blow-by can be
demonstrated by intentionally blocking the air intake
into the turbocharger. This occurs because the high
vacuum causes the oil to travel across the labyrinth
seal. This phenomena occurs to a much smaller de-
gree under normal engine operating conditions.
However, it is somewhat worse with an application
such as with skid steers, where the engine is not op-
erated at a constant speed and load.
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 111
The oil blow-by is not staying inside the hose and tub-
ing, but it is leaking to the outside surfaces, where it
collects dirt and gives the appearance that someth-
ing has failed. Oil leaking at this connection will also
give the appearance that there is an oil leak between
the turbine housing and the compressor housing at
the retaining ring and O ring.
To correct a leak, remove the hose from the turbo-
charger and tube at 1, and thoroughly clean the con-
nections. Remove and discard the original hose
clamps. These clamps are not properly seating and
sealing the hose to the rough casting of the turbo-
charger or steel tube.
NOTE: When the hose is removed, there may be evi-
dence of oil at this connection and inside of the hose
and tube. This is normal in the skid steer application.
Order and install two (2) new hose clamps, part
#58880, and tighten them to 35 in. lbs.
Install the hose and clamp onto the turbocharger at
1, half the length of hose, making sure that the hose
is positioned to allow enough area of hose past the 154
rolled edge on the turbocharger at 2, to insure the
hose clamp will properly seat the hose to the turbo-
charger.
Install the hose and clamp onto the crossover tube at
3, making sure the tube is fully inserted into the hose
so the hose clamp will seal the hose and tube past the
rolled edge on the tube.
112 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
156
6. Install fuel supply line, 1, and return line, 2.
7. Connect throttle cable. Adjust as required.
1
2
19995956
157
8. Connect the engine main harness connector, 1.
Install ground strap, 2.
1
158
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 115
19984502
159
10. Connect the oil cooler bottom left line.
11. Install fan shroud, 3, and secure with four cap
screws and nuts, 2. 3
12. Install the upper and lower radiator hoses, 1.
1
160
13. Connect hydraulic line, 3, to the filter base.
14. Connect the hydraulic oil filter restriction switch
wires, 1, and harness clamp, 2.
15. Install the air cleaner and tighten all hose clamps.
16. Install the fuel tank filler neck and tighten clamps. 1
17. Install the rear door latch bracket. 2
18. Install the rear door and connect the overflow
hose to the tank.
19. Install the battery. Refer to Section 3 for the bat-
tery installation procedure. 3
20. Refill all fluids to the proper level.
161
116 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
OPERATING THE ENGINE AFTER 5. Connect the wiring harness connector to the en-
OVERHAUL gine stop solenoid.
1. Check level of engine oil, coolant and fuel. 6. Move the hand throttle to the 1/3 or 1/2 open posi-
tion and start the engine. Operate at no more
2. Disconnect the wiring harness connector at the
than 1500 RPM.
engine stop solenoid.
7. Run the engine at 1500 RPM for about 30 min-
3. With the turbocharger oil return line removed,
utes to allow it to fully warm up and begin the ring
place a suitable container below the oil outlet
seating process. During warmup observe the fol-
port. Crank the engine until oil flows from the
lowing:
open port. Reinstall the oil return line.
– Listen for abnormal sounds.
4. Crank the engine until the oil pressure lamp is ex-
tinguished. – Monitor engine temperature.
– Check for fluid leaks (oil, coolant, fuel).
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 117
ELECTRICAL COMPONENT
MAINTENANCE - SL65B
3 2
CRANKING CIRCUIT (STARTING MOTOR)
5
Op. 55 201 50 1
Removal
7
IMPORTANT: Always disconnect the negative (-)
battery cable before removing the starter or a short
4 6
circuit could result.
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove solenoid cover, 1, from rear of solenoid. 19995960
Installation
1. Reverse the removal procedure previously out-
lined.
CHARGING CIRCUIT 2 5
3
Op. 55 301 10
Alternator Removal 4
IMPORTANT: Always disconnect the negative (-)
battery cable before removing the alternator or a
short circuit could result. 5
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable. 6
2. Disconnect the R/DK BL wiring lead, 3, from ter-
1
minal B+ and PU/R wiring lead, 2, from terminal 5
W.
3. Disconnect B wiring lead, 1, and Y/DK BL electri-
cal connector, 4. 163
4. Remove the three cap screws, 5. Remove belt,
6. Remove the alternator.
Installation
1. Reverse the removal procedure previously out-
lined.
2. Adjust belt tension.
118 SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1
164
SECTION 10 – ENGINE – CHAPTER 1 119
Chapter 1 – Gearboxes
CONTENT
Op. 27 000
GENERAL INFORMATION
Each of the two hydrostatic pumps is driven by the
engine through a spur gear configuration located in
the engine-to-transmission gearbox. The hydrostatic
pumps then transmit hydraulic power to the hydro-
static motors, 1, which are connected to gearboxes,
2, located on the inside of the final drive cases. The
left and right drives are separate from each other and
are operated independently.
2
Power is then transmitted through gears to a drive
sprocket, 1, in the final drive case. The drive sprocket
is connected to the axle sprockets, 2, with chains, 3,
one endless chain to the front axle and one endless
chain to the rear axle.
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 3
OPS844
4
1. Hydrostatic motors (2) 4. Drive chains (front and rear) (4)
2. Gearboxes (2) 5. Axle drive sprockets (4)
3. Final drive sprocket assemblies (2) 6. Axle assemblies (4)
4 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
SPECIFICATIONS
Chain Case and Gearbox
Description Use
Ultra/Blue Silicone Sealer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gearbox mounting bolts
Axle housing bolts
Chain case cover bolts
Gearbox to chain case
Gearbox cover and bolts
Sealing Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NH Ultra Blue silicone sealer
Gear Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80W-90 API Service GL-5 Gear Oil
Grease . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High viscosity lithium base
NOTE: Always use a noncorrosive silicone sealer to seal where required to prevent corrosion during the sili-
cone curing process.
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 5
TROUBLESHOOTING
6
6 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
One drive wheel not powered Broken drive chain Check chain and repair
Axle or drive sprocket splines worn Check axle and sprocket; replace
Chain case noise Loose drive chains Check and adjust chains
No oil in final drive Check oil level
Worn drive sprockets Check sprockets and repair
Bearing failure Check axle and gearbox bearings
and repair
Excessive axle play Bearing failure on axle shaft Check bearings and repair
Snap ring failure on axle shaft Check axle bearing preload; repair
Final drive case leaking Oil escaping past case side sheet Reinstall with sealant as described
and reinforcing plate in Service Bulletin (7/95-I7)
Oil escaping past studs Remove and reseal studs
Oil escaping around center Remove plate and reseal
inspection plate
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 7
TESTING
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat with seat belt buckled.
* Engine running at high idle (full throttle).
* Park brake in disengaged position.
STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION
1 Push both drive controls YES Drive system OK.
forward equally and loader
should move in a straight line. NO Engine stalls, wheels appear locked, check parking
brake for engaged. If OK, go to step 2.
Pretest instructions:
* Lower boom and attachment to the ground.
* Stop engine.
* Jack loader with wheels off the ground.
* Release parking brake.
Op. 27 126
GEARBOXES
Two gearboxes are used to provide speed reduction
and transmit power from the hydrostatic drive motors
to the final drive chains. The parking brake assem-
blies are located in the gearboxes.
19987119
8
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 9
Op. 27 126 40
REMOVAL
1. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Refer to Section 00 for more de-
tailed information on properly supporting the skid
steer.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the loader causing serious injury or
damage to the equipment.
19987119
11
Op. 27 126 48
DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the gearbox.
2. Remove the four cap screws and washers, 1. Re-
move bracket, 2, and the parking brake cover, 3.
12
3. Remove the two brake discs, 2, and separator
plate, 3, from drive coupling, 1.
13
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 11
3
14
5. Remove two cap screws, 2. Remove bracket, 3.
Remove the remaining five cap screws, 1. Separ-
ate the gearbox halves.
15
6. Inspect roller bearings, 1, 2, and 3. If worn or
rough, they must be removed and replaced.
NOTE: Roller bearings have some interference in
housing and may require a bearing puller to remove.
7. Loosen jam nut, 6, and cap screw, 5. Remove
park brake lever, 4.
16
12 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
17
9. Remove pinion gear, 2, and gear, 1, by sliding
them from the housing.
10. Remove snap ring, 3.
18
11. Place the gearbox in a press and support hous-
ing as close as possible to the drive sprocket.
12. Using an appropriate size shaft protector, press
the shaft assembly, 1, from the bearings and re-
move from the housing. Do not allow the shaft as-
sembly to drop to the floor when it breaks free of
the housing.
19
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 13
20
14. Remove roller bearings, 1.
NOTE: Roller bearings have some interference in
housing and may require a bearing puller to remove.
15. Remove oil seal, 2.
NOTE: The oil seal will be destroyed when removed.
Replace it with a new seal.
21
16. Support gear assembly in press as shown. Re-
move bearing race, 1, and gear, 2.
Do not allow the shaft to drop to the floor when it
breaks free of the gear.
22
14 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
23
18. Invert the pinion shaft assembly in the press.
Support the shaft assembly with a bearing separ-
ator as shown. Remove bearing race, 1.
24
PARTS INSPECTION
1. Thoroughly clean all parts of old sealant, oil, etc.
before inspection.
2. Examine the shaft bearing surfaces for wear.
3. Check the shaft splines for wear.
4. Check the operation of the gearbox breather.
5. Check the gearbox housing for any cracks, etc.
6. Inspect the gearbox housing bearing areas for
wear.
7. Examine the mounting bolt threads for damage.
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 15
REASSEMBLY
Reassemble the final drive gearbox in the reverse of
the disassembly procedures previously outlined
while observing the following precautions.
1. Install oil seals, 1, with the seal lips facing the
gearbox.
25
2. Install roller bearings into the housing until bear-
ing face, 1, is flush with the housing. DO NOT
bottom the bearings in the housing.
26
3. Install snap ring, 1, onto the drive shaft making
sure it is seated properly in its groove.
27
16 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
28
5. Install the parking brake pad spacer, 1, (thin disc)
into the inner brake housing. Install the friction
pad, 2, (thick disc) into the inner brake housing.
4
6. Install the splined coupler hub, 3, onto the gear-
box input shaft.
7. Reinstall the two magnets in holes, 4. One each
side.
4
29
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 17
2
1
19987114
30
9. Install the separator plate on the drive coupler,
with the lugs, 1, over the extended tabs, 2, on the
gearbox case.
1
2
19987115
31
10. Install the second brake disc, 1, on the drive
coupler, 2. The splines, 3, of the drive coupler 2
should be visible above the brake disc. 3
1
19987117
32
18 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
33
13. Reinstall the gearbox breather, 1, if removed,
using pipe sealant on the fitting threads.
34
Op. 27 126 40
REINSTALLATION
1. Thoroughly clean the mating surfaces between
the chain case and the final drive gearbox to pro-
vide a good sealing surface.
NOTE: When resealing, use a noncorrosive silicone
sealer to prevent rusting and corrosion of parts after
assembly.
2. Apply a bead of silicone sealer to the corner of
the pilot OD on the final drive gearbox at 1.
35
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 19
36
4. Using a hoist, lower the gearbox into position and
pilot into the chain case mounting hole, 1. 2
5. Apply a bead of silicone sealer under the heads
and washers of the gearbox retaining bolts, 2,
and install. Torque the bolts to 233 ft. lbs. (316 1
N·m). Check that the plastic funnel, 3, is not
cracked or broken, and reinstall if removed.
2
19987119
37
6. Install the two lower gearbox mounting bolts, 1,
through mounting plate, 2, and into the gearbox
at 3. Torque to 34 ft. lbs. (46 N·m).
38
20 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
39
10. Install the remaining hoses and control linkages:
– Neutralizer support bracket, connects the
right and left hydrostatic motors.
– Two-speed control linkage and shift cylinder,
1 (if applicable).
– High-pressure hydraulic and hydrostatic
hoses, 2.
– Neutralizer assembly, 3.
– Control handle assemblies and linkages, 4.
40
11. Install the drive chains onto the gearbox drive
sprocket, 1 with the front chain, 2, to the inside
and the rear chain, 3, to the outside.
12. Fill the chain case with SAE 80W-90 API service 1
GL-5 gear oil to the bottom edge of the lower two
threaded holes at 4.
13. Clean all sealer and oil from the chain case cover
mating area at 5.
4
5 3
2
19987119
41
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 21
43
17. With the axle housing, 1, tight against the case,
install the retaining nuts and flat washers, 2, to
hold the housing against the case.
18. Slide the axle housing assembly to tighten the
drive chains.
NOTE: The chains are properly tensioned when
there is 0 to 6 mm (0, to 1/4,) movement at the outer
edge of tire tread.
19. Torque the axle retaining hardware to 140 ft. lbs.
(190 N·m).
CAUTION
When tightening the axle retaining hardware, the
axle housing must be tight against the case at 1, or 44
damage to the case may occur.
22 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
3 1
45
22. Refer to “Start-Up Procedure” at the end of this
section, and complete the procedure prior to ma-
chine operation.
Start-Up Procedure Summary
– Connect charge pressure gauge.
– Remove fuel solenoid wire.
– Crank engine for up to 30 seconds until a
charge pressure of more than 50 PSI (3.4
bar) is obtained.
– Reconnect the fuel solenoid wire and start
engine. Operate for 30 min., observe charge
pressure gauge, and check for leaks. Repair
leaks if necessary.
– Stop engine, check oil level, and add if
necessary.
– Restart engine, operate at 1500 RPM and
slowly operate the control levers. Monitor
charge pressure.
– Stop engine, check oil level.
– Remove gauge, start engine, run for 30 min.
to filter oil. Stop engine, change oil filter.
23. Tilt cab back to operating position and install
tires.
24. Recheck the final drive chain adjustment. Rotate
each tire and check for movement: 0 to 6 mm (0″
to 1/4″) movement at the tire tread is acceptable.
25. Reinstall all shields removed for repair.
26. Lower the skid steer to the ground and operate.
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 23
ENGINE-TO-TRANSMISSION GEARBOX
The engine-to-transmission gearbox transfers
power from the engine to the hydrostatic pumps
through an internal gear set. The gearbox is also
equipped to accept the optional hydraulic, high flow
kit pump assembly.
REMOVAL - DISASSEMBLY
The transmission gearbox should be removed with
the cab and boom tilted forward.
1. Remove any attachment, bucket, etc. from the
boom quick-attach plate
2. Raise the boom and lower it onto the boom lock
46
pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
always remove the attachment from the loader.
19984337
47
24 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
WARNING
Never attempt to tilt the skid steer cab over unless the
loader is securely supported.
48
6. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position, 1.
7. Remove the step shield, 2.
8. Relieve all pressure in the hydraulic and hydro-
static systems.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the systems to avoid serious injury.
49
9. To drain the system, remove the small access
door, 1, at the front right corner of the engine belly
pan by removing the two rear bolts, 2, loosening
the front two bolts, 3, and sliding the door rear-
ward.
50
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 25
51
11. Tilt the cab and boom forward. Refer to the “Cab
Tilting Procedure” in Section 0 of the operator’s
manual for additional information.
52
12. Remove the wiring harness attaching clips, 1 and
3. Mark their locations for reassembly.
13. Remove the ground wire cap screw at 2. Keeping
the wires on the bolt and threading a nut onto the
end of the bolt will ensure that all ground wires
are reconnected during reassembly.
53
26 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
54
NOTE: Clean the pumps thoroughly and mark the
hose locations to aid in reassembly.
16. To remove the right and left hydrostatic pumps,
1, disconnect the high-pressure hoses, 2, and
cap the hose ends and pump ports.
17. Disconnect the supply hose to the charge pump
at 3.
55
18. Remove the charge pressure cross tube, 1, and
the case drain cross tube, 2. Disconnect the
charge pressure sender hose at 3.
19. Disconnect the hydraulic gear pump suction line
at 5, the motor case drain hose at 6, and the main
control valve supply hose at 7.
20. Disconnect the two-speed control valve supply
hose at 4, and the return hose at 8, (if applicable).
21. Disconnect the rear hydrostatic control rods from
the pump control arms at 9 and 10.
22. Plug all hoses and pump ports to prevent the
entry of dirt and contaminants.
56
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 27
57
25. Drain the oil from the gearbox at drain plug, 1.
26. Support the front of the engine block with a piece
of wood or other device at 2. Remove the front
engine mount, 3, along with the retaining hard-
ware.
27. Remove the gearbox cover retaining bolts, 4, and
the gearbox cover, 5.
58
28. Remove the drive gear, 1, by removing the six
socket-head attaching bolts, 2.
59
28 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
29. Remove the drive gear oil seal, 1, using a seal re-
moval tool or puller arrangement.
30. Replacement of the drive gear oil seal, 1, can be
done without removing the flywheel housing, 2.
If for some reason the flywheel housing needs to
be removed, do the following:
– Support the engine at the engine block.
– Remove the engine starter assembly at 3.
– Remove the eight flywheel housing attaching
bolts, 4 (two at both the top and bottom, and
two at each side).
– Remove the flywheel housing.
60
PARTS INSPECTION
1. Inspect the drive gear seal, 1, for damage to the 3
inside diameter sealing surfaces, 2, or for loose-
ness in the flywheel housing, 3, outside diameter
of seal.
2. Look for signs of oil on the engine flywheel side
of the housing. This could indicate a leaking seal.
3. Replace the seal if necessary. Install the seal
with the spring-loaded seal lip toward the fly-
wheel cover side. Use the proper tools to press
fit the seal into the flywheel housing so damage
to the seal does not occur. 2
61
4. Inspect the drive gear teeth, 1, for damage or un-
even wear patterns.
5. Inspect the seal contact surface, 2, for damage
or wear.
6. Replace the gear if necessary.
62
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 29
63
9. Inspect the hydrostatic pump drive gears, 1, on
both the right- and left-hand hydrostatic pumps
(left-hand pump shown). Check for tooth wear or
damage.
10. Check for damage to the O ring, 2.
11. Replace parts as required.
64
REASSEMBLY - INSTALLATION
1. Clean all previously sealed surfaces, flywheel
housing to engine, flywheel cover to flywheel
housing, and drive gear retaining bolts.
When resealing, use a noncorrosive silicone
sealer to prevent rust and corrosion of parts after
assembly.
2. Apply a bead of silicone sealer along the engine
plate, 1, to seal any gap between the plate and
the flywheel housing.
3. Align the dowel pins and install the flywheel
housing. Attach with the previously used hard-
ware and torque to 290 ft. lbs. (394 N·m).
65
4. Reinstall the starter motor assembly.
30 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
66
8. Apply a bead of silicone sealer along the contact
surface of the flywheel cover, 1, align correctly,
and install onto the flywheel housing, 2.
9. Install attaching hardware, 3, and torque to 34 ft.
lbs. (46 N·m).
10. Install drain plug, 4, and tighten.
11. Install the ground wire bundle, 5, and harness re-
taining clips where removed.
NOTE: Properly stack the ground wires according to
wire size and number of wires to single spade. Start-
ing with largest first and wire size and multiple wire
spades to single wire spades last.
67
12. Install the isolator mount, 1, hardware, and
snubber plate, 2, in the order previously re-
moved. Tighten the main mounting bolt, 3, to 165
ft. lbs. (225 N·m).
68
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 31
13. Fill the gearbox with 80/90 gear oil to the proper
level as indicated on the gearbox dipstick, 1.
69
14. Reinstall the right and left hydrostatic pumps, 1
and 2, and secure with 1/2″ x 1-1/4″ cap screws
and washers. Torque the bolts to 64 ft. lbs. (87
N·m).
15. Reconnect the rear control rods, 3, to the hydro-
static pump control arms.
16. Reinstall the case drain cross tube, 4, and the
charge pressure cross tube, 5. Reconnect the
charge pressure sender hose at 6.
70
17. Reconnect the motor case drain hose, 1; the hy-
draulic gear pump suction hose, 2; and the main
control valve pressure hose, 3.
18. Reconnect the charge pump suction hose to the
fitting at 4.
19. Connect the two-speed control valve return hose
at 5, and the control valve supply hose at 6, (if ap-
plicable).
71
32 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
72
21. Reinstall the neutralizer assembly, 5. Retain with
two bolts at the front, 3, and two bolts at the rear,
4. Reconnect the neutralizers at 2, and the dam-
pener shocks at 1.
73
START-UP PROCEDURE
1. Recheck all hydraulic/hydrostatic lines to be sure
they are tight.
2. Fill the hydraulic reservoir with API Service SH/
CG-4 10W-30 oil to the proper level, as indicated
on the back of the reservoir.
3. Install a 600 PSI (0 - 50 bar) gauge in the charge
pressure line at 1.
74
SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1 33
75
6. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
7. Turn the ignition key, 2, to the start position, and
allow the engine to crank for 30 seconds at a
time, until the pressure gauge starts to move. If
after trying three times the gauge does not move,
1
loosen the gear pump pressure line at the control
valve to bleed the air from the hydraulic system.
Recrank the engine until the gauge moves. After
the gauge moves, stop cranking and reconnect 2
the fuel solenoid wire.
8. Start the engine and monitor the charge pressure
gauge to insure charge oil to the hydrostatic sys- 19987741
77
34 SECTION 27 – REAR DRIVE AXLE (GEARBOXES) – CHAPTER 1
CONTENT
Op. 29 100
GENERAL INFORMATION
The hydrostatic system provides a means to transfer
power from the engine to the final drives and wheels.
It provides an infinite number of operator speed
selections for both forward and reverse directions.
The hydrostatic system also furnishes a means to
steer the loader.
Each of the two hydrostatic pumps receive power
from the engine through a spur gear drive configur-
ation located in the engine to transmission gearbox.
The pumps convert rotary power, developed by the
engine, to variable pressure/flow fluid power. Fluid
power is then transferred to the hydrostatic motors
where it is transferred back to rotary motion. The ro-
tary motion from the hydrostatic motors is transferred
to the final drive gearboxes, axles, and finally to the
wheels.
Hydrostatic pump flow and fluid direction is operator-
controlled by levers. Both left and right side pump
and motor configurations are operated independent-
ly of each other and power each side separately.
OPERATION
The hydrostatic system is a closed loop, fluid power
system that provides a smooth transition of power
from the engine to the wheels. The hydrostatic sys-
tem is made up of two piston pumps, 1 and two piston
motors, 2. Hydrostatic charge pressure is supplied to
the pumps by a gerotor charge pump, which is at-
tached to the right hand hydrostatic pump. This pro-
vides replenishing oil for the oil that is lost due to leak-
age for lubrication and cooling purposes.
Steering is controlled by two hand levers located in
the operator’s cab. These hand levers control the for-
ward and reverse direction and the amount of oil flow
for speed of the skid steer. The variable oil flow from 1
the pumps is a result of the rotation of the pump cam-
plates within the individual pumps. The further the
control levers are pushed from neutral, the greater
the camplate angle. More oil is then pumped to the
motors, resulting in an increase in wheel speed. The
greatest wheel torque is when the control levers are
closest to neutral. When operating the skid steer,
more power (torque), is available by destroking the
control levers, thus increasing the skid steer effi-
ciency.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 5
10
1
2 6
14 7
8
9
3
16
17
15
11
5
13
4
12
2
Hydrostatic System Components:
1. Hydraulic reservoir - Right front of engine compart- 9. Hydrostatic pump for right drive - Under operator’s
ment. seat.
2. Suction line - From the reservoir to the gear pump 10. Hydrostatic motor for right drive - Attached to the
under the operator’s seat. right gearbox assembly.
3. Pressure line - From the gear pump to the control 11. Hydrostatic pump for left drive - Under operator’s
valve. seat.
4. Return line - From the control valve to the oil cooler. 12. Hydrostatic motor for left drive - Attached to the left
5. Oil cooler - Engine side of radiator in engine com- gearbox assembly.
partment. 13. Two-Speed high/low control valve, if equipped.
6. Oil filter - After the oil cooler at the engine compart- 14. Two-Speed high/low shift cylinder, if equipped.
ment rear door. 15. Engine.
7. Charge pump suction line - From tee in the line from 16. Engine to transmission gearbox.
the oil filter to the hydrostatic charge pump. 17. Hydraulic gear pump.
8. Hydrostatic charge pump - Attached to the front of
the right hydrostatic pump.
6 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
SPECIFICATIONS
HYDROSTATIC PUMPS
Maximum Pump Case Drain . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.7 l/min. (1.5 US. GPM) per pump
HYDROSTATIC MOTORS
Charge Pump Relief Valve Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17.2 - 20.7 bar (250 - 300 PSI)
OIL REQUIREMENTS
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
PUMPS
MOTORS
OTHER MATERIALS
NOTE: Always use a noncorrosive silicone sealer to prevent damage to the components being sealed during
the silicone curing process.
8 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
LOW POWER THROUGH THE ENGINE/ b. Check for plugged fuel filters and drain water
TRANSMISSION SYSTEM trap.
Perceived low power has been noted in certain c. Check engine timing.
heavy power demand applications. Possible causes d. The injection pump calibration has not been
include: found out of range on any complaint ma-
• Machine overloaded - The bucket or attachment chines. However, it could still be a factor.
is too large for the material being handled. In most cases, engine performance has been
• Engine concerns. found acceptable, with the exception of bad fuel
or plugged fuel filters.
• The operator is not properly trained and is over-
steering the servo-controlled transmissions. 3. Machine operation has been the most significant
contributing factor. Operators tend to over-steer
1. Match the correct attachment for the material
the servo-controlled transmission in heavy
being handled. Use the bucket chart and material
power demand situations, resulting in the engine
density chart found in the attachment section of
lugging down or stopping.
the operator’s manual. It may be necessary to
weigh a bucket of material to determine the Operators must be instructed to reduce the wheel
weight being handled. speed (ground speed) by positioning the steering
levers closer to the neutral position in heavy digging,
2. Engine Concerns:
backing out of steep inclines, or turning on pave-
a. Check fuel quality and grade and replace fuel ment-type surfaces with heavy loads.
if necessary.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 11
5
12 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
7
3. Put the Service/Run switch, 1, in the “SERVICE”
position.
1
19984337
8
4. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Refer to Section 00 for more de-
tailed information on properly supporting the skid
steer.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer causing serious injury
or damage to the equipment.
9
14 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
10
6. Check the hydraulic oil level, 1, and add if re-
quired to the proper level.
WARNING
Gauges, gauge fittings, and hoses must have operat-
ing pressure ratings of at least 25% higher than the
highest pressures of the system.
Never adjust or replace the relief valves to get higher
pressures than those specified by the equipment
manufacturer. 1
Fluid under pressure can have sufficient force to pen-
etrate the skin, causing serious personal injury. Al-
ways protect the skin and eyes from escaping fluid
under pressure.
11
Before disconnecting lines or fittings, be sure to turn
off the skid steer engine and relieve all pressure. Be-
fore applying pressure to the system, be sure all con-
nections are tight and that lines, pipes, and hoses are
not damaged.
If injured by escaping fluid, obtain medical assist-
ance at once. Serious infection or reaction can devel-
op if medical treatment is not administered immedi-
ately.
Remove any attachment from the mounting plate be-
fore loosening or disconnecting any hydraulic lines.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 15
6
12
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM OIL FLOW The left hand hydrostatic pump, 4, supplies high-
pressure oil through high-pressure lines, 5, to the left
Hydrostatic Pumps and Motors High-Pressure hand hydrostatic motor, 6, when the left forward/re-
Flow verse control lever is stroked in either direction.
The hydrostatic pumps are driven by the engine The hydrostatic system is protected by four high-
through a spur gear configuration in the transmission pressure relief valves, two in each pump, one for for-
gearbox. ward and one for reverse. All four high-pressure relief
valves are the same and are factory set at 345 bar
The right hand hydrostatic pump, 1, supplies high- (5000 PSI). Do not try changing the pressure setting
pressure oil through high-pressure lines, 2, to the of these relief valves. If during testing the relief valves
right hand hydrostatic motor, 3, when the right for- are found to be incorrectly set, replace the complete
ward/reverse control lever is stroked in either direc- valve cartridge.
tion.
16 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
3
8
5
6
13
Hydrostatic Pump Charge Pressure Oil Flow Charge oil is also supplied to the Transmission
A gerotor charge pump, 1, is attached to the right Charge Pressure switch, 5, through hose 6. This
hand hydrostatic pump, 2, and provides charge pres- hose tees into the charge pressure circuit at the left
sure oil to both the right and left hand hydrostatic hand hydrostatic pump.
pumps, 2 and 3. Oil is supplied to the left hand hydro- On the two-speed skid steers, charge oil is used to
static pump through line 4. This charge oil replaces supply oil to the Hi/Low Control Valve, 7, through
oil in the high-pressure circuit that was used for lu- hose 8. This hose also tees into the charge pump cir-
brication and cooling of the internal rotating parts of cuit at the left hand hydrostatic pump.
the pumps and motors.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 17
5 6
3 8
9
14
Hydrostatic Pump and Motor Case Drain Flow drain from the pump and motor housings (cases)
(SL65B Two-Speed Shown) through the case drain lines.
NOTE: SL65B Models with fixed displacement mo- On the hydrostatic pumps, the case drain line, 1, con-
tors operate the same, without the two-speed selec- nects the right and left pumps 2 and 3. Line 4 tees into
tor valve and shift cylinder. the case drain port, 5, at the rear of the right-hand hy-
During operation of the hydrostatic pumps and mo- drostatic motor, 6. The hot case drain oil is returned
tors, oil from the high-pressure circuits used for lu- to the hydraulic system (to be cooled and filtered)
brication drains into the pump and motor housings. through the return line, 7.
The lubrication oil will fill the housings approximately Tube, 8, from the front case drain port on the left hand
half full. This oil then becomes cooling oil and will hydrostatic motor, 9, tees into the case drain port at
the hydraulic reservoir.
18 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Test Procedure
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom locks.
2. Put the SERVICE/RUN switch in the SERVICE
position.
3. Disengage the parking brake.
4. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Support the front of the skid steer
at 1, to the front of the final drive case and at 2,
to the rear of the case (tires removed for clarity).
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer causing serious injury
or damage to the equipment.
Test Procedure
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom locks.
2. Put the SERVICE/RUN switch in the SERVICE
position.
3. Engage the parking brake.
4. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer during testing causing
serious injury or damage to the equipment.
Gauge Required
0 - 690 bar (0 - 10,000 PSI)
24
The following hydrostatic pump relief valves pro-
tect the forward and reverse direction of the hy-
drostatic drive motor (tire) rotation.
Right pump controls the right motor
1 - Forward
2 - Reverse
Test Procedure
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom locks.
2. Put the SERVICE/RUN switch in the SERVICE
position.
3. Engage the parking brake.
4. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer during testing causing
serious injury or damage to the equipment.
Test Procedure
1. Remove the filler/breather cap.
2. Remove the self-tapping screws around the cap
base and screen assembly.
3. Remove the base, screen and gasket assembly,
clean all sealing surfaces.
4. Re-install new gaskets and base, taking care not
to overtighten the screws.
5. Make sure the tank has 10W-30 oil visible.
6. Pressurize the tank using an air pressure line.
The tool is equipped with a 3 PSI relief valve and
a pressure gauge. The reservoir should not be
pressurized beyond 4 PSI.
The following checks should then be performed to
trace the source of the air ingress.
• Examine the suction tubes and fittings to the hy-
draulic gear pump and the return tubes from the
filter to the reservoir.
• Examine the transmission case drain tubes/
hoses and fittings from the hydraulic motors and
pumps to the suction side of the hydraulic pump.
Also check the cam plate shaft seals and the
pump and motor casing gaskets.
• Potential leakage areas could also be input shaft
seals in the engine bell housing, gearbox or out-
put shaft seals in motors and gearboxes and the
chain case.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 27
HYDROSTATIC PUMPS
Op. 29 100 40
REMOVAL
The hydrostatic pump assemblies can be removed
from the top and front, or the cab and boom can be
tilted forward for more access. Refer to Section 00 for
the cab tilting procedure.
To remove the hydrostatic pump assembly without
tilting the cab forward:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi- 29
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
always remove the attachment from the skid steer.
19984337
30
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 29
31
6. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
33
30 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
34
11. Disconnect the dampener shocks at 1, and the
neutralizer assemblies at 2.
12. Remove the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, two at the front, 3, and two at the rear, 4. Lift
the entire neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one
piece.
35
NOTE: Clean the pumps thoroughly and mark the
hose locations to aid in reassembly.
13. Disconnect hydrostatic lines, 1 and 2, and cap
the ends.
14. Disconnect hydrostatic lines, 3 and 4, and cap
the ends.
36
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 31
2
A3649-
12 37
17. Disconnect the charge pump suction line at 1.
Remove the charge pressure cross tube, 2, and 3 2 5
the case drain tubes, 3 and 5. Disconnect the
1
charge pressure sender line at 4. Cap all lines. 7
Two-speed skid steers - If equipped, remove the
two-speed solenoid valve supply line, 6, and the 4
solenoid valve return line, 7. Cap lines.
A5358-
12 38
18. Remove the two 3/8″ gear pump attaching bolts,
1, and the gear pump assembly, 2, set aside.
Refer to Section 6, “Hydraulic Gear Pump”, for
repair information.
39
32 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
42
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 33
43
24. Loosen clamp bolt, 1, and remove control arm, 4,
and key, 3, from the servo control shaft, 2.
The right hand pump and control arm are shown. Re-
peat steps 23 and 24 for the left hand pump and con-
trol arm.
44
34 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Op. 29 100 46
DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the complete pump assembly
before teardown. Plug all ports so dirt and solvent
do not enter the pump.
The right hand hydrostatic pump consists of
these main components; charge pump adaptor
assembly, 1, backplate, 2, main pump housing,
3, and servo control assembly, 4.
45
The left hand hydrostatic pump consists of the
backplate, 1, main pump housing, 2, and servo
control assembly, 3.
NOTE: Dealer warranty adjustment requests for any
hydrostatic component repair must include the ma-
chine model, serial numbers, transmission model
number, and date codes. These codes are stamped
into the servo control end cap.
The following disassembly instructions apply to
the right hand hydrostatic pump, with gerotor
charge pump. When disassembling the left hand
pump, disregard steps concerning the charge
pump.
2. To ensure proper reassembly, mark the relation- 46
ship between the servo control assembly, charge
pump adaptor assembly, and main pump hous-
ing with a marker or scribe.
3. As the pump is being overhauled, lay the parts on
a clean wooden bench top or heavy cardboard to
prevent damage to the machined surfaces.
4. Position the pump into a protected jaw vise,
clamping onto the outer portion of the mounting
flange with the cap screws of the gerotor charge
pump facing up.
5. Remove the four cap screws, 1, and tap the
housings with a plastic or rubber mallet to separ-
ate the two pumps. Lift the charge pump adaptor
assembly straight up off the shaft and backplate.
The gerotor may stay in the adaptor or on the
backplate.
47
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 35
DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the charge pump to prevent
contamination of internal parts.
2. Remove two cap screws, 1, cover plate, 3, and
O ring, 2.
48
3. Remove the inner gerotor ring, 3, the outer gero-
tor ring, 1, and molded O ring, 2.
If the inner gerotor ring, 3, stays on the shaft, re-
move it and the drive key. If not, remove the drive
key and set with the charge pump assembly.
49
4. Remove the relief valve assembly which consists
of: plug, 1, O ring, 2, shims, 3, spring, 4, and
poppet, 5.
5. The needle bearings, 6, are a press fit in the
adapter housing. Do not remove at this time un-
less the bearing is loose in the housing or if there
are loose, damaged or missing needles.
50
36 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
PARTS INSPECTION
1. Clean all parts with a suitable solvent.
2. Inspect the relief valve seat inside the charge
pump adaptor housing at 1. Check to make sure
that the seat is smooth and free from burrs or
other defects.
3. Inspect the relief valve poppet, 2, for damage and
scratches in the seat contact area. Also check to
make sure the relief valve spring, 3, is not broken.
51
4. The shaft needle bearing assembly, 1, is a press
fit in the charge pump adaptor housing and
should not be loose. Inspect for looseness.
Check for loose or missing needles in the bearing
housing.
Remove bearing assembly if any problems are
found.
52
5. Check the gerotor pocket, 1, inside the charge
pump adaptor assembly, the inner gerotor ring,
2, and the outer gerotor ring, 3, for scoring and
excessive wear.
6. All seals should be replaced upon reassembly.
7. Inspect the drive key for wear or partial shearing.
53
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 37
REASSEMBLY
1. Use a suitable solvent to thoroughly clean all
parts. Lay the parts on a clean cardboard and air
dry.
2. Use a clean 10W-30 oil to lubricate all moving
parts as they are reassembled.
3. If necessary, press a new bearing into the 2.41
adaptor assembly. The bearing should be in- mm
stalled with the numbered end, 1, facing outward (0.095,)
and closest to the mounting flange, 2. The gero-
tor pocket is located at 3. Install to a dimension
of 2.41 mm (0.095″).
54
4. Install the relief valve poppet, 1, spring, 2, shims,
3, and plug, 4, with new O ring, into the adaptor
assembly. Torque the plug to 37 - 41 N·m (27 - 30
ft. lbs.).
55
5. Lubricate both a new molded O ring, 2, and the
outer gerotor ring, 1; install in adaptor assembly.
Upon reassembly to the main pump housing, the
inner gerotor ring, 3, and drive key will be in-
stalled on the pump shaft prior to installing the
charge pump adaptor assembly.
6. The four retaining cap screws are torqued to 37
- 42 N·m (27 - 31 ft. lbs.).
56
38 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Op. 29 100 46
HYDROSTATIC PUMP
DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the complete pump assembly
prior to teardown; plug ports so dirt and solvent
do not enter the pump.
After removal of the charge pump adaptor as-
sembly, described earlier, the main pump con-
sists of these main components: charge pump
backplate, 1, pump body, 2, and servo control as-
sembly, 3.
57
The backplates carry high-pressure oil from the
pumps to the motors via high-pressure hoses.
The low-pressure return oil from the motors flows
back to the pumps through the backplates to
complete the closed loop circuit.
NOTE: Dealer warranty adjustment requests for any
hydrostatic component repair must include the ma-
chine model, serial numbers, transmission model
number, and date codes. These codes are stamped
into the servo control end cap.
2. To ensure proper reassembly, mark the relation-
ship between the backplate, pump body and
servo control assembly with a marker or scribe.
3. As the pump is being overhauled, lay the parts on
a clean wooden bench top of heavy carboard to
prevent damage to the machined surfaces.
4. With the pump still clamped in a protected jaw
vise and the charge pump adaptor assembly re-
moved, lift the backplate, 1, straight up and off
the shaft and housing.
58
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 39
59
6. Mark the position of the two relief valves to aid in
reassembly.
7. Remove the relief valve assemblies, 1 and 4. O
rings, 5 and 6, on the relief valves, should be re-
moved and replaced on reassembly.
8. Remove retaining ring, 2, and plug, 3, from the
backplate assembly.
60
9. To remove the rotating group, 1, from the hous-
ing, set the edge of the housing on a 2 x 4 or 4 x
4 block and tilt the open end of the housing down.
Turn the rotating piston block and pull it out as a
complete unit without scratching or burring the
parts.
NOTE: Keep the rotating group as an assembly at
this time.
61
40 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
62
11. The pump drive shaft, 1, can be removed by
doing the following:
a. Remove the large retaining ring, 2.
b. Use an arbor press or tap the internally
splined end of the shaft with a soft faced
mallet to remove the drive shaft.
c. Remove seal, 3, and washer, 4. The seal
may be damaged during removal.
63
12. Remove both retaining rings, 1, thrust washers,
2, and thrust bearing, 3, from drive shaft, 4.
Set all drive shaft components aside for inspec-
tion.
64
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 41
65
14. Remove the six socket head cap screws, 2, and
the manual servo control assembly, 1.
66
15. Remove the servo control assembly gasket, 1.
Note the position of the alignment tab, 2, on both
the gasket and the servo control housing, for
proper installation of the gasket during reas-
sembly.
67
42 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
16. Remove the four socket head cap screws and flat
washers, 1, from the servo piston cover plate.
Remove the cover plate, 2, and gasket, 3. Re-
move the four remaining socket head cap screws
and washers from the cover plate at the opposite
end of the servo piston at 4.
68
17. To remove the cover plate, 1, from the servo pis-
ton bolt, 2, remove jam nut, 3, washer, 4, and seal
washer, 5. Hold the servo piston bolt, 2, with an
allen wrench and unscrew the cover plate off the
bolt. Remove gasket, 6.
69
18. Use a wooden hammer handle to push the servo
piston, 1, from the pump housing, 2.
Remove the two servo piston seal assemblies, 3,
from the pump housing, 2.
Disassembly of the servo piston assembly is not
required.
CAUTION
Do not disassemble the servo piston, personal injury
may occur. An internal spring inside the piston as-
sembly is under pressure.
70
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 43
PARTS INSPECTION
Clean all parts in a suitable solvent and air dry.
Pump Housing
1. The shaft needle bearing assembly, 1, in the
pump housing, is a press fit, and should not be
loose. Inspect for looseness. Check that all
needles are in the cage and move freely. Inspect
the needles for wear or damage.
The bearing is shown with the numbered end, 1,
facing out toward the flange end of the housing,
2.
71
2. Verify that the bearing is positioned correctly and
to the dimension shown.
3. Remove the shaft needle bearing assembly if
any problems are found. Install a new bearing in
the housing with the numbered end, 1, facing out
toward the flange end of the housing, 2. Install to
the dimension shown.
1.78
mm
(0.07,)
72
Servo Control and Piston
1. Inspect the servo piston, 1, and housing, 2, for
scratches. All seals and gaskets should be re-
placed at reassembly.
73
44 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Cradle Assembly
1. Inspect the cradle bushing, 1, for contamination
embedded in the bushing surface from contact
with the camplate.
2. If contamination is found, remove button head
cap screw, 2, and remove cradle bushing. Re-
place bushing.
3. If bushing is replaced, torque the button head cap
screw to 1.6 - 1.8 N·m (14 - 16 in. lbs).
74
Pump Shaft
1. Inspect the areas that contact the shaft needle
bearings, 1, for wear or a rough bearing surface.
2. Check for a bent or worn shaft.
3. Check the spline areas, 2, for wear or twist.
4. Check the thrust bearing, 3, races, 4, and retain-
ing rings and grooves, 5. If bearing or races show
wear or roughness, they must be replaced.
75
5. Input seal, 1, will be replaced upon reassembly.
6. Inspect retaining ring, 2, and washer, 3.
76
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 45
Camplate
1. Shoes of the pump pistons rotate at high speeds 1
against the camplate surface, 1. The surface
must be smooth with no metal flaked away and
no scoring. Circular scratches centered on the
machined surface are due to contamination. If
scratches can be felt with your thumbnail, re-
place the camplate.
2. Check the camplate surface for smearing. The
surface must be smooth and bright with no disco-
loration or brass color on the flat surface.
77
3. Check the camplate bushing surface, 1, for wear
and transfer of coating from the cradle bushing.
Replace if necessary.
4. Inspect the lubrication ports, 2, for blockage.
Clean thoroughly.
5. Inspect the servo piston follower, 3, and aligning
pin, 4, for wear.
78
Shoe and Piston Assemblies
Shoe Plate
1. Check for cracks and wear at the holes for the
spherical washer and shoes at 1. The shoe plate
is only available as part of the rotating group.
2. Check for wear in the area of the slippers, 2. This
area should be flat, smooth, and have no
grooves.
3. Check the internal splines of the piston block, 3,
for wear.
Spherical Washer (pivot), 4.
1. Check for wear on the top surface where the
shoe plate fits. The spherical washer is only
available as part of the rotating group.
80
2. Check the sides, rolled area for cracks.
Rotating Piston Block 4.
81
Loading Pins
82
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 47
83
Back Plate
1. Check the back plate for flatness, 1.
2. The back plate needle bearing assembly, 2, is a
press fit and should not be loose. Inspect for
looseness and wear. Check that all needles are
in the cage and move freely.
84
3. Verify that the needle bearing, 1, is positioned
correctly and to the dimension shown.
4. Remove the needle bearing if any problems are
found. Install a new bearing in the housing with
the numbered end, 3, toward the valve plate. In-
stall to dimension of 2.29 mm (0.09″ ) above the 2.29 4.39
surface of the back plate as shown. The bearing mm mm
is used as a pilot for the valve plate. (0.09,) (0.173,)
5. Check the back plate roll pin, 2. If the pin is tight
and set to the dimension shown, replacement is
not required.
85
48 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
86
9. Check the relief valves for scratches in the seat
areas, 1. Also check for broken springs, 2. If
problems are found, the complete relief valve
must be replaced.
87
LS190 skid steers only - Inspect the splines, 1, of the
coupler for wear or damage. Remove the inside snap
ring, 2, and inspect for damage. Replace if necess-
ary. (The coupler is part #86566800 and the snap ring
is part #49894.)
19987697
88
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 49
19987698
89
REASSEMBLY
1. Use a suitable solvent to thoroughly clean all
parts. Lay the parts on a clean cardboard and air
dry.
IMPORTANT: Due to tight tolerances and finish of in-
ternal pump surfaces, it is very important to maintain
absolute cleanliness during reassembly.
2. Use clean SAE 10W-30 oil to lubricate all moving
parts as they are being reassembled. Fill the
transmission cases with oil through the case
drain hole after completing assembly of the com-
ponent.
IMPORTANT: Lubrication of the pump components
during assembly is required to ensure lubrication oil
for start-up.
3. Install the new O rings, seals, gaskets, and re-
taining rings provided with the repair kit.
4. If required and not done during inspection, install
new needle bearings in the pump housing and
backplate. Installation details are shown in the in-
spection area.
5. Install two new seal sub-assemblies, 1, into the
servo piston housing at 2.
6. Install the servo piston assembly, 3, into the right
hand side of the housing by inserting end, 4, first.
Roughly center the piston in the housing.
90
50 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
91
8. To obtain neutral, centering of the servo piston is
required.
a. Insert an allen wrench into the servo piston 12.7
bolt, 1, on the right hand side. mm
b. Measure in from the left hand side of the (0.5,)
housing, 2, and turn the servo piston bolt, 1,
either in or out to obtain a measurement from
the face of the housing to the servo piston of
12.7 mm (0.5″).
c. While holding the bolt steady, tighten jam nut,
3, to 17 - 18 N·m (150 - 160 in lbs.).
92
9. Install a new LH servo piston cover plate gasket,
1, and cover plate, 2. Align the gasket with the
cover plate and retain with four flat washers and
socket head cap screws, 3. Torque to 4.5 - 5.4
N·m (40 - 48 in lbs.).
93
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 51
94
11. Reassemble the pump drive shaft bearing as-
sembly by installing retaining ring, 1, in groove,
6. Next install thrust washer, 2; thrust bearing, 3;
and second thrust washer, 4. Secure assembly
with second retaining ring, 5, in groove, 7.
95
12. Install the shaft and bearing assembly, 1, into the
pump housing. Install washer, 2, and new shaft
seal, 3. Seat seal into position with a seal driver
and secure with retaining ring, 4.
96
52 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
13. Camplate
a. Reinstall the servo piston follower, 1, onto the
camplate aligning pin, 2.
97
b. Coat the cradle bushing, 1, previously in-
stalled with the cradle assembly in the pump
housing, with SAE 10W-30 oil.
c. Carefully align the servo piston follower with
the notch in the pump housing opening, 2,
and slide the camplate into the pump hous-
ing.
d. Make certain that the servo piston follower, 1,
Figure 97, on the camplate is aligned with the
large groove in the servo piston assembly, 3,
to ensure correct positioning of the camplate.
98
14. Check the three piston block loading pins, 1.
Make sure they are seated properly in the over-
size grooves in the splines and held in place by
the retaining ring, 2.
99
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 53
100
16. With the pump housing resting on its side, insert
the piston block assembly into the housing. Ro-
tate the piston block slowly to align the splines
and slide together.
NOTE: Check to be sure that the camplate is still
positioned correctly in the housing and that the piston
shoes contact the camplate before proceeding.
NOTE: If the rotating group assembly will not easily
slide over the splined shaft, DO NOT FORCE. One
or more of the three loading pins may be out of their
groove or the pin head is not seated properly be-
tween the washer and block. Forcing the rotating
group may cause pin failure and early transmission
failure.
IMPORTANT: Make sure all mating surfaces are well
lubricated with SAE 10W-30 motor oil to insure
proper lubrication for start-up.
17. Install new O rings on the relief valve assemblies,
1, and install the valves at their original positions
in the backplate at 2.
18. Install a new O ring on plug, 3; install plug, and
secure with retaining ring, 4.
101
54 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
102
20. Clamp the pump assembly in a protected jaw
vise at the pilot flange, 1, with the open end up.
Install a new gasket, 2, between the pump hous-
ing and backplate, and slide the backplate, 3,
down over the shaft. Make sure the ports are
positioned correctly and the gasket and valve
plate are aligned.
103
NOTE: With no gerotor pump, go to step 23.
21. Install the gerotor pump drive key and inner gero-
tor ring, 1, onto the pump shaft. Lubricate the
inner gerotor ring.
22. Install the charge pump adaptor assembly, 2,
onto the pump housing. Make sure the molded O
ring, 3, stays in place and that the inner and outer
gerotor rings, 1 and 4, are properly aligned.
104
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 55
105
NOTE: When the backplate assembly, 1, is in place,
and prior to inserting bolts, a small gap (approx. 1/8,) 1
will be noticed between the pump housing gasket
and backplate at 2. This is normal. Tightening the
bolts brings the housing against the rotating group
spring, resulting in an internal spring load to the valve
plate and slippers. After torquing the retaining bolts,
the shaft should turn easily with a pair of 8, pliers. The 2
shaft should have some rolling resistance but should
not be tight (locked down) or rotate easily. If it is
locked down or rotates freely, the pump is assembled
incorrectly and requires teardown and reassembly.
106
25. Install the servo control assembly, 1, and new
servo control gasket, 2, onto the pump housing,
making sure the feedback link, 3, aligns with the
small groove in the servo piston.
NOTE: Make sure the tabs, 4, on both the servo con-
trol housing, 1, and gasket, 2, are aligned. Also note
the position of the gasket over the control ports, 5.
26. Retain the servo control assembly with six (6)
socket head cap screws. Torque to 5 - 8 N·m (4
- 6 ft lbs).
27. Install new O rings on all pump plugs. Install
plugs into pump housing. Torque to the following
specs:
3/4″ Plugs: 28 - 32 N·m (21 - 24 ft. lbs.) 107
1-1/4″ Plugs: 54 - 61 N·m (40 - 45 ft. lbs.)
56 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
108
29. Install inner retaining ring, 3, drive gear, 2, and
outer retaining ring, 1, onto pump drive shaft, 4.
30. Install the pumps onto the engine bell housing at-
taching plate, using 1/2″ x 1-1/4″ cap screws and
washers. Torque to 87 N·m (64 ft. lbs.).
109
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 57
REINSTALLATION
1. Install a new O ring, 1, on the gear pump pilot, 2.
For SL65B skid steers, install the gear pump onto 1
the hydrostatic pump, mating the splines on the
input shaft. 2
19987701
110
58 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
116
3. Connect the charge pump suction line, 1, the
charge pressure cross tube, 2, the case drain 3 2 5
tube, 3, the charge pressure sender line, 4, and
1
the case drain tube, 5. 7
If equipped, connect the two-speed solenoid
valve supply line, 6, and the solenoid valve return 4
line, 7.
A5358-
12 117
4. Connect the rear control rods, 1 and 2, at the
pump control arms. 1
Connect the hydraulic suction hose, 3, the hy-
draulic high pressure hose, 4.
If equipped, connect the two-speed slave cylin-
der supply hose, 5. 4 5
2
A3649-
12 118
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 59
119
6. Lower the entire neutralizer assembly into place.
Reconnect the dampener shocks, 1, and neutral-
izer assemblies, 2.
Install the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, 3 and 4.
120
7. Make sure the return line, 1, is installed into the
tee, 2, connecting to the hydraulic reservoir.
Reinstall all shields and fittings removed during
hydrostatic pump removal.
121
60 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Op. 29 100 60
MOTORS
HYDROSTATIC MOTOR - SINGLE SPEED
REMOVAL
The hydrostatic motor assembly can be removed
from the top and front or the cab and boom can be
tilted forward for more access, refer to Section 00 for
the cab tilting procedure.
To remove the hydrostatic motor assembly without
tilting the cab forward:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
always remove the attachment from the skid steer.
19984337
123
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 61
124
6. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
125
7. Remove the step shield, 1, to access the hydro-
static pump and motor area. For more access, re-
move the right or left hydrostatic control handle
assembly, 2 or 3.
8. Relieve all pressure in the hydraulic and hydro-
static systems.
CAUTION
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system to avoid serious injury.
126
62 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
127
10. Drain the hydraulic reservoir by disconnecting
the return line, 1, at tee, 2, and drain the oil into
a suitable container.
128
11. Disconnect the dampener shocks at 1, and the
neutralizer assemblies at 2.
12. Remove the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, two at front, 3, and two at rear, 4. Lift the en-
tire neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one piece.
129
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 63
130
14. Clean the motors, 1, high-pressure hoses, 2, and
case drain tube, located under the motors, and
mark their positions to aid in reassembly.
15. Remove the high-pressure hoses, 2, and case 4
drain lines, 3, from the motor and cap to prevent
loss of oil. Plug the motor ports to prevent dirt
from entering the motor housing. 3
16. Unbolt and remove the motor from the gearbox
assembly, 4. Make sure the parking brake is en- 3
gaged. This will hold the brake components in
place for easier reassembly.
4
131
64 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Op. 29 100 66
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: Dealer warranty adjustment requests for oil 2
leak repairs, other repairs, or overhaul of the motor
must include the model number of the motor and date
code. These are stamped into the mounting flange of
the motor housing at 1.
1. Thoroughly clean the outside of the motor hous-
ing before disassembly. Plug the ports to prevent
dirt and solvent from entering the motor housing.
2. To ensure proper reassembly, mark the relation- 1
19986361
ship between the motor housing and backplate
with a marker or scribe, 2. 132
3. As the motor is being overhauled, lay the parts on
a clean wooden bench or heavy cardboard to
prevent damage to the machined surfaces.
4. Clamp the motor in a protected jaw vise at the
mounting flange. Remove the six cap screws, 1,
from the backplate assembly, 2, and lift the back-
plate straight up from the housing to prevent
damage to the shaft and bearings.
NOTE: The backplate assembly should pop up with
the removal of the six cap screws. If the plate does
not pop up, use a plastic mallet and tap on the back-
plate to remove.
IMPORTANT: The motor housing is aluminum and
can be easily damaged. Do not use sharp objects to
pry the backplate from the housing or damage to the
machined surfaces may occur.
133
5. Remove valve plate, 1, and O ring, 3, from the
backplate, 2. Note the position of the valve plate
for reassembly.
134
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 65
135
7. The rotating group consists of the following parts:
a. Piston block, 1.
b. Spherical washer, 2 (spider pivot).
c. Piston assemblies, 3.
d. Piston plate, 4 (spider).
Carefully disassemble these parts and lay them
on cardboard to avoid damage.
136
8. Remove camplate, 1.
137
66 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
138
10. Remove shaft seal, 1, and washer, 2, from motor
shaft, 3. The motor shaft, thrust bearing assem-
bly, consists of two retaining rings, 4, two thrust
washers, 5, and thrust bearing, 6. Disassemble
these parts for inspection.
139
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 67
PARTS INSPECTION
Clean all parts in a suitable solvent and air dry prior
to inspection.
IMPORTANT: Due to close tolerances and finish of
motor internal surfaces, it is important to maintain ab-
solute cleanliness during inspection and reassembly
or damage to the components may occur.
Motor Housing
1. The shaft needle bearing, 1, in the motor housing
is a press fit and should not be loose. Inspect for
looseness. Check that all needles are in the cage
and move freely.
2. If no problems are found, there is no need to re-
140
place the bearing.
Motor Shaft
1. Inspect the ares that contact the shaft needle
bearings, 1, for wear or a rough bearing surface.
2. Check for a bent or worn shaft.
3. Check the splined areas, 2, for wear or twist.
4. Inspect the thrust bearing, 3, bearing races, 4,
and retaining rings and grooves, 5. If bearing or
races show wear or roughness, they must be re-
placed.
141
5. Input seal, 1, and retaining ring, 2, will be re-
placed upon reassembly. Inspect washer, 3, for
wear and flatness.
142
68 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Camplate
1. Shoes of the motor pistons rotate at high speeds
against the camplate surface at, 1. The surface
must be smooth with no metal flaked away and
no scoring. Circular scratches centered on the
machined surface are due to contamination. If
scratches can be felt with your thumbnail, re-
place the camplate.
2. Check the camplate surface for smearing. The
surface must be smooth and bright with no disco-
loration or brass color on the flat surface.
143
Shoe and Piston Assemblies
146
Loading Pins
The three block loading pins, 1, are spring loaded
and are held in place by the pin keeper (split bush-
ing), 2.
1. The pins should be the same height.
2. The pins should be seated in the special grooves.
3. The head of the pins should be seated between
the washer and the block.
147
Replaceable Bearing (Valve) Plate
1. Check for flatness.
2. Check for scratches on the brass side of the
plate, extending outward across the area where
the raised area of the piston block contacts the
plate at 1. If scratches can be felt with your
thumbnail, replace the bearing plate.
3. Check for scratches between the kidney ports at
2.
148
70 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Backplate
1. Check the backplate for flatness, 1.
2. The backplate needle bearing assembly, 2, is a
press fit and should not be loose. Inspect for
looseness and wear. Check that all needles are
in the cage and move freely.
3. If no problems are found, there is no need to re-
place the bearing.
4. Check the alignment pins to make sure they are
in place.
149
Shuttle Flow Valves
1. Remove the shuttle valves. Inspect the spool, 1,
seats, 2, and springs, 3, for damage.
IMPORTANT: Do not adjust the recirculate valve
screw assembly, 4.
3 2 1 2 3
19986350
150
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 71
REASSEMBLY
1. Use a suitable solvent to thoroughly clean all
parts. Lay the parts on a clean cardboard and air
dry.
IMPORTANT: Due to tight tolerances and finish of
motor internal surfaces, it is very important to main-
tain absolute cleanliness during reassembly.
2. Use a clean SAE 10W-30 oil to lubricate all mov-
ing parts as they are being reassembled.
3. Install the new O ring, seal and retaining rings in-
cluded with the repair kit.
4. Motor Housing
a. If required, install a new needle bearing, 1, in
the motor housing with the numbered end to-
ward the outside (flange end) of the housing.
151
b. Install the bearing with the numbered end, 1,
facing out towards the mounting flange end
of the motor housing, 2. Press into place and
to the dimension shown, 1.78 mm (0.07″).
NOTE: When installing bearings in the housing or
backplate, be careful not to damage the outer bear-
ing race. If the outer race is damaged, early bearing
and shaft failures could occur.
1.78
mm
(0.07,)
152
72 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
153
6. Install the shaft and bearing assembly, 1, into the
motor housing. Install the washer and new shaft
seal, 2, into the housing and set in place with a
seal driver. Secure the shaft in place with a new
retaining ring, 3.
154
7. Install the camplate, 1, into the motor housing, 2,
in the direction indicated on the camplate.
155
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 73
156
9. Invert the motor housing, 2, and insert the rotat-
ing group assembly, 1, into the housing.
NOTE: Piston shoes must contact the camplate. Be
sure all parts are in their proper position before pro-
ceeding.
NOTE: If the rotating group assembly will not easily
slide over the splined shaft, DO NOT FORCE. One
or more of the three loading pins may be out of their
groove or the pin head is not seated properly be-
tween the washer and block. Forcing the rotating
group may cause pin failure and early transmission
failure.
IMPORTANT: Make sure all mating surfaces are well
lubricated with SAE 10W-30 motor oil to insure 157
proper lubrication for start-up.
10. Backplate
a. If required, install a new needle bearing, 1, in
the backplate. The bearing should be in-
stalled with the numbered end facing the
center of the motor assembly.
158
74 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
159
11. Lubricate the valve plate, 1, and place the steel
side toward the backplate. Align one of the
notches on the outer edge of the valve plate with
alignment pin, 2. The brass side of the valve plate
should be next to the piston block when as-
sembled.
To assist in reassembly, place a small amount of
vaseline between the valve plate and the back
plate to hold the two pieces together.
12. Install a new O ring, 3, over the backplate flange
at 4.
160
13. Clamp the motor housing and rotating group in a
protected jaw vise and carefully install the back-
plate assembly onto the shaft. Match your align-
ment marks and dowel pin. Secure with six cap
screws and torque to 20 - 24 N·m (15 - 18 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: When the backplate assembly is in place and
prior to inserting bolts, a small gap (approx. 1/8,) will
be noticed between the motor housing and the back-
plate at 1. This is normal. Tightening the bolts brings
the housing against the rotating group spring, result-
ing in an internal spring load to the valve plate and
slippers. After torquing the retaining bolts, the shaft
should turn easily with a pair of 8, pliers. The shaft
should have some rolling resistance but should not
161
be tight (locked down) or rotate easily. If it is locked
down or rotates freely, the motor is assembled incor-
rectly and requires teardown and reassembly.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 75
REINSTALLATION
1. Clean the previously sealed surfaces between
the motor flange and gearbox at 1. 1 2
When resealing, use a noncorrosive silicone
sealer to prevent rust and corrosion to parts after
assembled.
2. Place a bead of New Holland Ultra-Blue silicone
sealer around the face of the motor housing.
3. Align the motor assembly splines with the 1 2
coupler splines in the gearbox, and slide the
motor shaft into the gearbox. Install two 1/2″ x
1-1/4″ cap screws and washers, 2, and torque to
101 N·m (75 ft. lbs.). A3549-
10 162
4. Reinstall motor fittings if removed.
5. Install the neutralizer support bracket, 1, and se-
cure with four attaching bolts, 2, two at each
gearbox.
6. Reinstall the case drain tube that runs beneath
the motor assemblies. The tube connects at the
front of the left motor at 3, and at the rear of the
right motor at 4. A hose assembly connects the
tee fitting at the rear of the right motor, 4, and the
inlet fitting of the gear pump.
7. Reconnect the high-pressure hydraulic hose, 5,
between the gear pump and the main control
valve.
163
8. Install the neutralizer assembly, 1, and secure
with four cap screws, 2; two at the front and two
at the rear.
9. Install the high-pressure hydrostatic hoses, 3,
from the pumps to the motors and tighten secure-
ly. When tightening fittings, first align hoses and
tubes for clearance and tighten to seat fittings,
then loosen and retorque.
164
76 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
165
12. For neutral adjustment, refer to the “Control Link-
age” section of this manual for the proper pro-
cedure and adjustments.
13. After a rebuild of any hydraulic or hydrostatic
component, refer to the “Start-Up Procedure”
section of this manual for the correct start-up pro-
cedure.
14. Put the Service/Run switch in the “SERVICE”
position.
15. Operate the unit and check for oil leaks and re-
pair if needed.
CAUTION
Securely support the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground, or movement of the skid steer may
cause serious injury or damage to the equipment.
16. Tilt the cab and boom back into position, if tilted
forward.
17. Reinstall the step shield, 1, fenders, etc., re-
moved for the repair.
18. Fill the hydraulic system (reservoir) with SAE
10W-30 oil.
166
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 77
19984337
168
78 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
169
6. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
170
7. Remove the step shield, 1, to access the hydro-
static pump and motor area. For more access, re-
move the right or left hydrostatic control handle
assembly, 2 or 3.
8. Relieve all pressure in the hydraulic and hydro-
static systems.
CAUTION
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system to avoid serious injury.
171
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 79
172
10. Drain the hydraulic reservoir by disconnecting
the return line, 1, at tee, 2, and drain the oil into
a suitable container.
173
11. Disconnect the dampener shocks at, 1, and the
neutralizer assemblies at, 2.
12. Remove the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, two at front, 3, and two at rear, 4. Lift the en-
tire neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one piece.
174
80 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
1
A3625-
14 175
15. Disconnect the hydraulic line from the two-speed
control valve, 1, to the rear of the slave cylinder, 1
2, and cap. 2
16. Disconnect the high pressure hydraulic hose, 3,
from the gear pump, 4, to the main control valve,
6
5, and cap.
17. Remove the slave cylinder, 2, and control link, 6.
Loosen and disconnect the control arm spring, 7, 4
at the rear control arm. 3
5
7
A3622-
4 176
18. Remove the front and rear control arms, 1 and 2.
These arms are attached to a tapered camplate
shaft and should be removed using a puller ar- 4
rangement as shown at 3.
NOTE: The holes, 4, in both motor cam plate arms
may be tapped and a cap screw used to remove
arms.
177
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 81
178
20. Remove the case drain hoses, 1, by loosening
the hose clamps, 2. 2
21. Unbolt and remove the motors from the gearbox
assembly. Make sure the parking brake is en-
gaged. This will hold the brake components in 1
place for easier reassembly.
1 2
A5358-
12 179
82 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Op. 29 100 66
DISASSEMBLY
1
NOTE: Dealer warranty adjustment requests for oil
leak repairs, other repairs, or overhaul of the motor
must include the model number of the motor and date
code. These are stamped into the mounting flange of
the motor housing at 1.
1. Thoroughly clean the outside of the motor hous-
ing before disassembly. Plug the ports to prevent
dirt and solvent from entering the motor housing.
2. To ensure proper reassembly, mark the relation-
ship between the motor housing and backplate 19986349
with a marker or scribe.
180
3. As the motor is being overhauled, lay the parts on
a clean wooden bench or heavy cardboard to
prevent damage to the machined surfaces.
4. Clamp the motor in a protected jaw vise at the
mounting flange, 1. Remove the four cap screws,
1
2, from the backplate assembly, 3, and lift the
backplate straight up from the housing to prevent
damage to the shaft and bearing.
NOTE: The backplate assembly should pop up with
the removal of the six cap screws. If the plate does
2
not pop up, use a plastic mallet and tap on the back-
plate to remove.
IMPORTANT: The motor housing is aluminum and 3
can be easily damaged. Do not use sharp objects to
pry the backplate from the housing or damage to the
machined surfaces may occur. 19986349
181
5. Remove the valve plate, 1, from backplate, 2.
Note the position of the valve plate for reassemb-
ly.
The valve plate may stick to the rotating group
when the backplate is removed.
182
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 83
183
7. Hold the rotating piston block, 1, in one hand and
tilt the open end of the motor housing, 2, down.
Rotate the piston block and pull it out as a com-
plete unit without scratching or burring the parts.
184
8. The rotating group consists of the following parts:
a. Piston block, 1.
b. Wave washer, 2.
c. Spherical washer, 3 (spider pivot).
d. Piston assemblies, 4.
e. Piston plate, 5 (spider).
Lift the rotating group parts out of the piston block
and carefully lay them on clean cardboard to
avoid damage. Mark the holes the pistons came
from with a soft marker (do not scratch the sur-
face) so they can be inspected and reassembled
in the same manner.
185
84 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
186
10. Remove the outer shaft seal, 1, and washer, 2,
from the motor drive shaft, 3.
187
11. The motor shaft, thrust bearing assembly, con-
sists of two retaining rings, 1, two thrust washers,
2, and a thrust bearing, 3. Disassemble these
parts for inspection.
188
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 85
12. Camplate
To remove the camplate from the motor housing:
a. Remove the two torx head screws, 1, seal
cover plate, 2, and gasket, 3, on the pintle
shaft side of the camplate.
b. Remove pintle shaft seal, 4, and washer, 5,
located behind the seal.
189
c. Remove the two torx head screws, 1, trun-
nion cover plate, 2, and gasket, 3, on the stub
shaft end of the camplate.
d. Remove the O ring cover, 4, and O ring, 5, lo-
cated behind the O ring cover.
190
e. Remove needle bearing, 1, and inner race, 2,
on the stub shaft end of the camplate, and
needle bearing, 3, on the pintle shaft end, by
sliding the camplate back and forth until the
bearings can be grasped. The bearings are
not a press fit and should be fairly easy to re-
move.
f. Remove the camplate, stub shaft end first.
NOTE: A bearing race is not used on the pintle shaft
end of the camplate.
191
86 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
PARTS INSPECTION
Clean all parts in a suitable solvent and air dry prior
to inspection.
IMPORTANT: Due to close tolerances and finish of
motor internal surfaces, it is important to maintain ab-
solute cleanliness during inspection and reassembly
or damage to the components may occur.
Motor Housing
1. The shaft needle bearing, 1, in the motor housing
is a press fit and should not be loose. Inspect for
looseness. Check that all needles are in the cage
and move freely.
2. If no problems are found, there is no need to re-
place the bearing.
192
Camplate
1. Shoes of the motor pistons rotate at high speeds
against the camplate surface at 1. The surface
must be smooth with no metal flaked away and
no scoring. Circular scratches centered on the
machined surface are due to contamination. If
scratches can be felt with your thumbnail, re-
place the camplate.
2. Check the camplate surface for smearing. The
surface must be smooth and bright with no disco-
loration or brass color on the flat surfaces.
3. Inspect the areas that contact the camplate
needle bearings, 2, for wear or a rough bearing
surface. 193
4. Inspect the camplate bearings for loose or mis-
sing needles in the bearing housing. Replace if
necessary.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 87
Motor Shaft
1. Inspect the areas that contact the shaft needle
bearings, 1, for wear or a rough bearing surface.
2. Check for a bent or worn shaft.
3. Check the splined areas, 2, for wear or twist.
4. Inspect the thrust bearing, 3, bearing races, 4,
and retaining rings and grooves, 5. If the bear-
ings or races show wear or roughness, they must
be replaced.
194
Shoe and Piston Assemblies
197
Loading Pins
The three block loading pins, 1, are spring loaded
and are held in place by the pin keeper (split bush-
ing), 2.
1. The pins should be the same height.
2. The pins should be seated in the special grooves.
3. The head of the pins should be seated between
the washer and the block.
Wave Washer
Inspect the wave washer, 3, for bent or broken tabs.
198
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 89
199
Backplate
1. Check the backplate for flatness, 1.
2. The backplate needle bearing assembly, 2, is a
press fit and should not be loose. Inspect for
looseness and wear. Check that all needles are
in the cage and move freely.
3. If no problems are found, there is no need to re-
place the bearing.
4. Check the alignment pin, 3, to make sure it is in
place.
200
Shuttle Flow Valves
1. Remove the shuttle valves. Inspect the spool, 1,
seats, 2, and springs, 3, for damage.
4
IMPORTANT: Do not adjust the recirculate valve
screw assembly, 4. 3
3
2
2 1
19986362
201
90 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
REASSEMBLY
1. Use a suitable solvent to thoroughly clean all
parts. Lay the parts on a clean cardboard and air
dry.
IMPORTANT: Due to tight tolerances and finish of
motor internal surfaces, it is very important to main-
tain absolute cleanliness during reassembly.
2. Use a clean SAE 10W-30 oil to lubricate all mov-
ing parts as they are being reassembled.
3. Install the new O ring, seals, gasket and retaining
rings included with the repair kit.
4. Motor Housing
a. If required, install a new needle bearing, 1, in
the motor housing with the numbered end to-
ward the outside (flange end) of the housing.
202
b. Install the bearing with the numbered end, 1,
facing out towards the mounting flange end
of the motor housing, 2. Press into place and
to the dimension shown, 1.78 mm (0.07″).
NOTE: When installing bearings in the housing or
backplate, be careful not to damage the outer bear-
ing race. If the outer race is damaged, early bearing
and shaft failures could occur.
1.78
mm
(0.07,)
203
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 91
5. Camplate
a. Reinstall camplate, 1, into the motor housing.
Make certain that the camplate pintle shaft is
on the correct side.
b. The figure shows the camplate and all the
parts used, in the order they should be reas-
sembled.
204
c. Install the inner bearing race, 2, and shaft
needle bearing, 1, on the stub shaft end of
the camplate.
d. Install the shaft needle bearing, 3, on the
pintle shaft end of the camplate.
205
e. Install a new camplate shaft O ring, 1, and O
ring cover, 2, on the stub shaft end of the
camplate at 3.
206
92 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
207
g. Install flat washer, 1, new pintle shaft seal, 2,
gasket, 3, and seal cover plate, 4. Secure
with two torx head screws, 5, on the pintle
shaft end of the camplate. Torque the screws
to 4 - 5 N·m (36 - 48 in. lbs).
208
6. Reassemble the motor drive shaft, 1, by installing
a new retaining ring, 2; thrust washer, 3; thrust
bearing, 4; and second thrust washer, 5. Secure
with a second new retaining ring, 6.
209
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 93
210
8. Reassemble the rotating group by installing the
wave washer, 1, over the loading pins. Install the
spherical pivot washer, 2, and insert the piston
assembly, 3, into the piston block, 4. The pistons
should be reinstalled into the same piston block
cylinders as they were removed.
211
9. Invert the motor housing, 2, and insert the rotat-
ing group assembly, 1, into the housing.
NOTE: Piston shoes must contact the camplate. Be
sure all parts are in their proper position before pro-
ceeding.
NOTE: If the rotating group assembly will not easily
slide over the splined shaft, DO NOT FORCE. One
or more of the three loading pins may be out of their
groove or the pin head is not seated properly be-
tween the washer and block. Forcing the rotating
group may cause pin failure and early transmission
failure.
IMPORTANT: Make sure all mating surfaces are well
lubricated with SAE 10W-30 motor oil to insure 212
proper lubrication for start-up.
94 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
10. Backplate
a. If required, install a new needle bearing, 1, in
the backplate. The bearing should be in-
stalled with the numbered end facing the
center of the motor assembly.
213
b. Press the bearing into the housing with the
numbered end, 1, facing the center of the
motor assembly and to the dimension
shown, 2.29 mm (0.09″) above the face of the
backplate. The bearing is a pilot for the valve
plate during reassembly.
2.29 4.39
NOTE: When installing bearings in the housing or mm mm
backplate, be careful not to damage the outer bear- (0.09,) (0.173,)
ing race. If the outer race is damaged, early bearing
and shaft failures could occur.
214
11. Lubricate the valve plate, 1, and place the steel
side toward the backplate. Align one of the
notches on the outer edge of the valve plate with
alignment pin, 2. The brass side of the valve plate
should be next to the piston block when as-
sembled.
To assist in reassembly, place a small amount of
vaseline between the valve plate and the back-
plate to hold the pieces together.
215
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 95
216
13. Clamp the motor housing and rotating group, 1,
in a protected jaw vise and carefully install the
backplate assembly, 2, onto the shaft. Match
your alignment marks and dowel pins. Secure
with four cap screws, 3, and torque to 37 - 42 N·m
(27 - 31 ft. lbs.).
217
NOTE: When the backplate assembly is in place and
prior to inserting bolts, a small gap (approx. 1/8,) will
be noticed between the motor housing and the back-
plate at 1. This is normal. Tightening the bolts brings
the housing against the rotating group spring, result-
ing in an internal spring load to the valve plate and
slippers. After torquing the retaining bolts, the shaft
should turn easily with a pair of 8, pliers. The shaft
should have some rolling resistance but should not
be tight (locked down) or rotate easily. If it is locked
down or rotates freely, the motor is assembled incor-
rectly and requires teardown and reassembly.
218
96 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
REINSTALLATION
1. Clean the previously sealed surfaces between
the motor flange and gearbox.
When resealing, use a noncorrosive silicone
sealer to prevent rust and corrosion to parts after
assembled.
2. Place a bead of New Holland Ultra-Blue silicone
sealer around the face of the motor housing at 1.
3. Align the motor assembly splines with the
coupler splines in the gearbox, and slide the
motor shaft into the gearbox. Install two 1/2″ x
1-1/4″ cap screws and washers, torque to
101 N·m (75 ft. lbs.).
219
4. Reinstall motor fittings if removed.
5. Install the case drain hoses, 1, and tighten the
hose clamps, 2, securely. 2
1 2
A5358-
12 220
6. Install the neutralizer support bracket, 1, and se-
cure with four attaching bolts, 2, two at each
gearbox.
7. Install the front and rear control arms, 3 and 4,
onto the tapered camplate pintle shafts. The
short arm on the right motor, long arm on the left
motor.
221
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 97
222
12. Reinstall the slave cylinder, 1. Connect the sup-
ply hose, 2, from the two-speed control valve to 2
the rear of the cylinder.
6
13. Reconnect the high-pressure hydraulic hose, 3,
between the gear pump, 4, and the main control
valve, 5.
14. Reinstall the case drain tube that runs beneath 1
the motor assemblies. The tube connects at the 4
front of the left motor and at the rear of the right 3
motor. A hose assembly runs from the tee fitting
at the rear of the right motor to the inlet fitting of 5
the hydraulic gear pump at 6.
A3622-
4 223
15. Install the neutralizer assembly, 1, and secure
with four cap screws, 2; two at the front and two
at the rear.
16. Install the high-pressure hydrostatic hoses, 3,
from the pumps to the motors and tighten secure-
ly. When tightening fittings, first align hoses and
tubes for clearance and tighten to seat fittings,
then loosen and retorque.
224
98 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
23. Tilt the cab and boom back into position, if tilted
forward.
24. Reinstall the step shield, 1, fenders, etc., re-
moved for the repair.
25. Fill the hydraulic system (reservoir) with SAE
10W-30 oil.
226
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 99
Op. 29 134
227
The Two-Speed control switch is located in the
handle of the right-hand hydrostatic control. The
switch, 1, is thumb operated and protected by the
handle assembly.
228
100 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Op. 29 134 20
19984337
231
5. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
232
102 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
233
REMOVAL
1. The control valve, 1, is mounted to the left chain
case along the inside edge next to the hydrostatic
pumps.
234
2. To remove the control valve, disconnect the elec-
trical connection, 1. Wires from the harness are
light blue and black (Lt Blu/Blk).
3. Disconnect the hydraulic supply line to the valve
at 2, the hydraulic supply line to the slave cylinder
at 4, and the return line to the hydraulic gear
pump at 5. Cap all hoses and fittings to prevent
dirt from entering the system.
4. Remove the two attaching bolts, 3, and remove
the valve.
235
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 103
Op. 29 134 24
DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the outside of the control valve
assembly prior to disassembly. Plug all ports to
prevent solvent from entering the valve.
2. Remove retainer, 1; top O ring, 2; coil assembly,
3; bottom O ring, 4; and cartridge assembly, 5,
from control valve body, 6.
3. Remove O ring, 7, from cartridge assembly, 5.
4. If there are no noticeable leaks around the hy-
draulic fittings, do not remove.
236
INSPECTION
Clean all parts in a suitable solvent and air dry prior
to inspection.
1. Inspect the cartridge assembly O rings and seals
at 1, 2, and 3. O ring, 1, is part of the seal kit, and
will be replaced during reassembly.
2. Inspect O rings 2 and 3, they should not be
broken or nicked. These must seal properly for
the valve to operate correctly. Replace if necess-
ary.
237
3. Using a VOM, check continuity across the coil
leads at 1. There must be continuity. Also check
the resistance. A reading of 7.2 ohms, plus or
minus .2 ohms, indicates a good coil.
4. Apply 12 volts to the coil leads, 1. Maximum am-
perage draw should be 1.5 - 2.0 Amps.
5. Replace if necessary.
6. The upper and lower waterproofing O rings, 2
and 3, should be replaced during reassembly.
238
104 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
239
9. Inspect all ports, 1, in the valve body for dirt or de-
bris.
10. Inspect the cartridge port, 2, for scratches or
damage.
11. Replace parts as needed.
240
REASSEMBLY
Be sure all parts are clean and air-dried before reas-
sembly.
1. Install a new O ring, 1, on the valve cartridge, 2.
Coat the lower portion of the cartridge with
10W-30 oil and screw into the valve body, 3.
Torque to 22 - 27 N·m (16 - 20 ft. lbs.).
241
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 105
242
CONTROL VALVE REINSTALLATION
1. Position valve on mounting bracket as shown
along the inside of the left chain case. Secure
with two attaching bolts, 1.
2. Reconnect the hydraulic supply line, 2, the sup-
ply line to the slave cylinder, 3, and the return line
to the hydraulic gear pump, 4.
3. Reconnect the coil wires, 5, to the main wiring
harness.
243
4. Reinstall the hydrostatic control handle assem-
blies, 2 and 3, if removed, and the step shield, 1.
5. Return the operator’s seat to its correct position.
244
106 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Op. 29 134 30
19984337
246
5. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
247
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 107
248
REMOVAL
1. The two-speed slave cylinder, 1, is located direct-
ly above the right hydrostatic motor.
2. Remove control rod attaching bolt, 2, and control
link pivot bolt, 3. Rotate the control link, 4, back
out of the way.
3. Disconnect the supply line to the slave cylinder,
5, and cap the ends.
4. Remove cap screws, 6, at rear of cylinder, and,
7, on the cylinder rod end. Note the position of the
washers and spacers as they are removed. Re-
move cylinder.
IMPORTANT: Do not remove cylinder retaining hard-
249
ware until all pressure is released from the cylinder.
Op. 29 134 34
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove piston rod, 1.
2. Remove rod seals, 2 and 3.
250
108 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
INSPECTION
Clean all parts in a suitable solvent and air dry prior
to inspection.
1. Inspect piston rod, 1, for wear, scratches and
nicks that could damage or cut the seals during
reassembly.
2. Inspect the cylinder bore, 4, for damage or wear.
3. Inspect the seals, 2 and 3, for wear or damage.
Replace seals if necessary.
4. If leakage is noticed at the inlet fitting, 5, remove
and inspect O ring, 6, for damage. Replace if
necessary.
251
REASSEMBLY
Be sure all parts are clean and air-dried before reas-
sembly.
1. Install new seals, 2 and 3, if needed.
2. Apply clean 10W-30 oil to all contact surfaces of
the piston rod, cylinder, and seals.
3. Insert the piston rod, 1, into the cylinder, 4, mak-
ing sure not to damage the seals.
4. Install a new O ring, 5, on hydraulic fitting, 6. In-
stall fitting.
252
SLAVE CYLINDER REINSTALLATION
1. Align the cylinder, 1, in the mounting bracket and
install the washers, spacers, and attaching bolts,
6 and 7, in the order they were removed.
2. Reconnect the hydraulic supply line, 5, to the cyl-
inder.
3. Realign the control link, 4, and install the control
link pivot bolt, 3, and control rod attaching bolt, 2.
4. Reinstall the hydrostatic control handle assem-
blies, if removed. Replace the step shield.
5. Return the operator’s seat to its correct position.
253
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 109
Op. 29 134 40
19984337
255
5. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Support at the front, 1, and rear,
2, of the final drive cases.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer causing serious injury
or damage to the equipment.
1 2
256
110 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
257
7. Remove the step shield, 1, to access the hydro-
static pump and motor area. For more access, re-
move the right or left hydrostatic control handle
assembly, 2 or 3.
258
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the dampener shocks at 1, and the
neutralizer assemblies at 2.
2. Remove the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, two at front, 3, and two at rear, 4. Lift the en-
tire neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one piece.
259
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 111
260
6. Remove the front and rear control arms, 1 and 2.
These arms are attached to a tapered camplate
shaft and should be removed using a puller ar- 4
rangement as shown at 3.
NOTE: The holes, 4, in both motor cam plate arms
may be tapped and a cap screw used to remove
arms.
261
INSPECTION
1. Inspect the rear control arm shaft hub, 1, for wear
on the taper and keyway. Check the spring at-
taching pin, 2, for wear, and inspect the bolt hole
at 3, to make sure it’s not worn or enlarged.
2. Inspect the front control arm shaft hub, 4, for
wear on the taper and keyway. Check for worn or
enlarged bolt holes at the control link attaching
point, 5, and the cylinder attaching point, 6.
3. Inspect the spring, 7, for stretch and for wear at
the end hooks.
262
112 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
263
CONTROL LINKAGE REINSTALLATION
1. Install the front and rear control arms, 1 and 2, to
the tapered camplate pintle shafts. The short arm
on the right motor, long arm on the left motor.
2. Install spring, 3, as shown, and adjust the draw-
bolt to obtain a spring length of 109 mm (4.3″).
Secure with jam nuts at 4.
109 mm
(4.3,)
264
3. Install control link, 1, but do not tighten the hard-
ware. 3
4. Make sure both the front and rear control arms
are rotated clockwise and held firmly against the
internal motor stops by spring, 2. 2
5. With the arms in this position, tighten the control 4
link hardware, 3.
6. Install cylinder rod bolt, 4.
265
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 113
266
TWO-SPEED CONTROL SWITCH
The two-speed control switch, 1, located in the right
hydrostatic control handle, supplies power to the
two-speed control valve when the switch is shifted to
the high speed position.
Wiring from the harness is dark green/red and light
blue (DK GN/R, LT BL). A white and black (W, B) wire
run from the switch to the harness connector.
To check the switch, use a VOM to check continuity
at the white and black wires. There should only be
continuity with the switch in the high speed position.
Replace the switch if necessary.
With the skid steer still securely blocked with all four
267
wheels off the ground, start the engine and operate
the control switch. Check for correct operation of the
valve, cylinder and control linkage.
Install the step shield and return the operator’s seat
to its correct position.
114 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
268
3. Drain and flush the hydraulic oil reservoir.
a. Remove the small access door, 1, at the front
right corner of the belly pan by removing the
two rear bolts, 2, loosening the front two
bolts, 3, and sliding the door rearward.
269
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 115
270
4. Thoroughly flush the oil cooler with solvent by
forcing the solvent through the cooler.
5. Remove the oil filter and base, clean the base, 1,
and check the bypass valve, 2, for operation.
6. Clean and flush all hydraulic lines. If the failure
was hydrostatic, be sure to flush and clean the
high pressure hoses from the pumps to the mo-
tors.
271
7. After the system is cleaned, thoroughly flush out
the solvent used to clean the system with fresh,
clean SAE 10W-30 oil.
8. Reconnect all lines removed for cleaning.
9. Install a new oil filter, 1.
10. Before start-up, fill the hydraulic system, pumps,
motors, etc., as full as the case drain lines permit
with SAE 10W-30 oil.
272
116 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
273
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 117
274
4. Remove the fuel solenoid power wire, 1, from the
fuel solenoid, 2, to prevent the engine from start-
ing.
5. Put the steering control levers in the neutral posi-
tion and set the parking brake.
275
118 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
277
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 119
278
13. Adjust the neutral control linkage if required; refer
to neutral adjustment procedures in this manual.
14. Run the engine at 1500 RPM for an additional 30
minutes to filter the oil. Stop the engine and
change the oil filter, 1.
15. Check for oil leaks and repair as required.
16. Reinstall all shields removed for repair.
17. Lower the skid steer to the ground and operate.
279
120 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Op. 29 100
STEERING SYSTEM
HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM CONTROLS
Before any control linkage adjustments or repairs are
made to the skid steer, do the following:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion, resting on the ground, or remove any attach-
ment and raise the boom and rest on the boom
lock pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.
19984337
281
5. Securely block the skid steer with all four wheels
off the ground. Support at the front, 1, and rear,
2, of the final drive cases.
CAUTION
Failure to securely support the skid steer could result
in movement of the skid steer during testing causing
serious injury or damage to the equipment.
1 2
282
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 121
283
122 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
NEUTRALIZER ASSEMBLY
Op. 29 130 10
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the dampener shocks at 1, and the
neutralizer assemblies at 2.
2. Remove the four neutralizer assembly attaching
bolts, two at front, 3, and two at rear, 4.
3. Lift the entire neutralizer assembly, 5, out in one
piece.
284
DISASSEMBLY
1. Unbolt the dampener shocks, 1, at the mounting
tabs, 2, and remove.
2. Loosen the jam nuts, 3, on the neutralizer rod, 4,
and unscrew ball joint end, 5.
3. Remove the three jam nuts at 3, the washer at 6,
and remove the neutralizer rod, 4.
4. Repeat these steps for both rods.
285
5. Remove the neutralizer spring assembly, 1, by
first removing the two lube fitting cap screws, 2.
CAUTION
Spring is under tension. Use extreme care when re-
moving.
286
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 123
287
INSPECTION
Thoroughly clean all parts before inspection.
1. Inspect the dampener shocks for equal pressur-
es for both extending and retracting. Check for
leakage around the rod seals at 1.
2. Check for a bent piston rod, 2, and for any bind-
ing.
3. Check the rubber bushing, 3, for wear and dam-
age.
4. Replace dampener shock if worn or damaged.
5. Check the ball joint end, 4, for looseness and
OPS85263
wear. Replace if worn.
288
6. The neutralizer rod assembly consists of the fol-
lowing parts:
a. Neutralizer rod, 1.
b. Flat washers, 2.
c. Nylatron bushings, 3.
d. Jam nuts, 4.
e. Ball joint end, 5.
289
124 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
290
11. Inspect the neutralizer spring, 1, for wear or a
permanent spring set. Free length of the spring
is 200.7 mm ± 4.6 mm (7.9″ ± 0.18″).
12. Inspect the spring guides, 2, for wear on both the
inner and outer surfaces of the tube and at the
guide holes for the neutralizer rods.
13. Inspect the shaft, 3, for wear or bending. Look for
scratches or wear that may indicate lack of lu-
brication.
14. Check the lube fitting cap screws, 4, for blockage
that would prevent proper lubrication.
15. Replace all parts that are worn or damaged.
291
16. Inspect the bushing and guide holes, 1, on both
sides of the mounting bracket, 2, for wear. Re-
place bracket if worn.
292
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 125
REASSEMBLY
1. Insert the four neutralizer rod bushings, 1, into
the mounting bracket, 2, with the shoulder to the
inside.
2. Apply grease to the inner bore of the spring
guides, 3, and to the ends of the shaft, 4.
3. Insert shaft, 4, into one of the spring guides, 3,
and slide spring, 5, over this assembly. Assemble
the second spring guide into the open end of the
spring and align with the shaft.
293
4. Insert the neutralizer spring assembly, 1, into the
mounting bracket and resting against the rod
bushings at 2. Be careful not to break the bush-
ings when installing the spring assembly.
NOTE: The spring assembly must be pried into place
and will be under tension. Be cautious until the retain-
ing bolts and rods are in place.
5. Install a flat washer and lube fitting cap screws,
3, at both ends and tighten.
294
6. Install flat washer, 1, onto the neutralizer rod, 2,
and insert the rod through the bushings, 3, and
spring guides, 4.
7. Install a second flat washer and two jam nuts at
5. Tighten the inner jam nut finger tight. There
should be no free play between the rod and bush-
ing at 6, or between the bushing and mounting
bracket at 7. Tighten the outer jam nut against the
inner jam nut.
NOTE: If the jam nuts on the rods are turned in too
far or not far enough, free play will result.
8. Repeat these steps for both neutralizer rods.
295
126 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
296
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 127
Op. 29 130 30
CONTROL LINKAGE
REMOVAL
The neutralizer assembly is removed for clarity.
1. The control linkage consists of three main com-
ponents:
a. Front control rod, 1.
b. Control link (pivot), 2.
c. Rear control rod, 3.
The right side control linkage is shown; the left
side control linkage is the same except for control
rod lengths.
Repeat each step for the left side.
297
2. Disconnect the front control rod at 1, the control
link at pivot bolt, 2, and the rear control rod at, 3.
Remove the control linkage assembly.
DISASSEMBLY
1. Remove the front control rod from the control link
at 4, and the rear control rod, 5.
298
INSPECTION
1. Inspect the control rod ball joint ends, 1, for
looseness and wear in the swivel.
2. Inspect the control rods, 2, for straightness.
3. Inspect the control link pivot bushing, 3, for wear
and damage.
4. Check for wear and bending of the pivot bolt, 4.
5. Replace any parts that are worn, damaged, or
bent.
299
128 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
REASSEMBLY
Control rod lengths are measured from center to
center of the ball joint ends.
1. Adjust the length of the right rear control rod, 1,
to obtain a vertical center line of the control arm
pivot, 2, and link pivot, 3, shown at 4, with the 1 2
control linkage in neutral and no tire rotation.
The center of the control arm pivot, 2, and center
4
of link pivot, 3, must align to ensure equal stroke
forward and reverse.
Remove the control link, 1, at 5, and adjust the 5 3
length of the link if required. 19984618
2. Reattach the rear control rod, 1, to the control link
300
at 5, and the front control rod to the control link at
2.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 129
302
DISASSEMBLY
1. Loosen the boot securing bolts, 1, and slide the
boot, 2, off the handle.
2. Remove the roll pin, 3, and shim washers, 4.
Take note of the number and position of all shim 2
washers for reassembly.
3. Slide the handle sideways and remove from the
stub shafts.
5 4
4. Remove the bearings, 5, from the handle. 1
3
303
130 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
INSPECTION
3
1. Inspect the handle pivot bearings, 1; replace if
worn or damaged.
2. Inspect the control handle for excessive wear or
bends in the bearing mounting plates, 2, and
pivot stub shafts, 3.
2 1
304
REASSEMBLY
1. Slide the handle sideways over the stub shafts.
7
2. Install the bearings, 1, on the handle. Install shim
washers, 2, to center the handle in the slot, 3.
3. Install shim washers, 4, to reduce side play on 6
the stub shafts. Retain the shims on the stubs
shaft with a roll pin, 5.
4. Slide the boot, 6, over the handle and tighten the 1
boot securing bolts.
4
3
5. Install a new hand grip, 7, if grip is worn. 3
2
305
REINSTALLATION
1. Place the handle assembly in the unit and install
the five handle mounting bolts, 1, and tighten se-
curely. If the unit is high-flow, reconnect the wires 1
from the high-flow switch.
306
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 131
3172-07
307
132 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
2
1
19996848
309
4. If the unit is high-flow, disconnect the wires from
the high-flow switch. Remove the five handle
mounting bolts, 1, and remove the handle as-
sembly from the unit.
1
310
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 133
DISASSEMBLY
1. Take note of the number and position of all shim 4
washers for reassembly. 9 8
2. Remove the bolt, 1, securing the ball end to the
control arm.
3. Remove the jam nut, 2, and ball end, 3, from the 10
rod, 4. 12
4. Remove the groove pin, 5, from the arm, 6. 11
5. Loosen the set screw, 7, on the set collar. Re- 10
move the cotter pins, 8, and shim washers, 9, tak- 7
ing note of the number of shim washers for reas- 6 5 8 9 11
sembly.
6. Remove the bearings, 10, from the control 311
handle and the bearings, 11, from the handle
mounting plates. Slide the handle sideways and
remove from the stub shafts.
7. Remove the nuts, 1, lock washers, and carriage
bolts securing the handle support to the handle
tube. Remove the handle support, 2, and control
rod, 3, from the handle tube, 4.
1 2
4
19996838
312
8. Remove the locknut, 1, and bolt to separate the
handle from the handle support.
9. Remove the ball end, 2, from the handle by re- 3
moving the capscrew, 3, flat washer and locknut. 1
Remove the ball end, 2, and jam nut, 4, from the
rod, 5.
2 4
19996839
313
134 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
1 1
2
19997750
314
INSPECTION
1. Inspect the handle pivot bearings, 1; replace if 2
worn or damaged.
2. Inspect the pivot stub shafts, 2, for any obvious
bends or deformation.
3. Inspect the control handle for excessive wear or
bends in the bearing mounting plates, 3.
3
1
19997747
315
4. Inspect the pivot handle linkage for looseness in
the ball joints, 1; replace if worn.
5. Inspect the pivot handle, 2, and handle support, 2
3, for damage or deformation. Replace as
necessary. 1
316
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 135
REASSEMBLY
1
1. Install a new hand grip on the top of the handle,
1, if grip is worn. 6 5
9
2. Attach the ball end, 2, and jam nut, 3, to the rod,
8
4. Fasten the ball end to the handle, 5, with the
capscrew, 6, flat washer and locknut. Position the
flat washer between the ball end and handle. Do 7
not tighten the jam nut at this time.
2
3. Attach the handle assembly to the handle sup-
3
port, 7, with the long bolt, 8, and locknut, 9.
4. Tighten the locknut to remove any movement be-
4
tween the handle assembly and support, but do
19996839
not overtighten. The support should be loose
enough to allow the handle to pivot without bind- 317
ing.
5. Slide the handle tube up through the slot, 1, in the
handle support base.
7
6. Slide the handle sideways over the stub shafts.
7. Install the bearings, 2, on the handle, install shim
washers, 3, to center the handle in the slot, 1.
Fasten each bearing with two 5/16″ x 3/4″ car-
riage bolts, lock washers, and nuts at 4. 1 2
8. Install shim washers, 5, to reduce side play on 5
the stub shafts. Retain the shims on the stubs
shaft with a roll pin, 6. 6
9. Slide the rubber boot, 7, down over the end of the 4
control handle, one side at a time, and secure 3 4
with the the hardware removed during disassem-
bly. 318
10. Attach the handle and rod assembly, 1, to the
control handle by first sliding the rod down
through the control handle tube, 2.
11. Attach the handle assembly to the handle tube
arms, 3, with the short carriage bolts, 4, lock
washers, 5, and nuts, 6. Tighten securely. 5 3
6
4
1
2
19996838
319
136 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
320
15. Attach the ball end and jam nut, 1, onto rod, 2. In-
stall spacer, 12, (OD - 7/16″; length - 15/32″) be- 8
tween the ball end and arm, 3. Secure with a 2
5/16″ x 1-3/4″ bolt, lock washer, and nut at 4. 1
16. Install shim washers at 5, between the cotter pin, 4
6, and bearing, 7, to center rod, 2, in the control 10
handle tube at 8. Secure the cotter pin and slide
12
the set collar, 9, against the opposite bearing to
remove any side movement of the shaft and
tighten the setscrew. 10
17. Drive the groove pin in the arm, 3, completely into 9
place. 3 7 11
6 5
18. With the handle in the neutral position angle, ad-
just the length of the rod, 12, so the ball stud at 321
the arm aligns with the pivot bearings at 10. This
will also set the pivot arm, 11, in a vertical posi-
tion.
19. Rotate the handle to make sure the rod, 2, does
not interfere at the top or bottom of the control
handle tube. Move the control handle back and
forth (forward and reverse) and make sure the
control arm, 3, does not move. When there is no
movement, tighten the jam nuts at both ends of
the rod.
REINSTALLATION
1. Place the handle assembly in the unit and install
the five handle mounting bolts, 1, and tighten se-
curely. If the unit is high-flow, reconnect the wires
from the high-flow switch. 1
322
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 137
2
1
19996848
323
3. Reconnect the dampener shock, 1, the neutral-
izer, 2, and the hydrostatic pump control link, 3. 3
Use the same number and position of spacers 1
and washers noted during removal.
4. Reinstall all shields removed for the repair.
3172-07
324
138 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Op. 29 100 15
REMOVAL
1. Securely latch the seat in the raised and latched
position. Remove the step shield and front step 2
cover to access the control handle, linkage and
valve area.
2. Disconnect the dampener shock, 1, the neutral-
izer, 2, and the hydrostatic pump control link, 3.
Take note of the number and position of all 3172-07
washers and spacers for reference during in- 325
stallation.
3. Disconnect the wires, 4, to the two-speed control
switch under the right control handle support, if
applicable.
4. Remove the auxiliary hydraulic control or bucket
control rod, 1, from the right control handle arm,
2.
2
1
19996848
326
5. Remove the five handle mounting bolts, 1, and
remove the handle assembly from the unit.
327
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 139
DISASSEMBLY
1. Take note of the number and position of all shim 4
washers for reassembly. 2
3
2. Remove the bolt, 1, securing the ball end to the
control arm. 9 10
3. Remove the jam nut, 2, and ball end, 3, from the
rod, 4.
8
4. Remove the groove pin, 5, from the arm, 6.
5. Loosen the set screw, 7, on the set collar.
6. Remove the cotter pins, 8, and shim washers, 9, 10 7
taking note of the number of shim washers for re- 1 5 6
assembly.
7. Remove the bearings, 10, from the control 328
handle and the bearings, 11, from the handle
mounting plates. Slide the handle sideways and
remove from the stub shafts.
Op. 29 100 15
Auxiliary Boom Control Handle (only)
8. Boom hydraulics control - Remove the setscrew,
1, and remove the handle support, 2, and control
rod, 3, from the handle tube, 4.
2
1
4
19996890
329
9. Boom hydraulics control - Remove the roll pin, 1,
the L-pin, 2, and the spring and ball at 3.
1
19997746
330
140 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
19996889
331
Bucket Control Handle
11. Bucket control - Remove the nuts, 1, lock
washers, and carriage bolts securing the handle
support to the handle tube. Remove the handle
support, 2, and control rod, 3, from the handle
tube, 4. 1 2
4
19996838
332
12. Bucket control - Remove the locknut, 1, and bolt
to separate the handle from the handle support.
Remove the ball end, 2, from the handle by re- 3
moving the capscrew, 3, flat washer and locknut. 1
Remove the ball end, 2, and jam nut, 4, from the
rod, 5.
2 4
19996839
333
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 141
1 1
2
19997750
334
INSPECTION
1. Inspect the handle pivot bearings, 1; replace if 2
worn or damaged.
2. Inspect the pivot stub shafts, 2, for any obvious
bends or deformation.
3. Inspect the control handle for excessive wear or
bends in the bearing mounting plates, 3.
3
1
19997747
335
4. Bucket control - Inspect the pivot handle linkage
for looseness in the ball joints, 1; replace if worn.
1
5. Bucket control - Inspect the pivot handle, 2, and 2
handle support, 3, for damage or deformation.
Replace as necessary.
3
19997751
336
142 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
337
REASSEMBLY
1
1. Bucket control - Install a new hand grip on the top
of the handle, 1, if grip is worn. 6 5
9
2. Bucket control - Attach the ball end, 2, and jam
8
nut, 3, to the rod, 4, and fasten to the handle, 5,
with the capscrew, 6, flat washer and locknut.
Position the flat washer between the ball end and 7
handle. Do not tighten the jam nut at this time.
2
3. Bucket control - Attach the handle assembly to
3
the handle support, 7, with the long bolt, 8, and
locknut, 9.
4
4. Bucket control - Tighten the locknut to remove
19996839
any movement between the handle assembly
and support, but should be loose enough to all 338
the handle to pivot without binding.
5. Bucket control - Slide the handle tube up through
the slot, 1, in the handle support base. 7
6. Bucket control - Slide the handle sideways over
the stub shafts.
7. Bucket control - Install the bearings, 2, on the
4
handle, install shim washers, 3, to center the
handle in the slot, 1. Fasten each bearing with 2 1
5
two 5/16″ x 3/4″ carriage bolts, lock washers, and
nuts at 4.
8. Bucket control - Install shim washers, 5, to re- 6 4
duce side play on the stub shafts. Retain the
shims on the stubs shaft with a roll pin, 6. 4 3
9. Bucket control - Slide the rubber boot, 1, down
over the end of the control handle, one side at a 339
time, and secure with the the hardware, 2, re-
moved during disassembly.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 143
4
1
2
19996838
340
12. Boom hydraulics control - Install a new hand grip
on the top of the handle, 1, if grip is worn. 1
13. Boom hydraulics control - Attach the ball end, 2, 6
and jam nut, 3, to the rod, 4, and fasten to the 5
handle, 5, with a 5/16″ x 1-1/4″ capscrew, 6, flat 8
washer and locknut. Position the flat washer be- 9
tween the ball end and handle. Do not tighten the
jam nut at this time. 2 3
14. Boom hydraulics control - Attach the handle as-
sembly to the handle support, 8, with the long 7
bushing, 3/8″ x 3-1/4″ capscrew and locknut at 9.
15. Boom hydraulics control - Tighten the locknut to 4
remove any movement between the handle as- 19996889
sembly and support, but should be loose enough 341
to all the handle to pivot without binding.
16. Boom hydraulics control - Slide the handle tube
up through the slot, 1, in the handle support base. 7
17. Boom hydraulics control - Slide the handle side-
ways over the stub shafts.
18. Boom hydraulics control - Install the bearings, 2, 4
on the handle, install shim washers, 3, to center
the handle in the slot, 1. Fasten each bearing with 2 1
5
two 5/16″ x 3/4″ carriage bolts, lock washers, and
nuts, 4.
19. Boom hydraulics control - Install shim washers, 6 4
5, to reduce side play on the stub shafts. Retain
the shims on the stubs shaft with a roll pin, 6. 4 3
20. Boom hydraulics control - Slide the rubber boot,
7, down over the end of the control handle and 342
secure with the the hardware removed during
disassembly.
144 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
1
4
2
19996890
343
23. Boom hydraulics control - Insert the spring and
ball at 1. Insert the L-pin, 2, and drive the roll pin,
3, in flush to retain the L-pin.
3
19997746
344
24. Assemble the pivot shaft, 1, shim washers, 2,
arm, 3, set collar, 4, and bearings, 5, into the con- 5
trol arm housing. Fasten each bearing with two
5/16″ x 3/4″ carriage bolts, lock washers, and 3
nuts at 6. 7
25. Rotate the pivot shaft, 1, to position the arm up-
ward as shown at 7.
26. Note the position of the arm, 3, on the shaft, 1, in 6
relation to the arm at 7. Insert groove pin, 8, 6
through arm, 3, and into shaft, 1, just far enough 2
to position the arm. Do not hammer into place at 8
this time. 1 4 5
345
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 145
27. Attach the ball end and jam nut, 1, onto rod, 2. In-
stall spacer, 12, (OD - 7/16″; length - 15/32″) be- 8 2
tween the ball end and arm, 3. Secure with a
5/16″ x 1-3/4″ bolt, lock washer, and nut at 4. 1
28. Install shim washers at 5, between the cotter pin, 4 10
6, and bearing, 7, to center rod, 2, in the control
handle tube at 8. Secure the cotter pin and slide 12
the set collar, 9, against the opposite bearing to
remove any side movement of the shaft and
tighten the setscrew.
29. Drive the groove pin in the arm, 3, completely into 10 9
place. 11 7 6 3
5
30. With the handle in the neutral position angle, ad-
just the length of the rod, 2, so the ball stud at the 346
arm, 3, aligns with the pivot bearings at 10. This
will also set the pivot arm, 11, in a vertical posi-
tion.
31. Rotate the handle to make sure the rod, 2, does
not interfere at the top or bottom of the control
handle tube. Move the control handle back and
forth (forward and reverse) and make sure the
control arm, 3, does not move. When there is no
movement, tighten the jam nuts at both ends of
the rod.
REINSTALLATION
1. Place the handle assembly in the unit, install the
five handle mounting bolts, 1, and tighten secure-
ly.
1
347
2. Install the auxiliary hydraulic control or bucket
control rod, 1, on the right control handle arm, 2.
2
1
19996848
348
146 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
3172-07
349
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 147
350
3. Install the neutralizer assembly, 1, and secure
with four attaching bolts, 2. Two at the front and
two at the rear.
4. Connect the neutralizer assemblies to the control
handles at 3, and reconnect the dampener
shocks at 4.
351
148 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
Op. 29 130 06
352
Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised posi-
tion.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
353
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 149
4825-09
354
Before making any adjustments make sure there is
no binding in the control linkage, shocks or neutral-
izers.
The skid steer must be raised and supported with the
tires off the ground. Use adequate blocking or jack
stands to securely support the skid steer.
The engine must be started and running to make final
linkage or neutral adjustments. Place the “SERVICE/
RUN” Switch, 1, in the “SERVICE” position to allow
the engine to be started. 1
19984593
355
SL65B LINKS AND ARMS
4 3
Control lever and link, 1, arm, 2, link, 3, and dam-
pener assembly, 4, controls the right side. Control
lever and link, 5, arm, 6, link, 7, and dampener as- 1 2
sembly, 8, controls the left side. The two dampener
shocks, 4 and 8, are connected to the steering link- 8
age to dampen the hydraulic vibration from the con-
trol levers and the operator’s hands. The neutralizer
assemblies are spring loaded to return the steering
linkage to the neutral position.
5
When the operator strokes both control levers in the 6
same direction the unit will travel in that direction until 7
the levers are stroked differently to change direction. 4319-10
When both levers are released the steering linkage 356
will return to neutral.
150 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
3649-05
358
3. Check and remove any free play in the neutral-
izer spring assemblies, 1, right side and, 2, left 2
side. There should be no free play between the
rod and bushing at, 3, or between the bushings 3
and the support at, 4. To remove the free play
loosen nuts and adjust on rods at, 5. 1
NOTE: If the rods are turned in too far or not far 4
enough, free play will result. 2
3649-05
359
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 151
4319-09
363
2. Unhook link, 1, at 2 and start the skid steer en-
gine, at this time. Pivot the control arm, 3, until the 3 2
1
hydrostat control neutralizes the hydrostatic
pump with no tire rotation.
3. With the control levers previously set to the 9.5
degrees, forward position, rotate the arm, 3, until
the tires start to rotate forward and then rotate the 4
arm, 3, back until tires just stop rotating. Now ad-
just the length of link, 1, with yoke, 4, to allow the
yoke to be reconnected at, 2. Adjust both the right
and left sides in this sequence.
Start the unit and check for neutral, no tire rota-
tion. If the tires rotate repeat step three, if there 4319-09
is no tire rotation go to straight travel adjustment. 364
NOTE: If adjusted correctly it will take the same
movement of the left and right hydrostatic control
levers to produce tire rotation in the forward direction.
SL65B STRAIGHT TRAVEL AND
FORWARD/REVERSE STOP ADJUSTMENT 1
Before straight travel can be adjusted, the control
levers, 1, must be set for equal movement. When
both the right and left control levers are stroked for-
ward, the tires should start rotating at the same time.
To obtain equal movement, refer to steps 2 and 3 of
LINKAGE AND CONTROL LEVER EQUAL MOVE- 2
MENT ADJUSTMENT. A hand held tach is required
to properly set forward and reverse wheel speeds.
IMPORTANT: If the external control lever stops, 2,
are not adjusted properly, overspeed may occur and
the control linkage and transmission may be dam- 19984866
aged. 365
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 153
4. Operate unit and stroke control levers forward to NOTE: If stop plates are not adjusted properly equal
obtain maximum speed, and slide the forward travel speeds forward and reverse will not be ob-
stops rearward to contact the control lever and tained. If too much forward stroke is allowed, the re-
tighten stop retaining hardware. verse speed may be diminished.
5. Stroke the control levers in reverse to obtain CAUTION
maximum speed and slide the reverse stops
the skid steer must be raised and supported with the
against the control levers and tighten retaining
tires off the ground. Use adequate blocking or jack
hardware.
stands to securely support the skid steer.
IMPORTANT: The hydrostatic pump control valve
and linkage has a dead band area in neutral, forward, IMPORTANT: If the external control lever stops are
and reverse. Within the dead band areas, there will not adjusted properly the control linkage and trans-
be a control lever movement without wheel move- mission may be damaged.
ment or increase in speeds.
7. Return the “SERVICE/RUN” Switch to the “RUN”
6. Operate the skid steer and check for straight position.
travel and make final adjustment by slowing
down the fast side.
SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1 155
3461-11
379
Before checking or adjusting the HIGH/LOW linkage,
make sure the control arms, 1, are tight on the motor 1
cam plate shafts, 2. The neutralizer and dampeners 2
are shown removed for clarity.
1 2
3625-13
380
Spring Adjustment
Adjust the high/low return spring to a spring length of 2
4-5/16″ (109 mm) from eye at, 1, to eye, 2, by tighten-
ing or loosening the draw bolt, 3.
NOTE: Once the skid steer neutral adjustments and
straight travel speeds are correct in low range, and 1
the variable motors are set to the high range position,
the skid steer may not run in a straight line.
3
3461-16
381
156 SECTION 29 – HYDROSTATIC TRANSMISSION – CHAPTER 1
CONTENT
OPS844
1
Op. 33 000 The park brake prevents movement of the loader
when power is applied or the machine is parked on
GENERAL INFORMATION an incline.
The parking brake system is a mechanically acti- CAUTION
vated double disc brake system. Brake discs are at- Always engage the parking brake before exiting the
tached to each of the two hydrostatic motor shafts, lo- loader. Never operate the loader until the parking
cated inside the gearboxes, 1. Both left and right side brake is released.
parking brakes are activated by a single control lever.
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 3
SPECIFICATIONS
Chain Case and Gearbox
Description Use
Ultra/Blue Silicone Sealer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gearbox mounting bolts
Axle housing bolts
Chain case cover bolts
Gearbox to chain case
Gearbox cover and bolts
Sealing Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NH Ultra Blue silicone sealer
Gear Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80W-90 API Service GL-5 Gear Oil
Grease . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High viscosity lithium base
NOTE: Always use a noncorrosive silicone sealer to seal where required to prevent corrosion during the sili-
cone curing process.
4 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1
TROUBLESHOOTING
CAUTION
Never exit the loader with the boom in the raised posi-
tion unless the boom is supported on the boom lock
pins.
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment
mounted. Always remove the attachment from the
loader.
3
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 5
TROUBLESHOOTING
Parking brake will not release. Brake not adjusted properly. Adjust parking brake.
Handle not operating properly. Check handle components; repair
or replace.
Brake caliper not releasing. Check brake caliper and repair.
Parking brake handle will not Handle not operating properly. Check handle components; repair
move or release. or replace.
Control linkage not moving. Check and repair linkage.
Brake caliper not releasing. Check brake caliper and repair.
Grinding noise when Handle not releasing properly. Check handle components; repair
operating. or replace.
Brake not adjusted properly. Adjust parking brake.
Brake caliper not releasing. Check brake caliper and repair.
6 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1
TESTING
PARKING BRAKE
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat with seat belt buckled.
* Engine running at 1500 RPM.
* Park brake in disengaged position.
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat with seat belt buckled.
* Engine running at 1500 RPM.
* Park brake in engaged position.
Op. 33 110
PARKING BRAKE
OPERATION
The parking brake system is a mechanically acti-
vated, double disc brake system. Brake discs are at-
tached to each of the two hydrostatic motor shafts lo-
cated in the gearboxes. Both left and right side
parking brakes are activated by a single control lever.
The park brake prevents movement of the loader
when power is applied or the machine is parked on
a slope.
The parking brake control lever, 1, is located to the 4
right of the operator’s seat. When the lever is in the
lowered, unlatched position, the brake is disen-
gaged. When the lever is in the raised, latched posi-
tion, the brake is engaged.
When the parking brake is engaged and the hydro-
static control levers are stroked, the skid steer should
not move if the brake is adjusted properly.
The hydrostatic system is the primary brake for the
skid steer when the unit is in operation. The parking
brake is intended to hold a stopped machine in place,
preventing rolling or creeping when parked.
The parking brake should always be engaged before
exiting the skid steer.
CAUTION
Always activate the parking brake before leaving the
operator station. Never operate the skid steer unless
the brake is released.
8 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1
Op. 33 110 48
Removal
1. Tilt the cab and boom forward. Refer to Section
00 for the cab and boom tilting procedure.
2. Remove the hydrostatic motor two-speed hy-
draulic cylinder and control linkage (if appli-
cable). Refer to Section 29 for the removal pro-
cedure.
3. Remove the hydrostatic motor. Refer to Section
29 for the removal procedure.
NOTE: If only the hydrostatic motor is to be removed,
apply the parking brake before removal to retain the
brake discs and splined coupler in place.
4. Remove two cap screws, 4.
5. Remove four cap screws, 2. Remove the park
brake housing cover, 1, and bracket, 3.
5
6. Remove two discs, 1; divider plate, 2; and splined
coupler 3, by sliding them off the gearbox input
shaft.
6
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 9
7
8. Remove the steel friction pad, 1, and spacer, 2,
from the gearbox housing.
8
Inspection
1. Inspect the discs and divider plates for warping,
scoring, galling or wear. Inspect the spline area,
1, of the discs and the lugs, 2, on the separator
plates. Replace if necessary.
9
10 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1
19987107
10
3. Inspect the brake friction pads, 1. If worn to 7 mm
(1/4″) or less, replace.
4. The spacer plate, 2, will show a small amount of
wear in the center. This is normal.
11
Repair and Assembly
After cleaning and careful inspection, reassemble
the parking brake, using new parts where necessary.
1. Install the friction pad, 1, into the brake end cap.
12
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 11
13
3. Install the first brake disc, 1, over the splines of
the drive coupler, 2.
1
19987114
14
4. Install the separator plate on the drive coupler,
with the lugs, 1, over the extended tabs, 2, on the
gearbox case.
1
2
19987115
15
12 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1
1
19987117
16
6. Apply silicone sealer to the mating surfaces of
the housing and end cap.
7. Install the end cap onto the brake housing mak-
ing sure the lugs, 1, on the separator plate fit in
the notches, 2, on the end cap and the brake fric-
tion pads, 3, line up opposite each other across
the brake and separator plates.
17
SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1 13
Op. 33 110
PARKING BRAKE ADJUSTMENT
The parking brake control lever is located to the right
of the operator’s seat. With the lever in the down
position, the brake is released; up is engaged. The
parking brake should prevent movement of the
loader when power is applied or parked on an incline.
To adjust the parking brake, do the following:
1. Put the control lever in the released (down) posi-
tion.
2. Put the seat in the raised position, making sure
the seat assembly is locked up securely.
NOTE: The fenders can be removed to access brake 18
linkage.
3. Remove cotter pin from spring link, 1, and lever,
2, at 3.
4. Unhook the spring link.
5. Adjust the spring assembly bolts, 6, equally to
obtain a spring length of 152 mm (6″) with the
parking brake control lever in the released posi-
tion.
6. Loosen the setscrew, 4, in lever, 2, to allow the
lever to be removed from the actuator shaft, 5.
7. Rotate the lever down to turn the actuator shaft
into the caliper support to remove any play in
brake caliper.
8. Slide the lever off the actuator shaft and rotate
the lever up on the splined shaft until the spring
link can be rehooked.
9. Slide the lever onto the shaft and reposition the
lever to prevent contact with the hydraulic oil res-
ervoir, hoses, etc. and tighten the setscrews.
10. Reinstall the cotter pin to retain the spring link to
the lever.
CAUTION
Before adjusting the brake linkage, be sure that the
brake is disengaged and the loader is on level ground
to prevent the loader from rolling.
Always engage the parking brake before leaving the
operator’s seat. Never operate the unit unless the
brake is released.
14 SECTION 33 – BRAKES AND CONTROLS – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
CONTENT
Op. 35 000
GENERAL INFORMATION
The hydraulic system provides hydraulic oil to the The hydraulic gear pump, which is attached to the
boom and bucket circuits. On skid steers equipped left-hand hydrostatic pump, provides continuous oil
with the boom auxiliary hydraulic kit, system oil will flow through the system to power the boom and
also be supplied to quick couplers at the front of the bucket circuits and, if equipped, the auxiliary boom
boom to operate optional hydraulic attachments. circuit.
The hydraulic system on the SL65B is an open center Figure 1 shows the hydraulic circuit layout and sys-
type hydraulic system. An open center means means tem components for the SL65B skid steers.
that the first control valve function has priority over
the next function in line.
17 4 6 9 5 18 12
1
13
15
14
1
4 8 16 3 18 7 11 10
BSC0938A
1
LS180 Hydraulic Circuit and System Components
1. Bucket cylinders 10. Engine (power supply)
2. Control valve (3 spool) 11. Engine gearbox
3. Hydraulic gear pump 12. Hydraulic reservoir
4. Boom cylinders 13. Hydraulic filter
5. Hydrostatic pump (RH) 14. Hydraulic oil cooler
6. Hydrostatic motor (RH) 15. Auxiliary boom hydraulics
7. Hydrostatic pump (LH) 16. High/low control valve (if two-speed equipped)
8. Hydrostatic motor (LH) 17. High/low shift cylinder (if two-speed equipped)
9. Charge pump 18. Hydraulic high flow kit (optional)
4 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
2
2. What is the hydraulic oil flow requirement? Is
it more than the highest total flow rate of the
skid steer model?
SL65B 18.5 US. GPM (70.0 l/min.) @2350 RPM 32.0 US. GPM (122 l/min.) @2350 RPM
68 bar (@1000 PSI) 68 bar (@1000 PSI)
* Hydraulic flow rates are rated at 150 RPM below high idle at 90% pump efficiency.
NOTE: When using the High-Flow system, 3/4 quick Example: Snow blowers must free wheel to a
couplers must be used or high system backpressure stop.
may result. 5. Will the attachment accept hydraulic system
3. Will the attachment accept oil flow in both backpressure?
directions?
If “YES”, nothing is required.
If “YES”, nothing is required. If “NO”, the attachment will not function properly
If “NO”, install a check valve or cross into the at- on a skid steer. Normal backpressure for skid
tachment return line to prevent reverse oil flow to steers is between 13.8 to 17.3 bar (200 to 250 PSI).
the attachment.
Examples: Backhoes and trees spades with a Examples: Post drivers, some breakers, and
separate control valve do not accept oil flow in some hand held hydraulic tools do not accept
both directions. system backpressure.
4. Must the attachment “Free Wheel” to a If all the skid steer oil flow is not required to oper-
STOP? ate an attachment (e.g., shaver post driver), a
flow divider can be installed into the hydraulic oil
If “YES”, a crossover relief connection must be circuit on the attachment. The flow divider sends
installed on the attachment side to allow the at- the required oil flow to the attachment and the re-
tachment to free wheel to a stop after the skid mainder back to the normal skid steer hydraulic
steer hydraulics is turned off. circuits.
If “NO”, nothing is required.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 5
6. Does the attachment have a separate case NOTE: Skid steers equipped with High Flow Hy-
drain oil line? draulics have a separate case drain coupler and re-
turn line attached to the right boom arm.
If “NO”, nothing is required.
7. Does the attachment require circuit relief in
If “YES”, install a separate case drain line to re- the bucket circuit?
turn the attachment case drain oil directly to the
hydraulic oil reservoir. If “NO”, nothing is required.
Example: Cold planners have a separate case If “YES”, install a bucket circuit relief valve on
drain oil line. front of the control valve.
NOTE: Most attachment case drains will not accept Example: Some mini-backhoes attach like a
backpressure and must drain directly into the reser- bucket, and require a bucket circuit relief.
voir.
6 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
1
19987103
4
To use the power-beyond port for a second oil supply
to additional attachments, remove the factory power-
beyond plug to access inner hole, 1. This hole must
be plugged to divert oil to the power-beyond instead
of normal oil flow to the out port.
1
19987104
5
Install part #236622 allen head type pipe plug in the
inner port, 1. Tighten the plug securely. A regular O
ring type fitting can now be inserted in the power-be-
yond port.
IMPORTANT: Once the power-beyond fitting and
plug is installed, oil must be constantly returned from
the attachment valve into the return line, 2. If oil is
blocked at the power-beyond port, hydraulic system
overheating and component damage could occur. 2
Also, engine horsepower requirements will increase.
A tee fitting can be inserted in the return line at 2, for
attachment oil return. 1
19987105
6
8 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
SPECIFICATIONS
MAIN CONTROL VALVE
Electrical solenoid boom and bucket spool locks (controlled by the EIC) will lock the control valve spools when
the operator is out of the seat or the ignition key is in the “OFF” position with the spools in the neutral position.
HYDRAULIC PUMP
RESERVOIR
Capacity
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24.6 (6.5 US. gal.)
Filter Spin-on
. . . . . .Canister
................................................................. 10 micron
10 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Control Valve
Boom Cylinders
Bucket Cylinders
Gear Pump
OTHER MATERIALS
NOTE: Always use a noncorrosive silicone sealer to prevent damage to the components being sealed during
the silicone curing process.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 11
TROUBLESHOOTING WARNING
When performing a test on the hydraulic system, use Gauges, gauge fittings, and hoses must have operat-
the proper test procedures and test equipment. ing pressure ratings of at least 25% higher than the
Before testing, lower the attachment to the ground or highest pressures of the system.
remove the attachment from the skid steer. Never adjust or replace the relief valves to get higher
If testing is to be performed with a raised boom, make pressures than those specified by the equipment
sure the boom is raised above and resting on the manufacturer.
boom lock pins. Fluid under pressure can have sufficient force to pen-
Before opening the hydraulic system, clean the area etrate the skin, causing serious personal injury. al-
thoroughly to prevent contaminating the system. ways protect the skin and eyes from escaping fluid
Before opening the hydraulic system, relieve all pres- under pressure.
sure from the system. Before disconnecting lines or fittings, be sure to turn
Before testing the hydraulic system, check the hy- off the skid steer engine and relieve all pressure. Be-
draulic oil level. fore applying pressure to the system, be sure all con-
nections are tight and that lines, pipes, and hoses are
Before testing the hydraulic system, the oil must be not damaged.
at normal operating temperature.
If injured by escaping fluid, obtain medical assist-
If testing requires the skid steer to be raised, use ad- ance at once. Serious infection or reaction can devel-
equate blocking and/or jack stands to securely sup- op if medical treatment is not administered immedi-
port the skid steer. ately.
CAUTION Rmove any attachment from the mounting plate be-
When connecting test equipment to the hydraulic fore loosening or disconnecting any hydraulic lines.
system, relieve the pressure in the system. Stop the
engine, turn the ignition switch to the “on” position CAUTION
and operate all hydraulic control valve circuits to re-
Use adequate blocking and/or jack stands to make
lieve pressure. Turn the ignition switch to the “off”
sure that the skid steer is safely supported with all
position.
four wheels off the ground.
12 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
7
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 17
Pretest instructions:
* Hydraulic oil reservoir oil at proper oil level
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “OFF” position
Pretest instructions:
* Hydraulic oil reservoir oil at proper oil level
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
Pretest instructions:
* Hydraulic oil reservoir oil at proper oil level
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
Pretest instructions:
* Hydraulic oil reservoir oil at proper oil level
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM
Pretest instructions:
* Hydraulic oil reservoir oil at proper oil level
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM
Boom operation:
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM
Bucket operation:
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
* Engine running half throttle, 1500 RPM
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat
* Service/Run switch in “RUN” position
* Seat belt fastened
* Ignition switch in the “ON” position
4 2 1
3 7
BSC0938B
8
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM OIL FLOW
Control Valve - Spools in Neutral Position 6. The oil flows through return line, 7, to oil cooler,
1. Hydraulic oil reservoir, 1, storage for system oil. 8.
2. Oil flows through suction line, 2, from reservoir, 7. Oil passes through the oil cooler, 8, being cooled
1, to gear pump, 3. with the air blast from engine fan through the
cooler.
3. Oil flows from gear pump, 3, through pressure
line, 4, to control valve, 5. 8. Oil flows from the oil cooler, 8, through oil filter, 9,
and back to reservoir, 1.
4. Control valve, 5, is equipped with a system relief
valve, 6.
5. With the control valve spools in neutral position,
the oil flows through center of control valve, 5, to
return line, 7.
24 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
1
BSC0938C
9
CONTROL VALVE - BUCKET SPOOL 1. Oil flows from the gear pump, 1, through pres-
SHIFTED0 sure line, 2, to the control valve, 3.
2. When the bucket valve spool, 4, is pulled out, the
oil flows from the rear work port, 5, to the shaft
Bucket Control Operation
side of the bucket cylinder to curl the bucket
back.
Foot Controls
3. When the bucket valve spool, 4, is pushed in, the
When the toe of the control pedal is pushed down, it
oil flows from the front work port, 6, to the base
will shift the control valve spool in, dumping the
(piston) end of bucket cylinder to dump the buck-
bucket. When the heel of the control pedal is pushed
et.
down, it will shift the control valve spool out, curling
the bucket back. 4. When the bucket circuit is operated to maximum
pressure or cylinders are bottomed, the main
system relief valve will relieve the high pressure
Hand Controls oil into the return oil galley in the control valve, re-
When the right control handle is pivoted up, it will shift turning the oil to the reservoir.
the control valve spool in, dumping the bucket. When 5. The return oil from the opposite side of the cylin-
the right control handle is pivoted down, it will shift the der being pressurized will return through the con-
control valve spool out, curling the bucket back. trol valve to the reservoir.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 25
2 1
BSC0938D
10
CONTROL VALVE - BOOM SPOOL 3. When the boom valve spool, 4, is pushed in, the
SHIFTED oil flows from the front port, 6, to the shaft end of
boom cylinders to lower the boom.
4. When the boom circuit is operated to maximum
Boom Control Operation
pressure or cylinders are bottomed, the main
system relief valve will relieve the high pressure
Foot Controls oil into the return oil galley in the control valve, re-
When the toe of the control pedal is pushed down, it turning the oil to the reservoir.
will shift the control valve spool in, lowering the boom.
5. The return oil from the opposite side of cylinders
When the heel of the control pedal is pushed down,
being pressurized will return through the control
it will shift the control valve spool out, raising the
valve to the reservoir.
boom.
6. When the boom cylinders are extended, the
boom control valve spool is in neutral, and a load
Hand Controls is put on the boom cylinders causing them to re-
When the left control handle is pivoted down, it will tract, the circuit relief valve, 7, will relieve the
shift the control valve spool in, lowering the boom. pressure in the base (piston) side of the cylinders
When the left control handle is pivoted up, it will shift protecting the cylinder and lines. The oil relieved
the control valve spool out, raising the boom. from the circuit relief valve enters the return oil
galley in the control valve and returns to the res-
ervoir.
1. Oil flows from the gear pump, 1, through pres-
sure line, 2, to control valve, 3. 7. When the boom valve spool, 4, is pushed in all
the way, it will put the spool into detent position,
2. When the boom valve spool, 4, is pulled out, the
opening both work ports 5 and 6 to the return oil
oil flows from the rear work port, 5, to the base
galley, allowing the boom to float.
(piston) end of the boom cylinder raising the
boom.
26 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
9 3
BSC0938E
11
CONTROL VALVE - AUXILIARY SPOOL plies oil to the female quick coupler, 6, at the front
SHIFTED of the boom.
3. When the auxiliary valve spool, 4, is pushed in,
the oil flows from the front work port, 7, and sup-
Auxiliary Control Operation
plies oil to the male quick coupler, 8, at the front
of the boom.
Hand Controls
4. When the auxiliary circuit is operated to maxi-
When the right control handle is pivoted down, it will
mum pressure, the main system relief valve will
shift the control valve spool in, supplying oil to the
relieve the high pressure oil into the return oil gal-
male quick coupler. When the right control handle is
ley in the control valve, returning the oil to the res-
pivoted up, it will shift the control valve spool out,
ervoir.
supplying oil to the female quick coupler.
5. The return oil from the opposite quick coupler be-
ing pressurized will return through the control
Foot Control valve to the reservoir.
When the toe of the control pedal is pushed down, it NOTE: The return oil from the quick couplers must be
will shift the control valve spool in, supplying oil to the returned through the normal return line, 9, to
male quick coupler. When the heel of the control replenish the hydrostatic system; hydrostatic charge
pedal is pushed down, it will shift the control valve oil is required for lubrication of the hydrostatic pumps
spool out, supplying oil to the female quick coupler. and motors.
1. Oil flows from the gear pump, 1, through pres- 6. When the auxiliary valve spool, 4, is pushed in all
sure line, 2, to control valve, 3. the way, it will put the spool into detent position,
2. When the auxiliary valve spool, 4, is pulled out, holding the spool for continuous oil flow to the
the oil flows from the rear work port, 5, and sup- male quick coupler.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 27
3 2
BSC0938F
12
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM OIL FLOW When the selector is Off, the oil is directed to the
control valve return line, 3.
High Flow - Selector Off When using the high flow, always use the 3/4″
The high flow gear pump, 1, supplies the high flow oil couplers to prevent high back pressure and
to the control valve block through the selector, 2. overheating of the hydraulic system.
28 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
3 2
BSC0938G
13
HYDRAULIC SYSTEM OIL FLOW When the selector is On, the high flow oil is directed
to the control valve, 3.
High Flow - Selector On When using high flow, always use the 3/4″ couplers
The high flow gear pump, 1, supplies high flow oil to to prevent high back pressure and overheating of the
the control valve block through the selector, 2. hydraulic system.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 29
Op. 35 710 02
14
The main system pressure can also be checked at
the base end of the left bucket cylinder at 1 or at the
auxiliary boom hydraulic quick couplers, 2, if
equipped.
15
To check main system pressure at the boom cylin-
ders, the boom must be up and resting on the boom
lockpins, 1.
16
30 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
17
Raise the seat and seat pan to the raised latched
position, 1. Be sure the seat support rod is latched se-
curely at 2, before working under a raised seat.
CAUTION
Do not work under raised seat unless securely
latched in the raised position.
18
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 31
20
3. Install the pressure test gauge in the boom cylin-
der at 1.
1
4. Start the engine and run it at full throttle (2175
RPM - 2275 RPM).
5. Operate the boom control to raise the boom to
the fully raised position until the system by-
passes and take a pressure reading. Lower the
boom down to the boom lockpins and relieve
pressure in the system.
6. The pressure should be from 177 - 190 bar (2600
- 2800 PSI) when the hydraulic oil is at operating
temperature.
21
7. The relief valve is a cartridge type and is not ad-
justable. Replace the relief valve cartridge, 1, if
the pressure is not within specifications.
CAUTION 1
Do not attempt to change the pressure setting or alter
the pressure to a higher setting as the hydraulic com-
ponents, hoses, tubes, and cylinders may be dam-
aged and could cause injury.
19997742
22
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 33
23
3. Install the pressure test gauge in the left bucket
cylinder at 1.
4. Start the engine and run it at full throttle (2175
RPM - 2275 RPM).
5. Operate the bucket control to dump the bucket to
the fully dumped position until the system by-
passes and take a pressure reading. Curl the
bucket back to relieve pressure in the system.
6. The pressure should be from 177 - 190 bar (2600
- 2800 PSI) when the hydraulic oil is at operating
temperature.
24
7. The relief valve is a cartridge type and is not ad-
justable. Replace the relief valve cartridge, 1, if
the pressure is not within specifications.
CAUTION 1
Do not attempt to change the pressure setting or alter
the pressure to a higher setting as the hydraulic com-
ponents, hoses, tubes, and cylinders may be dam-
aged and could cause injury.
19997742
25
34 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
26
3. Install the pressure test gauge in one of the quick
couplers at 1.
4. Start the engine and run it at full throttle (2175
RPM - 2275 RPM).
5. Operate the auxiliary control to pressurize the
auxiliary circuit until the system bypasses and
take a pressure reading. Move the control handle
in the opposite direction to relieve pressure in the
system.
NOTE: Pivoting the control handle down supplies oil
to the male quick coupler.
6. The pressure should be from 177 - 190 bar (2600
- 2800 PSI) when the hydraulic oil is at operating
temperature. 27
7. The relief valve is a cartridge type and is not ad-
justable. Replace the relief valve cartridge, 1, if
the pressure is not within specifications.
CAUTION 1
Do not attempt to change the pressure setting or alter
the pressure to a higher setting as the hydraulic com-
ponents, hoses, tubes, and cylinders may be dam-
aged and could cause injury.
19997742
28
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 35
30
3. Remove the step shield, 1, to access the control
valve and circuit relief valve area.
31
36 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
CAUTION 32
Do not increase pressure over 3800 PSI. If the relief
valve does not open when pressure reaches 3600
PSI, discontinue the test and replace the valve.
33
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 37
Test Procedure
Gear pump flow test on units equipped with auxiliary
boom hydraulics.
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion, resting on the ground.
2. Stop engine, turn ignition key to the run position
and operate the boom and bucket control pedals
to relieve pressure in the cylinders. Turn off the
key.
3. Attach the pressure (inlet) hose from the flow
tester with the female quick coupler to the male
half on the skid steer at 1.
4. Attach the return (outlet) hose from the flow
tester with the male coupler to the female half on
the skid steer at 2.
IMPORTANT: Make sure the flow tester is connected
into the hydraulic system properly for proper oil flow
through the tester to prevent damage to the hydraulic
test equipment or hydraulic system.
CAUTION
Never position tester between the gear pump and
control valve as the system relief valve will be out of 34
the test circuit, and pump over pressure may cause
a pump failure by splitting the center section or twist-
ing off the input shaft.
35
38 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
40
2. Raise the seat, 1, and latch securely in the raised
latch position, 2. Remove the step shield, 3, from
over the control valve to access the solenoid
locks.
41
3. Unplug one solenoid, 1, at a time and check for
battery voltage at the main wire harness plugs, 1 1
pink/light-blue and black wires. The operator
must be in the seat with the seat belt buckled and
the ignition key in the “ON” position.
NOTE: If both solenoids are unplugged, the EIC will
show an FOA fault and there will be no voltage from
the EIC to the solenoids.
4. If there is battery voltage at the solenoids, re-
move the coils and check their operation. If the
plunger moves in when power is applied, check
for binding when the coil is threaded into the
body. Check for spool centering to allow the coil 19997742
plunger to seat into the groove in the spool. 42
DANGER
If the lockout solenoids are loosened or removed
from the control valve body, the pedal(s) are no
longer locked. Pedal or hand control movement will
result in spool movement and boom/bucket move-
ment.
42 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Test Procedure:
1. Remove the filler/breather cap.
2. Remove the self-tapping screws around the cap
base and screen assembly.
3. Remove the base, screen and gasket assembly.
Clean all sealing surfaces.
4. Re-install new gaskets and base, taking care not
to overtighten the screws.
5. Make sure the tank has 10W-30 oil visible.
6. Pressurize the tank using an air pressure line.
The tool is equipped with a 3 PSI relief valve and
a pressure gauge. The reservoir should not be
pressurized beyond 4 PSI.
The following checks should then be performed to
trace the source of the air ingress.
• Examine the suction tubes and fittings to the hy-
draulic gear pump and the return tubes from the
filter to the reservoir.
• Examine the transmission case drain tubes/
hoses and fittings from the hydraulic motors and
pumps to the suction side of the hydraulic pump.
Also check the cam plate shaft seals and the
pump and motor casing gaskets.
• Potential leakage areas could also be input shaft
seals in the engine bell housing, gearbox or out-
put shaft seals in motors and gearboxes and the
chain case.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 43
CONTROL VALVE
Specifications
Torque Specifications
CONTROL VALVE
Op. 35 724 50
REMOVAL
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins, 1. Roll the attachment plate to
the fully “DUMPED” position.
2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run
position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn off the key.
44
3. Raise the seat and seat pan to the raised latched
position, 1.
4. Remove the step shield, 2, to access the gear
pump area. For more access, remove the right or
left hydrostatic control handle assembly, 3 or 4.
CAUTION
Do not work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised latched position.
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev- 45
ing all pressure in the system.
46
46 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
47
7. Unplug the spool lock solenoids, 1.
8. Remove the pressure line, 2, and return line, 3;
cap both lines to prevent loss of oil and conta- 4
mination from entering the hydraulic system. 2 3
9. Remove the hydraulic lines connected to the
work ports of the control valve, 4, four or six lines, 7 5
if unit is equipped with auxiliary boom hydraulics
and cap. 7
10. Remove the line from the power beyond port, 5,
if equipped with auxiliary hydraulics and cap. 1
1
11. Unhook the control linkage from the control valve
spools at 6. 6 6
19984464
12. Remove the control valve retaining hardware, 7.
48
Lift the control valve assembly from the skid
steer.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 47
Op. 35 724 54
DISASSEMBLY AND INSPECTION
19984466
50
Op. 35 724 90
Spool Locks (Boom and Bucket)
Remove the solenoid plunger assemblies, 1, from
the ports, 2, over the control spool ends.
2
1
19984467
51
48 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
2
2 1
19984468
52
Remove the plug, 1, from the port, 2, over the main
relief valve port. Remove the plug, 3, from the port,
4, over the auxiliary control spool.
2 4
3
19984469
53
Spools, Caps, and O Rings
Oil is directed through the housing to the different 4
ports by way of the spools: the bucket spool, 1, the 1
boom spool, 2, and the auxiliary spool, 3.
Some oil circulates around the spools for lubrication
and smooth operation. If an oil leak appears on the
outside of the valve and all lines connected to the
ports are tight, check the O rings on each end of the
spools. The spools can be pulled from the control
valve housing while the valve is still in the skid steer 2
by disconnecting the control linkage and removing
5
3
the spool caps.
19984470
CAUTION
If removing spool caps on the tractor, make sure all 54
system pressure has been relieved first.
1
19984471
55
NOTE: Before removing the spools, make sure the
exposed portion of the spool is free from any paint or
corrosion which could damage the internal porting of
the valve.
3. Remove the spools, 1, from the valve body.
NOTE: Each spool is different. Make sure to replace
the correct spool in the correct part of the valve body.
19984472
1
56
4. Remove the O rings, 1, from the spool ports. In-
spect the O ring seating area for burrs, and re-
move them before installing new O rings.
1
19984473
57
50 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
4 13
3 8 9
3 10
12
2
19984474
58
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 51
PARTS INSPECTION
Inspect the control valve components thoroughly for 2
scratches or nicks, weak centering springs, weak lift 1
check springs, and scored lift checks or valve seats. 3
Valve Body, 1
1. Check for cracks in casting that allow an oil leak.
2. Check the lift check seats, 2.
3. Check O ring seating surfaces.
4. Damaged fitting thread areas.
Control Spools, 3
1. Check the spool lands for scratches.
19984475
2. Check spool straightness.
59
IMPORTANT: The spools are matched to the control
valve body. If excessively worn or damaged, replace
the control valve assembly.
NOTE: The three spools are different. Do not mix
spools and return spring assemblies during reas-
sembly.
Detent Caps, 1
1. Check the detent pins and springs for proper 1
operation. All pins should move freely and return
to position with spring pressure. 2
2. Clean the caps thoroughly and lubricate the pins
with a light grease.
Lift Checks, 2 3
1. Check the lift check seat surface for wear or
4
scratches.
2. Check the lift check springs, 3.
3. Check the caps to ensure free movement of lift
checks into the caps. 19984472
Orifice Plate, 4 (Boom Lower Circuit) 60
1. Check the flat surface for scratches.
2. Check the hole in the plate for dirt and clean.
Solenoid Spool Locks
1. Check solenoid operation
52 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
REASSEMBLY
1. Install O rings, 1, in the boom control spool ports,
the bucket control spool ports, and auxiliary con-
trol spool ports.
1
19984473
61
2. Install the O ring seals, 1, on the boom circuit re-
lief valve, 2, and all the plugs, 3.
3. Install small O rings, 4, and backup rings, 5, on
the relief valve and plugs.
62
4. Install the boom circuit relief valve, 1, into the
valve body.
5. Install the plugs, 2, over the bucket and auxiliary
spool caps.
2
2
19984468
1
63
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 53
2 4
3
19984469
64
7. Install new O rings, 1, on the spools.
8. Install the washers, 2, spring retaining plate with
small hole, 3, centering spring, 4, spring plate
with large hole, 5, and end screw, 6, on each
spool.
65
NOTE: The spring retaining plate with the small hole
must go next to the valve. The plate with the large
hole, 5, must be over the end pin, 6, for proper spool.
9. Tighten the end screw, 6, securely.
66
54 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
1 2 3
19984472
67
12. Install the plain cap, 1, over the bucket control
spool and the detent caps, 2, over the boom and 1
auxiliary control spools. Tighten the allen head
screws, 3, securely.
NOTE: If any spool binds in the housing, rotate the
spool 180_ and check it. If the spool still binds, check
the end caps for proper alignment. If a spool still
binds, the complete control valve must be replaced.
NOTE: On the tractor, binding can be caused by
mounting hardware that is too tight (valve to main 2
frame).
3
19984470
68
13. Install the solenoid plunger assemblies, 1, into
the ports, 2, over the control spool ends.
19984467
1
69
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 55
2 3 1
19984466
70
16. Install an O ring on the main system relief valve,
1, and install into the valve body.
19984465
71
56 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
REINSTALLATION
1. Place the rubber isolation mount, 1, in place
under the control valve space.
2. Reinstall the control valve into the skid steer with
the retaining hardware previously removed. 2
Align the valve with the control linkage and
torque the valve retaining hardware to 24 N·m
(18 ft. lbs.). 1
3. Reconnect the control linkage and wiring har-
ness to the lockout solenoids.
4. Reinstall orifice plate with the flat surface to-
wards valve body and the slotted side towards
19984464
the fitting in the rear boom port at 2.
72
5. Reinstall the hydraulic lines and tighten to seat
the fittings, then loosen the lines and retorque.
6. Refill the hydraulic reservoir with 10W-30 oil.
7. With the unit supported off the ground, start the
unit and check for any oil leaks and repair.
8. Reinstall the step shield and belly pan.
9. Recheck the hydraulic oil level and add as re-
quired.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 57
HYDRAULIC PUMP
Specifications 26000 Series
SL65B
Type Gear Pump
Output @2225 RPM - 17.6 US. GPM
69 bar (1000 PSI) (63.2 L/min)
Rotation (Viewed from shaft end) Clockwise
Gear teeth 13 per gear
Wear plate Black, powdered metal with Te-
flon coating
Bushings Teflon coated
Internal lubrication system Inlet (suction) side
58 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Op. 35 710 10
PUMP REMOVAL
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the lowered posi-
tion (resting on the ground), or remove any at-
tachment and raise the boom and rest on the
boom lock pins.
2. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the run
position and operate the boom and bucket con-
trol pedals to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn off the key.
3. Raise the seat and seat pan, 1, to the raised
latched position, 2.
4. Remove the step shield, 3, to access the gear 73
pump area. For more access remove the right or
left hydrostatic control handle assembly.
CAUTION
Do not work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised latched position.
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the skid steer.
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system.
74
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 59
75
7. Disconnect the hydrostatic high pressure hoses
at 1 and 2, and cap.
76
8. Remove suction line, 1, from the hydraulic reser-
voir, and cap to prevent oil loss.
9. Remove pressure line, 2, to the control valve,
and cap.
10. Disconnect the motor case drain line, 3, the two-
speed control valve return line, 4, and the pump
case drain tube, 5, and cap.
11. Remove the gear pump retaining hardware, 6,
and remove the gear pump from the skid steer.
77
60 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Op. 35 710 20
DISASSEMBLY
Identify the pump by the two series of numbers and
letters on the pump flange at 1.
26 = Series
0 = Features 0-Standard Single Gear Pump 1
08 = Displacement Code
L = Rotation (left, counterclockwise)
A = Catalog No.
A = Shaft, Port, Type, and Size
B = Revision Level
96 = Year Built 80
06 = Month Built
17 = Day Built
LJ = Tester
81
The 26000 gear pump consists of the following com-
ponents:
1. Capscrews
2. Pump front plate (drive end)
3. Pump body
4. Pump back plate
5. End cap O ring seals (2)
6. Pump idler gear assembly
7. Pump drive gear assembly
8. Wear plate
9. Backup gasket
10. Seal
82
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 61
PARTS INSPECTION
1. Inspect the pump front plate (drive end) for ex- 3
cessive wear. The oil grooves in the bushings in 1
the front plate should be in line with the dowel pin-
holes and 180 apart, 1. If the bushing oil
grooves are not positioned as noted, the bush-
ings have turned in the plate - the plate should be 3
replaced. 2
The bushings in the front plate should be at 3.20
mm (0.126) above the surface of the plate, 2. 4
Replace the front plate if the I.D. of the bushing
exceed 19.2 mm (0.755).
3
2. Check the seal areas, 3, for scratches or damage
that could prevent a good seal. 83
3. The plug, 4, does not have to be removed unless
damaged. The plug can be removed by thread-
ing a 3/8″ UNC bolt into the plug center. This plug
MUST be in place for proper pump operation.
4. Inspect the pump back plate for excessive wear.
The oil grooves in the back plate bushings should
be at approximately 37 to the pressure side, 1.
If the bushing oil grooves are not positioned as
noted, the bushings have turned in the plate, and
the plate should be replaced.
Replace the back plate if the I.D. of a bushing ex-
ceeds 19.2 mm (0.755″). Check for scoring on
the face of the back plate, 2. Replace the back
plate if wear exceeds 0.038 mm (0.0015″).
84
5. Inspect the pump body for excessive wear.
Check the pump body inside the gear pockets, 1,
for excessive scoring or wear.
Replace the pump body if the I.D. of gear pockets
exceed 43.7 mm (1.719″).
85
62 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
19984487
86
8. Inspect the pump gears for excessive wear.
Check for obvious twisted or broken shaft 4 2
splines, 1, on the drive gear. Replace if damage
is found. Inspect the gear keys and retaining
rings, 2, to ensure they are not sheared. Replace
if found twisted or sheared.
The gear shaft assemblies should measure
greater than or equal to 19.0 mm (0.748″) in the 2 1
bushing area, 3. If the shaft measures less then
3
the specified diameter, replace the gear assem- 3
bly.
The gear width, 4, should be close to the follow-
ing specs. If the gears measure less than the 19984488
specified width, the gear pump will not develop 87
sufficient flow or pressure for loader application.
REASSEMBLY
1. Coat all parts with a thin coat of petroleum jelly or
oil to aid in reassembly.
2. Install a new washer, 1, and shaft seal, 2, in the 1 2
pump front plate (drive end), 3. The seal is
pressed into the housing to a depth of 6.35 mm
(0.25) from the outer seal housing lip.
NOTE: Once the seal is installed, make sure that the
washer can rotate freely. If the washer cannot rotate,
reinstall the seal to a lesser depth to obtain freedom
of movement for the washer. 3
19984489
89
3. Install new O rings, 1, in the pump front and back
plates. Ensure that the plug, 2, is installed on the
1
pressure side of the pump front plate (drive end),
3.
2 3
19984490
90
4. Make sure the dowel pins, 1, are in place and in-
stall the body on the pump front plate (drive end) 1
with the half-moon cavities in the body facing
away from the pump front plate. Check that the
reference marks made during disassembly align
correctly.
NOTE: The small half-moon cavity, 2, must be on the
pressure side (plugged side) of the pump. 2
1
19984491
91
64 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
5 4
19984487
92
NOTE: The gasket AND seal must align and lay flat
at 4 when installed in the wear plate.
93
6. Install the wear plate assembly, 1, with the
gasket/seal side towards the pump front plate,
into the body cavity with the mid section cut away 1
on the suction side (large half moon cavity), 2, of
the pump.
NOTE: To best accomplish the installation of the
wear plate, hold the pump body/front plate assembly
upside down while sliding the wear plate assembly
up into the housing until it is seated against the front
plate. This helps ensure that the seal and backup
gasket stay in place.
2
19984492
94
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 65
19984493
95
8. Install the pump back plate, 1, over the gear
shafts. Check that the reference marks made
during disassembly align correctly.
96
9. Install the housing hardware with the four bolts
with sealing washers, 1, on the inside bolt holes,
2, with the remaining bolts installed in outside
holes, 3. Torque the bolts evenly in a criss-cross
pattern to 34 - 38 N·m (25 - 28 ft. lbs.).
3
2 1
19984494
97
66 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
INSTALLATION
1. Install a new O ring, 1, on the gear pump pilot, 2.
For SL65B skid steers, install the gear pump onto 1
the hydrostatic pump, mating the splines on the
input shaft. Tighten the mounting hardware to 39 2
N⋅m (29 ft. lbs.).
19987701
98
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 67
2
3
104
8. Connect hydrostatic lines, 1 and 2, previously re-
moved for pump access.
105
9. Reconnect hydraulic line, 1, previously removed
to drain the reservoir.
10. Fill the reservoir with SAE 10W-30 oil to the
proper level.
11. Reinstall the hydrostatic control lever assem-
blies, if removed, and install the step shield.
106
68 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Torque
Torque
BOOM CYLINDER
Op. 35 710 10
REMOVAL
CAUTION
Before removing the boom cylinders, the boom must
be in the up, locked position supported by the boom
lock pins.
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system.
108
5. Turn off the ignition switch.
6. Disconnect both the upper, 1, and lower, 2, boom
hydraulic hoses from the cylinder.
109
7. Using a screwdriver, remove the plastic plug, 1,
from inside the cab to access the lower cylinder
pivot retaining hardware.
8. Loosen the LOWER boom pin retaining hard-
ware.
NOTE: DO NOT remove the retaining hardware at
this time.
110
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 71
111
10. Remove the UPPER boom pin retaining bolt, 1,
and boom pin, 2.
11. Remove the cylinder.
112
Op. 35 730 18
DISASSEMBLY
1. Thoroughly clean the outside of the cylinder.
2. Pull the piston rod out slowly, and drain the oil
from the barrel into a suitable container.
3. Clamp the base of the cylinder in a vise at 1, and
unscrew the cylinder head (gland), 2.
NOTE: Do not clamp the cylinder barrel in the vise to
unscrew the cylinder head. Flattening of the barrel
will cause damage to the piston and piston seals.
113
72 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
114
5. Remove the piston retaining nut, 1; the piston, 2;
spacer, 3; and cylinder head (gland), 4, from the
piston rod, 5.
115
6. Remove the wiper seal, 1; O ring and backup
washer, 2; and inner seal and wear ring, 3, from
the cylinder head (gland), 4.
116
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 73
117
PARTS INSPECTION
1. Thoroughly clean all parts and remove any nicks
or burrs with a fine emery cloth.
2. Inspect the inner diameter of the barrel, 1, for ex-
cessive wear or scoring.
3. Inspect the threaded area of the barrel, 2, for
damaged threads that would prevent proper
tightening of the cylinder head.
4. Inspect the O ring seal area, 3, and remove any
burrs or nicks that could damage or prevent the
O ring from sealing properly.
118
5. Inspect the outer diameter of the piston, 1, for ex-
cessive wear or scoring. If the piston is damaged,
the inner surface of the barrel will also most likely
be damaged. Inspect the barrel thoroughly. If the
piston is not damaged, do not replace.
119
74 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
2 2
1
19987106
120
6. Inspect the cylinder head (gland) inner and outer
seal areas, 1 and 2, for sharp edges and scoring.
Inspect the threaded area of the gland, 3, for
damaged threads that would prevent proper
tightening of the retaining nut. Replace the gland
if necessary. All seals should be replaced during
reassembly.
121
REASSEMBLY
1. Clean and dry all parts. The metal parts should
be lightly oiled prior to assembly.
2. Install a new O ring, 1, and backup washer, 2, in
the outer groove of the cylinder head, 3. Install a
new shaft seal, 4, and wear ring, 5, in the inner
grooves.
NOTE: Install the shaft oil seal, 4, with the lip of the
seal facing the piston.
3. Install a new shaft wiper seal, 6, into the cylinder
head. The seal lip should face outward.
122
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 75
19987106
123
5. Install the cylinder head assembly, 1, and spacer,
2, onto the piston rod, 3.
6. Prior to installing the piston, clean and apply a
bead of hydraulic sealant between the piston and
piston rod at 4. Install the piston assembly, 5, and
new locknut, 6. The wear ring on the piston
should be toward the threaded end of the rod.
NOTE: The flat side of the piston must face the
spacer, and the recessed side must face toward the
end of the rod. The effective length of the piston rod
must be maintained, with the locknut fitting into the
recessed area of the piston.
7. Torque the locknut to 230 N·m (170 ft. lbs.).
124
8. Lubricate the piston and cylinder head assem-
blies with 10W-30 oil and install the piston rod as-
sembly, 1, into the barrel, 2.
9. Prior to threading the cylinder head into the bar-
rel, apply a coat of grease around the cylinder
head, in the area between the backup washer
and the cylinder head flange at 3.
10. Torque the cylinder head assembly to 306 N·m
(225 ft. lbs.).
125
76 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
REINSTALLATION
1. Lubricate the boom pivot pins, 1, with an antise-
1
ize-type lubricant.
2. Install the cylinder onto the skid steer.
NOTE: Refer to Service Bulletins 5/96 - I6 and 7/96 2
- I6 for updated pivot pin support information and
proper pin, spacer, and bolt part numbers.
3. Install a 3/8″ bolt, 2; flat washer, 3; and spacer, 4,
through the pivot pin retaining strap and boom 6
side plate. Secure with flat washer, 5, and lock- 3
nut, 6. 5 4
4. Torque the upper pivot pin hardware to 38 N·m 19997745
(28 ft. lbs.).
126
5. Install the lower pivot pin and 3/4″ hardware at 1,
and torque to 338 N·m (250 ft. lbs.).
6. Using a six-pound hammer and a piece of 2x4
hardwood to protect the pivot pin, place the board
over the end of the pin and hit briskly to properly
seat the tapered pin in the side frame. Retorque
the hardware to 338 N·m (250 ft. lbs.).
7. Reinstall the hydraulic tubes, 2, and position to
prevent contact with other components, fenders,
etc. at 3.
8. Reinstall the plastic plug on the side of the cab
inner shell.
9. Start the skid steer and cycle the boom several
times to remove trapped air from the system and 127
check the cylinder for leaks.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 77
BUCKET CYLINDER
Op. 35 730 10
REMOVAL
CAUTION
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first reliev-
ing all pressure in the system.
129
Op. 35 730 13
DISASSEMBLY
1. Clean the outside of the cylinder and clamp the
cylinder base, 1, in a vise.
2. Use a spanner wrench to remove the cylinder
gland, 2. The gland is threaded into the cylinder.
3. Pull the cylinder rod assembly from the barrel.
130
78 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
131
5. Remove seals from the gland; the outer O ring
seal and backup ring, 1, the inner shaft seal, 2,
and the wiper seal, 3.
132
PARTS INSPECTION
1. Thoroughly clean all parts and remove all nicks
and burrs with a fine emery cloth.
2. Inspect the inner diameter of the barrel for ex-
cessive wear or scoring.
3. Inspect the gland thread area, 1, for damaged
threads that would prevent proper tightening of
the gland.
4. Inspect the O ring seal area, 2, and remove burrs
or nicks that would prevent the O ring from seal-
ing properly.
133
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 79
134
Make sure the new “T” seal, 1, and two backup
seals, 2, are installed correctly.
2
1
80 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
137
REASSEMBLY
1. Clean and dry all parts. The metal parts should
be lightly oiled prior to assembly.
2. Install a new shaft seal, 2.
3. Install a wiper seal, 1, and wear ring, 3.
NOTE: Install shaft seal, 2, with the lip of the seal
facing the piston.
138
4. Install O ring, 1, and backup washer, 2, on the cyl-
inder gland.
139
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 81
19987106
140
6. Slide cylinder gland, 1, and piston, 2, with seals
installed, 3, onto the piston rod.
7. Use a hydraulic sealant to seal the piston and
rod. Install piston retaining stud, 4, with medium-
strength 242 Loctite and torque to 386 N·m (285
ft. lbs.).
82 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
143
REINSTALLATION
1. Lubricate the pivot pins with an antiseize-type lu-
bricant.
2. Install the cylinder on the skid steer.
3. Torque the upper pivot pin hardware to 108 N·m
(80 ft. lbs.).
4. With a hammer and using a piece of 2 x 4 hard-
wood to protect the pin, hit the pivot pin and re-
taining hardware at 1, to properly seat the tap-
ered pin and retorque to 108 N⋅m (80 ft. lbs.).
5. Torque the lower pivot pin hardware to 38 N·m
(28 ft. lbs.).
6. Cycle the boom several times to remove the air 144
from the system and check the cylinder for leaks.
7. Check the hydraulic oil level and add 10W-30 oil
as required.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 83
PEDAL CONTROLS
Op. 35 724 16
REMOVAL
With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls
1. Remove the step shield hardware and step
shield.
2. Remove the clip washer, 1, that connects the 1
control rod, 2, to the pedal hub arm. 2
145
3. Remove the bolts, 1, connecting the two bracket
halves.
4. Disconnect the control valve links, 2, at the con- 1
trol valve.
5. Remove the pedal mounting bolts, 3, and remove
both pedals from the loader.
3
3
146
PEDAL INSPECTION
2
With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls
1. Remove the control valve links, 1, from the hub 1 1
control arms, 2.
19996895
147
84 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
19996894
148
3. Inspect the auxiliary hydraulic hub arm, 1, the
boom hub arm, 2, and the bucket hub arm, 3, for 1
any deformation or cracks. 4
2 4
4. To disassemble hub arms, remove the roll pins, 3
4, from the hub arms and control shaft.
5. Inspect the control shafts, 5, for any obvious
damage or bends.
5
5
19996893
149
6. To remove control shafts, remove bolt, 1, secur-
ing shaft arm to pedal. Take note of the position 2
and number of any spacer washers or shims. Re-
move the nuts, 2, holding the bearings on the
pedal support. Separate the shaft from the pedal
and bearing.
2
1
19996891
150
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 85
19996826
151
8. Inspect the pedals, 1, and pedal supports, 2, for
any excessive wear or deformation.
19996827
152
PEDAL REINSTALLATION
With Boom and Bucket Pedal Controls
1 1
1. Reinstall the bearings, 1, shafts, 2, brackets, 3, 3
and control arms, 4, using the same number and
position of washers or shims.
2 4 4 2
19996896
153
86 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
154
3. Slide the pedal assembly to align the auxiliary
boom hydraulic hub arm and boom hub arm as
shown. Align the inside edge of each hub arm, 1,
with the slot in the control valve spool, 2. Tighten
the pedal mounting hardware.
4. Recheck the alignment of the hub arm and spool.
2
155
5. Install the right pedal, 1, adding shim washers as
necessary so pedal mounting holes line up cor-
rectly. Check that the inside edge of the bucket 1
hub arm aligns with the slot in the control valve 3
spool as described above. Install the pedal with
hardware, 2, previously removed, and tighten se-
curely. Connect the two-piece bracket with the
two bolts, 3, washers and nuts.
2
6. Check for free operation of the foot pedals and
hub control arm assemblies. If any components
are binding, adjust or reshim the pedal assem-
blies.
156
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 87
157
9. Connect the auxiliary hydraulic control rod, 1, to
the pedal hub arm, 2, with the clip washer re-
moved during disassembly.
10. Install the step shield and hardware.
3
2
1
158
88 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Op. 35 724 16
PEDAL REMOVAL
With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls
1. Remove the step shield hardware and step 2 2
shield.
2. Remove the bolts, 1, washers, lock washers and
nuts, that connect the control rods, 2, to the pedal
hub arms.
159
3. Disconnect the control valve links, 1, from the
control valve spools by removing the cotter pins,
2, and clevis pins, 3. 3
4. Disconnect the control valve links, 1, from the
control hub arms by removing the bolts, 4,
2 1
washers, lockwashers, and nuts. 1
19996833
160
5. Remove the right pedal mounting bolts, 1, and re-
move the right pedal, 2.
6. Remove the left pedal mounting bolts, 3, and re-
move the left pedal, 4.
1
3
4 2
19996832
161
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 89
PEDAL INSPECTION
With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls
1. Remove the bucket hub arm assembly, 1, and 3
4
the boom hub arm assembly, 2. Inspect the hub
arm assemblies for any deformation or cracks.
2. Inspect the control shaft, 3, for any obvious dam-
age or bends. To remove control shafts, remove
the two allen screws, 4, securing the auxiliary hy-
draulic hub, 2, to the control shaft. Then remove
the bolt, 5, securing shaft arm to pedal. Take note
of the position and number of any spacer 5
washers or shims. 2 1
19996824
162
3. Remove the two allen screws, 1, securing the
boom hydraulics hub, 2, to the control shaft. In- 1
spect the boom hydraulics hub for any deforma-
tion or cracks. 2
19996825
163
4. Inspect the shaft bearings, 1, for excessive wear.
If bearings do not move freely, replace.
1
19996826
164
90 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
19996827
165
6. Inspect the control valve spool links, 1, for bends
or excessive wear. 1
19996829
166
PEDAL REINSTALLATION
With Boom and Bucket Hand Controls 3
1. Insert the control shaft, 1, through the left pedal, 1
6
2, and left pedal support, 3, fitting three washers,
4, between the pedal and support. 5
2. Slide the auxiliary boom hydraulic hub assembly,
5, onto the control shaft and secure with allen
screws, 6.
2 4
19996824
167
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 91
19996831
168
5. Slide the pedal assembly to align the auxiliary hy-
draulic hub arm as shown. Align the inside edge
of the hydraulic hub arm, 1, with the slot in the
control valve spool, 2. Tighten the pedal mount-
ing hardware.
6. Recheck the alignment of the hub arm and spool.
7. Check the alignment between the hub arms and 2
control valve spools. Add shim washers if
necessary to correct alignment.
1
169
8. Install the right pedal, 1, adding shim washers as
necessary at 2, fitting inside the bearing, 3, so 3
pedal mounting holes line up correctly. Install the
pedal with hardware, 4, previously removed, and 2
tighten securely.
4
9. Check for free operation of the foot pedals and
hub assemblies. If any components are binding,
adjust or reshim the right pedal assembly.
1
19996832
170
92 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
8
19996833
171
13. Install control rods, 1, to the pedal hub arms, 2,
with the bolts, washers, lock washers and nuts
removed during pedal removal.
14. Install the step shield and step shield hardware.
1
1
172
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 93
Op. 35 705
FILTER SYSTEM
The skid steer is equipped with a single spin-on filter
canister type located at 1, to the right of the engine
radiator. The filter is a 10-micron element.
NOTE: Allow the hydraulic oil to cool before changing
the filter.
CAUTION
The hydraulic oil filter will be under pressure when
the oil is at operating temperature.
173
The filter base is equipped with a bypass valve, 1, to
allow cold oil to bypass the filter without damaging
the filter or starving the hydrostatic system of lubrica-
tion oil during cold weather start-ups.
In cold weather start-ups, allow the hydraulic oil to
warm up before operating the boom, bucket, or the
hydrostatic ground drive system, to prevent possible
damage to the systems.
The filter base is also equipped with a pressure sen-
sor that is monitored by the EIC (Electronic Instru-
ment Cluster) to signal the operator of a plugged oil
filter.
174
Op. 35 705 04
FILTER REMOVAL
Op. 35 705 05
BASE REMOVAL
The filter base can be removed by opening the rear
door and removing the right engine side panel.
1. Remove the sensor wires, 3.
2. Remove the inlet, 2, and outlet, 6, oil lines and
cap to prevent loss of oil.
3. Remove the two cap screws, 5; ground wire, 7;
and wire clamp, 4.
4. Remove the filter assembly, 1, from the unit. 175
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 95
REASSEMBLY
1. Reinstall the filter base with the hardware previ-
ously removed and reconnect the ground wire, 1.
Torque the mounting hardware to 20 N·m (15 ft.
lbs.).
2. Reinstall the hydraulic lines, tighten the lines to
seat line on fittings; loosen and retorque.
3. Reinstall the filter sensor and connect the sensor
wires, 2.
4. Reinstall a new filter, coat the filter seal ring with
10W-30 oil, and tighten the filter unit until it con-
tacts the base, and then tighten another half to
three-quarter turn.
176
96 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
OIL COOLER
Op. 35 300 10
REMOVAL
The hydraulic oil cooler is located between the radi-
ator and the engine cooling fan. To access the oil
cooler, the radiator will have to be removed.
1. Drain the engine cooling system.
2. Lift up on the release handles, 1, and move the
radiator rearward.
3. Disconnect the upper and lower radiator hoses,
2.
4. Remove the coolant overflow hose to the over- 177
flow tank, 3.
5. Remove the two cap screws and spacers, 4. Re-
move the radiator.
6. Disconnect the oil cooler inlet and outlet lines, 1,
at the bottom of the cooler. Cap to prevent loss
of oil and contamination.
7. Remove the four nuts holding the fan shroud and
move it forward.
8. Remove four cap screws, 2, and remove the oil
cooler from the support frame.
178
REASSEMBLY
1. Reattach the oil cooler, 1, to the support bracket
with the previously removed hardware.
2. Reattach the fan shroud.
3. Reconnect the hydraulic lines to the oil cooler.
Tighten the lines to seat the fittings, then loosen
and retighten the connections.
4. Remount the radiator, 2, reinstalling the two
spacers and cap screws.
5. Reconnect the radiator hoses and fill the cooling
system with a 50/50 water-antifreeze mixture
with corrosion inhibitor.
6. Check the hydraulic oil level and fill with 10W-30 179
oil as necessary.
7. Start the unit, operate the hydraulic system, and
check for oil and coolant leaks. Repair as required.
8. Recheck hydraulic oil and coolant levels and add
as required.
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 97
Op. 35 300
OIL RESERVOIR
The hydraulic oil reservoir fill is accessed through the
top engine shield. The fill cap assembly is the hy-
draulic system breather and is equipped with a
screen to help prevent contamination into the sys-
tem.
To clean the breather cap, 1, remove the cap from the
reservoir and back flush the cap assembly with a
clean solvent. Blow dry with low-pressure air.
180
Op. 35 300 28
Filter/Breather Cap Cleaning
To clean the fill screen, remove the six screws and
washers, 2, and lift the screen assembly from the res-
ervoir neck. Carefully clean the filler neck area before
removing the screen.
Back flush the screen, 1, with a clean solvent and
blow dry with low-pressure air.
Reinstall the screen assembly making sure the
screen is sealed between the screen and reservoir
neck with gaskets, 2. Use of a silicone sealer with
gaskets to seal between the screen and reservoir is
recommended.
181
The hydraulic reservoir is equipped with a tempera-
ture sender, 1, which allows the EIC (Electronic In-
strument Cluster) to monitor the hydraulic oil tem-
perature and signal the operator of an oil overheat
condition.
IMPORTANT: Do not over tighten the sender or dam-
age to the reservoir may occur.
182
98 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Op. 35 300 10
OIL RESERVOIR REMOVAL
To access the reservoir, open the rear door and re-
move the right engine side shield.
To remove the reservoir from the skid steer, the cab
and boom must be tilted forward. Refer to Section 1
for cab tilting procedures.
183
With the cab tilted forward:
1. Remove the rear engine belly pan.
2. Drain the reservoir by removing hydraulic line, 1,
and allowing the oil to drain into a suitable con-
tainer.
184
3. Remove the hydraulic oil temperature sender
wires, 1 and 2.
4. Disconnect the suction and return lines, 3 and 4,
from the oil tank.
5. Remove front and rear mounting hardware, 5.
6. Lift the oil reservoir from the skid steer.
NOTE: If the reservoir should leak due to a hole or
crack, DO NOT repair. Replace the reservoir.
185
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 99
INSPECTION
Check the reservoir for cracks and leaks. Check for
signs of interference or wear from the transmission
control arm.
186
NOTE: The reservoirs have a vent area molded into
the fill neck, 1, to allow air to escape around the plas-
tic strainer when filling the tank. This improves the
rate that oil can be added to the reservoir.
IMPORTANT: Do not remove or modify the plastic
strainer, as any material that gets past the strainer
can go directly to the gear pump, control valve,
cylinders, and auxiliary hydraulic attachments and
cause major damage to these components.
187
Inspect the return line port, 1, and suction line port,
2, for cracks and debris buildup.
188
100 SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
REINSTALLATION
1. To increase the reservoir clearance from the con-
trol arm, install a #80424 socket-head setscrew,
3/8 x 5/8, as a plug in hole, 1, in the chaincase.
Apply pipe thread sealer or Loctite to the plug
threads to keep chaincase oil from leaking out
and to hold the plug in place.
2. Loosely reinstall the previously removed hard-
ware with thread sealer applied into tank slot, 2,
and thread into the chaincase.
3. Install the previously removed rear hardware
loosely in the tank slot/chain mount, 1. Make sure
the tank is positioned flat against the chaincase
wall. Tighten front hardware bolt assembly and 189
rear hardware bolt assembly securely to hold the
tank in place.
4. Install the two oil temperature sender wires, 1
and 2.
5. Connect the suction and return lines, 3 and 4,
and tighten the hose clamps securely. Check the
mounting hardware, 5, is tight.
6. Reconnect the hydraulic line disconnected for
draining.
190
7. Fill the tank with SAE 10W-30 oil and operate the
system to remove all air from the system. Check
for leaks. Repair as required.
8. Install the rear engine belly pan.
9. Tilt the cab and boom back to operating position.
10. Reinstall all shields previously removed.
191
SECTION 35 – HYDRAULIC SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 101
CONTENT
Op. 37 140 10
REAR COUNTERWEIGHTS
Counterweights can be installed to improve the sta-
bility of the loader when handling heavy loads or
when operating the skid steer with a heavy front
mounted attachment.
Six 27.2 kg (60.0 lbs) weights, 1, (three per side may
be added to the rear of the loader as shown.
The rear counterweights should be removed when
not required. Operating the skid steer with rear 1
counterweights installed and with light front loads,
3173-03
may cause uneven tire wear.
1
Op. 37 140 12
CONTENT
GENERAL INFORMATION
ROPS
The ROPS, 1, is a welded frame structure to provide
rollover protection for the operator and pivot point
locations for the boom assembly.
1
ROPS FRAME
Op. 90 152 46 1
1
REMOVAL
The ROPS can be removed from the lower frame with
the cab inner shell and boom attached in place or
removed.
To remove the ROPS with the inner shell and
boom removed:
Follow the instructions for “Cab Inner Shell Removal” 2 2
in Section 90 and “Boom, Upper and Lower Link
Removal” in Section 82. 19984332
1. Remove the rear attaching bolts, 1, left and right 2
sides.
NOTE: If the rear bolts, 1, have spacers under the
bolt heads they must be reinstalled during
reassembly for proper torquing.
2. Support the ROPS with a suitable lifting device
and remove the front attaching bolts, 1, two each
side.
3. Lift the ROPS frame from the lower main frame
and move to a level area. Lower the ROPS to the
floor.
3
SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1 3
5
6. Lower the boom to the lowered position and turn
the ignition (key) switch to the “OFF” position. Do
not unbuckle the seat belt and exit the loader.
7. Relieve the hydraulic pressure from the boom
and bucket circuits.
– Turn the ignition (key) switch to the “ON”
position.
– Operate the boom and bucket controls
relieving all pressure in the system.
– Turn the ignition switch “OFF” and exit the
loader.
6
4 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1
7
9. Disconnect the parking brake linkage at 1.
10. Raise the parking brake control lever, 2, to the
raised, engaged position.
8
11. Disconnect the (–) negative ground battery
cable, 1.
+ –
9
SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1 5
10
16. Remove the wire harness clamps and plastic ties
along the left side of the lower frame at 1, 2, and
3.
11
17. Remove the ground strap, 1, from the cab inner
shell and lower main frame.
12
6 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1
13
19. Remove the throttle control cable, 1, from the
control lever at 2. Remove the cable retaining
nut, 3, and slide the cable down through the right
side shield at 4.
14
20. With the boom in the lowered position and the
hydraulic pressure relieved in the boom and
bucket circuits, disconnect the boom, bucket, 1 1
and auxiliary boom hydraulics hose connections,
1, and cap all connections.
CAUTION
Never loosen any hydraulic lines without first
relieving all pressure in the system.
15
SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1 7
16
22. With a suitable lifting device, support the boom at
the rear, lifting the boom assembly until it
contacts the boom lock pins, 1.
17
23. With a suitable lifting device, support the boom at
the rear, and lift the boom assembly at the front
until it contacts the boom lock pins, 1.
18
8 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1
2 2
19984332
19
25. Remove the right and left front retaining bolts, 1.
26. Lift the ROPS and boom assembly from the lower
main frame and move to a level area. Rest the
assembly on the floor, lowering the boom to the
floor.
20
SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1 9
REINSTALLATION
1. Lift the ROPS and boom assembly onto the lower
frame resting the rear ROPS post on the lower
frame pads. Supporting the front of the ROPS,
install the front retaining hardware at 1. With the
front hardware installed, align the rear ROPS
posts and install the rear hardware at 2.
2. Torque the front hardware, 1, to 160 ft. lbs. (217
N·m).
21
3. Torque the rear hardware, 1, to 80 ft. lbs.
(108 N·m).
NOTE: If the rear bolts, 1, had spacers, 2, under the 1
1
bolt heads, they must be reinstalled during
reassembly for proper torquing.
2 2
19984332
22
4. With the ROPS and boom securely attached to
the lower frame and the boom in the lowered 1 1 1
position, remove the lifting device from the
ROPS.
5. Reinstall the wire harness, 1, along the main
frame and attach the engine fuse/relay panel.
6. Reconnect the main harness to the engine
harness, re-route the wire harness along the fuel
tank and the right side of the engine installing all
clamps and ties previously removed.
23
10 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1
24
8. Reconnect all hydraulic lines, 1, and position for
clearances between other components. Install
any hose clamps removed. 1 1
25
9. Slide the throttle cable up through the hole in the
left cab panel and secure with retaining nut at 1.
Reattach the cable to the control handle at 2. 2
26
SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1 11
27
12. After all wires and hydraulic hoses are
connected, start the unit, raise the boom, and
check for oil leaks.
NOTE: The boom and bucket hydraulic circuits may
require cycling several times to purge the air from the
hydraulic system.
13. Reinstall all fenders, shields, etc. removed.
14. After the fenders are reinstalled, raise and lower
the boom and recheck the hoses and tubes for
clearance at 1. Readjust the hoses and tubes if
they contact the fenders.
28
12 SECTION 39 – FRAMES – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS
Chapter 1 – Axles
CONTENT
Op. 44 100
GENERAL INFORMATION
Each of the two hydrostatic pumps is driven by the
engine through a spur gear configuration located in
the engine-to-transmission gearbox. The hydrostatic
pumps then transmit hydraulic power to the hydro-
static motors, 1, which are connected to gearboxes,
2, located on the inside of the final drive cases. The
left and right drives are separate from each other and
are operated independently.
2
Power is then transmitted through gears to a drive
sprocket, 1, in the final drive case. The drive sprocket
is connected to the axle sprockets, 2, with chains, 3,
one endless chain to the front axle and one endless
chain to the rear axle.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 3
OPS844
4
General arrangement of Chains and Axles
1. FINAL DRIVE SPROCKET ASSEMBLIES (2) 3. AXLE DRIVE SPROCKETS (4)
2. DRIVE CHAINS(FRONT AND REAR) (4) 4. AXLES ASSEMBLIES (4)
4 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
SPECIFICATIONS
Drive Axles
Description Use
Ultra/Blue Silicone Sealer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gearbox mounting bolts
Axle housing bolts
Chain case cover bolts
Gearbox to chain case
Gearbox cover and bolts
Sealing Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . NH Ultra Blue silicone sealer
Gear Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80W-90 API Service GL-5 Gear Oil
Grease . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High viscosity lithium base
NOTE: Always use a noncorrosive silicone sealer to seal where required to prevent corrosion during the sili-
cone curing process.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 5
TROUBLESHOOTING
Before servicing or adjusting the final drive system,
the skid steer should be jacked up with the wheels off
the ground.
Remove any attachment from the skid steer; boom,
bucket, etc. Lower the boom to the lowered position
or, if servicing requires the boom to be in the raised
position, support the boom on the boom lock pins.
Raise the boom and lower onto the boom lock pins,
1.
1. Raise the boom above the boom lock pins.
2. Engage the boom lock pins.
3. Stop the engine; ignition key in the “OFF” posi- 5
tion.
4. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position.
5. Lower the boom onto the boom lock pins.
6. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position.
CAUTION
Never exit the loader with the boom in the raised posi-
tion unless the boom is supported on the boom lock
pins.
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment
mounted. Always remove the attachment from the
loader.
6
6 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
One drive wheel not powered Broken drive chain Check chain and repair
Axle or drive sprocket splines Check axle and sprocket;
worn replace
Chain case noise Loose drive chains Check and adjust chains
No oil in final drive Check oil level
Worn drive sprockets Check sprockets and repair
Bearing failure Check axle and gearbox
bearings and repair
Excessive axle play Bearing failure on axle shaft Check bearings and repair
Snap ring failure on axle shaft Check axle bearing preload;
repair
Final drive case leaking Oil escaping past case side sheet Reinstall with sealant as
and reinforcing plate described in Service Bulletin
(7/95-I7)
Oil escaping past studs Remove and reseal studs
Oil escaping around center Remove plate and reseal
inspection plate
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 7
TESTING
FINAL DRIVE
Pretest instructions:
* Operator in seat with seat belt buckled.
* Engine running at high idle (full throttle).
* Park brake in disengaged position.
STEP TEST RESULT PROBABLE CAUSE AND CORRECTION
1 Push both drive controls YES Drive system OK.
forward equally and loader
should move in a straight line. NO Engine stalls, wheels appear locked, check parking
brake for engaged. If OK, go to step 2.
Pretest instructions:
* Lower boom and attachment to the ground.
* Stop engine.
* Jack loader with wheels off the ground.
* Release parking brake.
Op. 44 106
AXLES
Op. 44 106 10
AXLE HOUSING ASSEMBLY REMOVAL
The axle housings must be removed to service the
axle seals, axle bearings, drive chains, drive
sprockets, and axle housing mounting bolts.
NOTE: The axle housings may be removed without
removing the final drive side cover or draining the
case oil.
1. Lower the boom and attachment to the ground. 7
2. If the work is going to be done with the boom in
the raised position, remove the attachment, raise
the boom, and rest the boom on the boom lock
pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the loader.
8
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 9
10
Op. 44 106 16
DISASSEMBLY
NOTE: A press is required to remove the axle shaft
and hub assembly from the housing.
1. Remove the retaining ring, 1, from the axle shaft.
2. Remove the shims, 2. Note the thickness and
number of shims.
3. Place the housing assembly in a press; support
the housing as close to the center of the housing
as possible to prevent damage to the housing.
4. Press the axle and hub assembly, 3, from the
housing.
11
10 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
12
7. Remove the inner bearing race, 1, by driving it
from the housing with a suitable hammer and
driver.
13
8. Remove the outer replaceable seal sleeve, 1, by
prying it from the axle housing.
9. Remove the outer bearing race, 2, and seal, 3, by
driving them from the housing with a suitable
hammer and driver.
Note the positioning of the oil seal before re-
moval, as the replacement seal should be posi-
tioned in the same position.
14
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 11
15
11. Shown here are the related parts used in the axle
assembly.
1. Housing
2. Axle and hub assembly
3. Outer seal
4. Outer seal sleeve
5. Outer bearing assembly
6. Inner bearing assembly
7. Inner seal
8. Shims
9. Retaining ring
16
PARTS INSPECTION
Thoroughly clean all parts before inspection.
1. Inspect the housing flange, 1, and bearing race
areas, 2. Replace the seals and replaceable seal
sleeve if worn or damaged.
17
12 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
18
REASSEMBLY
1. Install the outer seal, 1, as shown, on the axle-
hub assembly. Fill the grooves in the seal with
grease.
2. Pack the bearing with grease and install the outer
bearing, 2, with a suitable bearing driver.
3. Wrap the axle in the retaining ring groove area,
3, with a single layer of plastic tape to prevent
damage to the seal during assembly.
NOTE: If the bearing failed because of excessive
contamination, use green Loctite 609 on the seal
housing to shoulder press-fit joint. If the axle shoul-
der is worn from previous seal rotation, use a new
axle and seal, and use loctite to seal the joint. 19
NOTE: When reinstalling the axle into the axle hous-
ing, be sure both bearings are packed with grease.
The cavity in between the triple lip seal and axle seal,
where the outer bearing is positioned, must be full of
grease. If any old or hardened grease is in a housing
that will be reused, be sure to clean the housing and
fill it with new grease. The axle bearings should be
greased every 500 hours, or if a wheel or tyre is re-
moved for repair, grease the axle bearings at that
time.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 13
20
7. Place the housing over the axle and hub assem-
bly making sure the outer bearing is properly
seated in the race.
8. Remove the tape from the axle shaft.
9. Install the inner bearing race, 1, into the housing.
21
10. Pack the bearing with grease and install the inner
bearing, 1.
Press the inner bearing on the axle shaft and into
the housing to obtain housing rolling torque of 9
- 15 lbs.
NOTE: To check housing rolling torque, hook a
spring scale in one of the housing flange slots, 2, and
pull on the scale to rotate the housing.
11. Add shims to fill the space between the bearing
race, 3, and retaining ring, 4.
12. Install the retaining ring in groove, 5.
22
14 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
13. Fill the outer seal area with grease until the
grease appears around the hub at 1; spin the axle
housing while adding grease.
14. Install the O ring in the groove in the axle housing
flange at 2; wipe a layer of grease over the O ring
to help hold the O ring in place during assembly.
23
REINSTALLATION
1. Clean the final drive case.
2. Inspect the axle opening in the case to make sure
it is flat for a good seal between the case and axle
housing. To check surface flatness, lay a straigh-
tedge across the axle opening in the horizontal
and vertical planes, 1. Straighten if required.
3. Inspect the axle assembly retaining bolts, 2, and
replace if damaged.
– To replace a stud, the old stud can be driven
out with a hammer and suitable driver.
– Thoroughly clean the inside and outside of
the case in the stud area.
24
– Wipe the new stud with a wicking-type seal-
ant. The new stud can be installed into the
case by using a 3/4″ thick spacer over the
stud and then using the nut and a flat washer
to pull the stud in place.
– Wipe around the stud with a wicking-type
sealant to ensure an oil tight seal.
If there are signs of oil leaking out of the bottom of the
axle housing, the oil may be escaping between the 1
final drive case sheet and the outer reinforcing plate.
The reinforcing plate, 1, has a narrower opening than
the drive case sheet, 2. If the loader frame is welded
between the reinforcing plate and drive case sheet,
the case should not leak. 3
To seal off this area and prevent leaks, clean the final
drive case around the pilot mating area, 2, and 2
around the studs, 3, with an appropriate cleaner.
Place a bead of silicone sealant (such as part
#L58775), around the side sheet mating area, 2, and
the studs, 3. 19987113
NOTE: When installing the final drive case, the case 25
must lay flat against the frame and the pilot must rest
on the edge of the frame opening.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 15
26
6. With the axle housing, 1, tight against the case,
install the retaining nuts and flat washers, 2, to
hold the housing against the case.
7. Slide the axle housing assembly to tighten the
drive chains.
NOTE: The chains are properly tensioned when
there is 0 to 6 mm (0, to 1/4,) movement at the outer
edge of tyre tread.
8. Torque the axle retaining hardware to 140 ft. lbs.
(190 N·m).
CAUTION
When tightening the axle retaining hardware, the
axle housing must be tight against the case at 1, or 27
damage to the case may occur.
28
16 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
FINAL DRIVE
Op. 44 106 48
DRIVE CHAIN AND SPROCKET REMOVAL
The axle housing assemblies and final drive case
cover will need to be removed to access the drive
chains and drive sprockets.
The four final drive chains are an endless design,
with no connector link.
Removal
1. Lower the boom and attachment to the ground.
2. If the work is going to be done with the boom in 29
the raised position, remove the attachment, raise
the boom, and rest the boom on the boom lock
pins, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the loader.
30
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 17
32
9. Remove the final drive cover, 1.
33
18 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
35
2. Inspect the drive chains for broken or cracked
rollers, 1.
3. Inspect the drive chains for cracked or broken
side bars, 2.
4. Inspect the side-bar-to-pin wear or looseness at
3.
5. Inspect the drive chains for excessive stretch
(bushing wear).
36
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 19
REASSEMBLY
1. Clean all surfaces which require resealing of old
silicone sealer, dirt, etc.
2. If replacing the oil, it will have to be syphoned
from the chain case. Thoroughly clean the inside
of the case to remove all debris.
3. If removed, place the chains into the chain case.
Install the front chain (the longer chain) into the
case first.
4. Place the front driven sprocket into the chain
case with the longer center hub, 1, to the outside
of the case.
NOTE: The driven sprockets are not centered in the
37
chain case. The front sprocket is installed with the
longer hub, 1, to the outside of the machine and the
rear driven sprocket is installed with the short hub, 2,
to the outside.
5. Install the longer chain on the large sprocket and
roll it into position.
6. Place the rear driven sprocket in the chain case,
install the shorter chain and roll it into position.
NOTE: The SL65B front chains are longer than the
rear chains.
4
5 2 3
19997743
38
20 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
40
14. With the axle housing, 1, tight against the case,
install the retaining nuts and flat washers, 2, to
hold the housing against the case.
15. Slide the axle housing assembly to tighten the
drive chains.
NOTE: The chains are properly tensioned when
there is 0 to 6 mm (0, to 1/4,) movement at the outer
edge of tyre tread.
16. Torque the axle retaining hardware to 140 ft. lbs.
(190 N·m).
CAUTION
When tightening the axle retaining hardware, the 41
axle housing must be tight against the case at 1, or
damage to the case may occur.
SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1 21
3 1
42
22 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
Op. 44 511
TYRES/WHEELS
TYRE OPTIONS
1. 8.25 x 15 HST-Hollow segmented
2. 12.00 x 16.5 HST-Hollow segmented
3. 8.25 x 15 Chevron tread
4. 12.00 x 16.5 R4-Cleat tread
5. 12.00 x 16.5 PHD- Premium heavy-duty
6. 14.00 x 17.5 cleat tread (not shown)
7. Solid Tyres (not shown)
43
NOTE: Solid tyres are available and can be obtained
from your New Holland dealer.
Tyre Pressures
Tyre Pressure
8.25 x 15 Chevron tread 50 PSI (414 kPa)
7.50 x 15 HST-Hollow segmented N/A
12.00 x 16.5 R4-Cleat tread 50 PSI (345 kPa)
12.00 x 16.5 PHD- Premium heavy-duty 50 PSI (345 kPa)
12.00 x 16.5 HST-Hollow segmented N/A
14.00 x 17.5 - cleat tread 60 PSI (410 kPa)
44
Op. 44 511 28
When replacing the sections of the hollow seg-
mented tyres, torque the section hardware to 10 ft.
lbs. (13.6 N·m).
45
Track Installation on Loader
Correct tyre/track combinations are important to pre-
vent damage to the tracks, tyres/wheels, and loader
main frame.
Installing tracks on skid steers equipped with seg-
mented tyres, solid tyres, foam-filled tyres, or any
hard-type non-pneumatic tyres is not recommended.
If these tyre combinations are used with steel tracks,
track or loader main frame damage may occur.
These tyres do not provide a cushion when debris
comes between the track and tyre. A pneumatic tyre
will absorb this type of stress and, in severe cases,
may deflate before damage to the loader or track oc-
curs. 46
New Holland only recommends pneumatic tyres be
installed with tracks.
24 SECTION 44 – AXLES AND WHEELS – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL
Chapter 1 – Heater/Defroster
CONTENT
Op. 50 100
HEATER/DEFROSTER (CAB)
1 2
Switch and Control Panel
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable to pre-
vent possible shorting of the electrical system.
2. Remove the retaining hardware, 1, and pull the
panel from the rear support, 2.
3. Disconnect the switch wires and control cable.
19990481
1
Switch Wiring
The heater switch, 1, has four terminals marked, L,
M, H, and B, that the wire harness must be connected
to.
Connect the wires as follows:
Terminal Wire
L R/W (Red/White)
M Y (Yellow)
H O (Orange)
B O/DKBL (Orange/Dark Blue)
2
Relay and Fuse Block
1 - Fuse block - 20 amp
2 - Relay
3
SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1 3
1 R/W
B
V
O/DKBL B Y
M
C H
LTGN/B–2
O
LTGN/B–1
2 3
B–7
B
LTGN/B
O/DKBL
LTGN/B
6
B
4
R/O R/O
20A
7.5A
5 15A
5A
BSC0942A
4
Heater Wiring Diagram
1. Heater 4. Fuse block D
2. Blower switch 5. Start relay
3. Motor 6. Heater power relay
4 SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1
Louvre Replacement
1. To remove the louvre, use a small flat screwdriver
and pry the louvre from the support base at 1.
5
2. Remove the #6 self-tapping screws, 1, from the
base and remove the base from the headliner.
6
Heater Core, Shutoff Valve and Fan Assembly
Access
2
To access the heater core and/or fan assembly, the
rear light bar, 1, (if equipped with lights) and top
heater cover, 2, must be removed. Remove the
heater cover mounting screws, 3, to remove the
cover and light bar together.
3
7
SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1 5
Op. 50 104 24
Heater Core Replacement 1 2
1. Drain the cooling system enough to drain the
coolant from the core, about 2 liters (2 quarts).
2. Remove the heater hose clamps, 1, from the
heater core, remove the hoses from the core and
cap hoses.
3. Remove the heater core retaining hardware, 2,
and remove the core from the heater support.
19997753
8
Op. 50 104 23
Heater Shutoff Valve Replacement 1
1. Drain the cooling system enough to drain the
coolant from the core, about 2 liters (2 quarts).
2. Remove the control cable from the valve.
3. Remove the heater hose clamp, 1, from the
heater shutoff valve and remove the hoses from
the valve and cap hoses.
4. Remove the heater shutoff valve, 2.
19997755
9
Op. 50 104 20
Heater Fan Assembly Replacement 1
1. Remove the heater core retaining hardware and
pivot the core away from the fan support.
2. Disconnect the fan power wire, 1. 2 2
3. Remove the retaining hardware for the fan and
motor assembly, 2.
19997754
10
6 SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1
Op. 50 100 10
1
Heater Hose to Engine Connections
1. The pressure side heater hose, 1, tees into the
engine line, 2, from the water pump to the engine
oil cooler at the flywheel end of the engine.
11
2. The return side heater hose, 1, tees into the en-
gine line, 2, from the engine oil cooler to the en- 3
gine head at the flywheel end of the engine.
NOTE: To purge the air from the heater core and
hoses, temporarily “pinch off” the oil cooler supply 1
hose at 3. This will force coolant through the heater
core and hoses, removing the air from the system.
IMPORTANT: Do not install a shutoff valve or orifice
in the oil cooler supply hose. Restricting coolant flow
to the engine oil cooler may result in overheating and
engine failure. 2
12
The return side heater hose, 1, attaches to the en-
gine head, 2, with a hose adapter.
NOTE: Use Teflon tape on the threads of the engine 2
head adapter pipe fitting connection.
1
19986412
13
SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1 7
Op. 50 100 10
Heater Core Connections
Connect the pressure hose to the left side hose, 1,
and the return hose, 2, to the right side. Secure with
hose clamps. The hoses from the engine will have to
be cut to length for proper fit.
14
Op. 50 104 10
Filter
Replacement filter #86504784
The heater contains an air filter element in the rear
right side at 1.
Remove cover plate, 2, by removing two self- tapping
screws, 3.
15
Check the filter element, 1, periodically, especially if
running in dirty applications and using the fresh air
ventilation. The element can be blown off with a low-
pressure air gun and reused or replaced. The el-
ement must be placed with the rubber seal toward
the heater core. Be sure the seal is behind the top
clamp, 2, and lower screw, 3.
16
8 SECTION 50 – CAB CLIMATE CONTROL – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
CONTENT
The following are common terms used in electrical To test for a “GROUNDED CIRCUIT,” use a volt/ohm
diagnostics and how they may affect the circuit and meter and check for continuity between the circuit
electrical components. wire and ground.
The term “OPEN CIRCUIT” means there is no volt- The following chart shows the abbreviations for the
age getting from the control point to the operating various wire colors used to identify the electrical cir-
point. This means the wire carrying the voltage is cuits.
open/broken and voltage cannot continue to flow.
The effect is the operating component will not func- Wire Abbreviations to Indicate Wire Color
tion.
WIRE WIRE
The term “SHORT CIRCUIT” means there is voltage COLOR DESIGNATION COLOR DESIGNATION
being lost to another component wire or to ground.
Black B White W
This could result in the wrong component being oper-
ated or the blowing of the circuit protection device Dark DKBL Orange O
(fuse or breaker). Blue
The term “GROUNDED CIRCUIT” means the volt- Light LTBL Pink PK
age is going directly to ground and usually results in Blue
no component operation and/or blown fuse-breaker. Dark DKBR Purple PU
To test for an “OPEN CIRCUIT,” use a volt/ohm meter Brown
and check from one end of the wire to the other. If Gray GY Red R
voltage is not present, trace the circuit from control
point to operating point until the open is found. Dark DKGN Tan T
Green
To test for a “SHORT CIRCUIT,” use a volt/ohm meter
and check for very low resistance in different parts of Light LTGN Yellow Y
the circuit or continuity between the circuit wire and Green
ground.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 9
3
Engine Fuse Panel
The wires and connections listed below are available
providing electrical attachments were not previously
installed.
4
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 11
12 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
5
For Intermittent High Current Loads up to 15 amps
1. Preheat circuit breaker
2. R/LTBL (preheat load side)
3. R (feed dise)
4. Preheat relay
5. Main ground to bell housing
6. Live to attachment
7. Ground from attachment
8. Attachment power cable
9. Start relay
10. Alternator excite resistor
11. Start interlock relay
12. Drill second hole (protect component whilst drilling)
13. Accessory relay
14. Customer supplied 15 amp circuit breaker
15. Existing hole
16. Customer supplied jumper wire
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 13
6
For Intermittent High Current Loads up to 30 amps
1. Preheat circuit breaker
2. R/LTBL
3. R
4. Preheat relay
5. Customer supplied sealed circuit breaker
6. Customer supplied jumper wire
7. Main ground to bell housing
8. Ground wire from attachment
9. Live wire to attachment
10. Attachment power cable
11. Start relay
12. Alternator excite resistor
13. Start interlock relay
14. Accessory relay
15. Heater power relay
16. Turn signal relay
14 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
SPECIFICATIONS
Alternator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 amp
Tachometer output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 to 6.5 AC Volts
Battery (1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BCI PC31 - 12 volt - 925 amps @ -18_C (0°F) Top stud
.............................
System Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Negative (-)
Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuse blocks in cab and engine areas
Cab panel (standard)
Fuel pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5A
Electronics ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A
Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5A
Lights (road/work) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15A
Engine panel (standard)
Turn signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10A
Accessory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25A
Electronic (EIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A
Key main . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15A
Preheat circuit breaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50A
Cab panel (optional equipment)
Beacon light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5A
Engine panel (optional equipment)
Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20A
Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5A
Attach/Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15A
Backup alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A
Electronic Instrument Cluster (EIC)
Low voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will fault at 11.9 volts (low)
High voltage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will fault at 16.5 volts (high)
Fuel gauge sensor resistance
Full tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 ohms
Empty tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 ohms
Fuel shutoff solenoid
Pull-in amperage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 to 1.5 amps
Hold-in amperage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1.2 to 1.5 amps
Engine air filter sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Switch is normally closed
EIC will fault at 1.6″ Mercury or 22″ Water
Engine coolant temperature sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will read “COLD” until 0°C (32°F)
EIC will fault at 102°C (216°F)
Engine coolant temperature sensor resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . At 20°C (68°F) 2.21-2.69 K ohms
At 0° - 30°C (32° - 86_F) 1.65-5.88 K ohms
Engine crankcase oil pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will fault at 0.68 bar (10 PSI)
NOTE: The EIC will not alarm unless coolant temperature is above 64 F or two minutes have passed since
starting.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 15
Hydraulic oil temperature sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will read “COLD” until 0°C (32°F)
EIC will fault at 99°C (210_F)
Hydraulic oil temperature sensor resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . At 20°C (68°F) 2.21-2.69 K ohms
At 0° - 30°C (32° - 86°F) 1.65-5.88 K ohms
Hydraulic oil filter sensor (differential between in/out) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Switch normally closed
EIC will fault at 2.7 ± 0.27 bar (40 ± 4 PSI)
EIC will reset at 2.0 bar (30 PSI)
NOTE: This alarm is locked out until the oil temperature is at 110 F. The switch must be open for over 5 seconds
to alarm.
Hydrostatic charge pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EIC will fault at 3.4 bar (50 PSI)
Manifold heater resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.97 to 1.18 ohms
Solenoid (boom and bucket spool lock) resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 to 18 ohms
Starter Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Key start and relay
Headlights and rear work lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37.5 watt halogen
Taillights (road) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37.5 watt halogen
Amber Flasher lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sealed
Electronic Instrument panel indicator lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0.080 amp C-2F
16 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
ELECTRICAL DIAGRAM
18 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
F10928
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 19
F10930
20 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
F10960
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 21
Op. 55 418
10
EIC (ELECTRONIC INSTRUMENT 3. RIGHT ARROW DISPLAY SELECTOR
CLUSTER) FRONT PANEL SWITCH
1. AUDIBLE ALARM The display selector switch, covered with an
“ARROW” symbol, will cause an audible “chirp” when
The audible alarm will sound if there is an unusual
pressed if the ignition key is in the “RUN” position.
condition in any of the monitored areas. The audible
Pressing the “ARROW” symbol during operation will
alarm is located behind the front panel at 1.
select the function that the operator chooses to moni-
2. CHARACTER DISPLAY tor and will be displayed in the character display, 2.
The character display will display the item that the op- If a sensor causes a warning or fault, the appropriate
erator has chosen to monitor. The display shows one lamp will flash, accompanied by an audible alarm.
function at a time. After the engine is started, the dis- Pressing this switch also cancels any audible alarm
play defaults to the last function viewed at power off. that is sounding.
Any of the other functions may be selected by the op- 4. OPEN BOOK SELECTOR SWITCH
erator during operation by briefly pressing the
This selector switch covered with the symbol of an
“ARROW” selector switch, 3. When the EIC is turned
“OPEN BOOK” (instruction manual) is used to select
off and then powered up, the display default will be
other functional modes of the EIC panel. The “OPEN
the newly selected function.
BOOK” switch has no function during normal oper-
ation.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 23
11
EIC FUNCTIONAL GROUPS
The EIC display panel is divided into four functional
groups, 1 through 4.
5. Engine hours, displayed to 0.1 hours (no light).
FUNCTIONAL GROUP 1
Those symbols in display group 1, backlighted white
are:
4. Character display.
The character display will display the chosen func-
tion or the function with the fault within this functional
group.
24 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
12
FUNCTIONAL GROUP 2
Those symbols in display group 2, backlighted yellow
are:
4. Parking brake.
Used to remind operator to engage the parking
brake when exiting the loader. An audible alarm
1. Hydraulic oil filter condition. will sound when the operator begins to exit the
machine with the engine running.
The EIC continuously monitors the condition of
the oil filter. A yellow warning lamp will signal a
warning when the filter becomes dirty. The lamp
will flash continuously, accompanied by a 5-sec-
ond audible alarm, when the filter requires re-
placement. 5. Stop engine warning.
When this warning lamp flashes, stop the engine
and determine the cause to prevent damage to
the engine.
13
FUNCTIONAL GROUP 3 bars, 2, the segments will flash accompanied by
The symbol in display group 3 is: an audible alarm for about 5 seconds.
When the fuel level reaches two bars, the EIC will
signal the operator again with the segments
flashing and another 5-second audible alarm.
NOTE: The lower fuel gauge segments accurately
read the lower fuel levels so an operator is less likely
1. Fuel gauge. to run out of fuel. However, if a machine is operated
The fuel gauge, 1, is a vertical 10-segment green on a hillside, the fuel gauge should be monitored
LED bar graph. When the fuel level reaches three closely to avoid running out of fuel, as the fuel can still
move freely from one end of the tank to the other.
26 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
1 2
4 5 6
14
FUNCTIONAL GROUP 4
Symbols in display group 4 are backlighted red.
When a fault occurs, the flashing lamp is accompa-
nied by the audible alarm. 5. Coolant temperature.
When the engine coolant temperature is above
operating temperature of 102°C (216°F) the
lamp will flash with a 5-second alarm.
1. Transmission charge pressure.
When the pressure drops below normal operat-
ing pressure, the lamp will flash with a continuous
alarm. 6. Operator “FASTEN SEAT BELT” symbol.
When the operator is in the seat, the lamp will
flash until the seat belt is fastened.
These symbols are backlighted RED and are in-
2. Transmission/Hydraulic oil temperature. tended to complement the audible alarm should
a fault occur.
When the oil temperature is above operating
temperature of 99°C (210° F), the lamp will flash
with a 5-second alarm. 7. Alternator/water pump drive belt warning.
If the drive belt breaks, the EIC will signal the op-
erator with the battery symbol light, 3, flashing
continuously and a 5 second audible alarm.
3. Battery voltage. NOTE: If during skid steer operation the Engine
When battery voltage drops below normal volt- Coolant or Hydraulic Oil Temperatures show an over-
age, the lamp will flash with a 5-second alarm. heat condition, the EIC will default to that function
and read the temperature. When this happens, back
off on loader operation and allow the systems to cool
down to within normal operating temperature ranges.
If the temperatures don’t cool down, stop operating
4. Engine oil pressure. the unit, find the cause and correct.
When the engine oil pressure drops below nor-
mal pressure, the lamp will flash with a continu-
ous alarm.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 27
15
CONTINUOUSLY MONITORED ELEMENTS
The following machine elements are continuously
monitored by the EIC:
5. Hydrostatic charge pressure.
When the pressure drops below normal operat-
ing pressure the lamp will flash with a continuous
alarm.
1. Engine air filter.
Monitors the condition of the air cleaner element
and will signal when the element is dirty and re-
quires replacement.
6. Engine oil pressure.
When the engine oil pressure drops below nor-
mal pressure the lamp will flash with a continuous
alarm.
2. Hydraulic oil filter.
Monitors the condition of the filter and will signal
when the filter is dirty and requires replacement.
4. Battery Voltage.
When battery voltage drops below normal volt-
age the lamp will flash with a 5-second alarm.
28 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
1 2 3 7 4 5 6
16
OPERATING MODE 5. ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE –
By pressing and releasing the “ARROW” switch, 1, Reads COLD until 0°C (32°F)
during normal skid steer operation, the operator can 6. TRANSMISSION/HYDRAULIC OIL TEM-
select a function to be monitored. Only one function PERATURE – Reads COLD until 0°C (32°F)
can be monitored and displayed at a time in the dis-
play, 7. By pressing and releasing the “ARROW” If a fault occurs in the following monitored functions,
switch once, the EIC will select the next monitored the EIC will automatically show that function’s read-
function. Functional symbols are located across the ing in the character display, accompanied by a flash-
top of the EIC display and will light up when selected. ing light and a five second audible alarm.
Note that the engine hour symbol, 4, is not illumi-
nated. FAULT READING
Monitored functions are: Battery Voltage Battery Voltage
(Low & High)
2. ENGINE RPM
Engine Coolant (High) Temperature in
3. BATTERY VOLTAGE Degrees
4. ENGINE HOURS (No Light) Transmission/ Temperature in
Hydraulic Oil (High) Degrees
30 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
17
If a fault occurs in the following monitored functions FAULT CODE
a fault code will appear in the EIC character display,
1, accompanied by a five second audible alarm. By Hydraulic Boom/Bucket Solenoid (F0A)
turning the ignition key switch to the “OFF” position Engine Preheat Relay Coil (F03)
the EIC will return to the normal operating mode. If
Fuel Solenoid (F04)
when the loader is restarted and the fault still exists,
the code will reappear with an alarm indicating there
is an open or short in that circuit. Contact your New
Holland dealer for assistance.
–––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––––
1 2
18
If a fault occurs in the following monitored functions FAULT
the EIC will signal the operator with a flashing light 1. Hydraulic Oil Filter
accompanied by a five second audible alarm indicat- 2. Engine Air Cleaner
ing the filter(s) require service.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 31
19
If a fault occurs for more than 30 seconds in the fol- BROKEN ALTERNATOR/WATER PUMP BELT
lowing monitored functions the EIC will signal the op- WARNING, 3
erator with a flashing light, a continuous audible
If the drive belt breaks the EIC will signal the operator
alarm and will stop the engine after 30 seconds of
with the battery symbol light, 3, flashing, accompa-
operation.
nied by an audible alarm.
FAULT
NOTE: The engine will shut down automatically.
1. Engine Oil Pressure Then immediately turn the ignition key to “OFF” posi-
tion to prevent engine overheating or damage.
2. Hydrostatic Transmission Charge Pressure
If a fault occurs in one of these functions, the engine
can be restarted and the skid steer moved to a safe
inspection area with the boom resting on the boom
lock pins or on the ground. If the fault still exists, the
EIC will stop the engine after another 30 seconds.
IMPORTANT: Use caution when restarting the skid
steer because of the possibility of NO LUBRICATING
OILS for the engine and/or the hydrostatic
transmissions. DO NOT restart the skid steer more
than once or operate the engine at high engine
speeds. Damage to the engine and/or transmission
may occur. Contact your New Holland dealer for
assistance.
32 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
FUEL LEVEL
1
Fuel level is shown to the operator by the fuel gauge
bar lights located in the center of the EIC display at
1. The operator will be signaled when the level is at
three bars and again at two bars. The bar lights, 2, will
flash continuously accompanied by an audible alarm
for about five seconds at each signal level.
2
20
EIC INTERLOCKS
1
EIC controls the fuel solenoid circuit. The operator
must be in the seat, with the seat belt fastened before 2
the engine will start and continue to run.
The EIC will lock the boom and bucket control valve
spools in neutral if the operator unfastens the seat
belt, leaves the seat, or turns the ignition key off. If the
operator is out of the seat for more than two seconds,
the seat belt must be unfastened and refastened to 3
enable the boom and bucket hydraulic systems to
function.
The unit is equipped with a “SERVICE/RUN” switch
for use during servicing and troubleshooting of the 19984593
skid steer. To access the Service/Run switch located 21
under the cab fuse panel cover, 1, loosen the two
thumbscrews, 2, and rotate cover, 1, to the side.
When the “SERVICE/RUN” switch, 3, is in the “SER-
VICE” position, the engine will start but the boom and
bucket hydraulic system will be inoperative.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 33
1 3
22
EIC LOCK MODE 11. With the two (2) digit code entered, “01 to 99”,
A two digit code can be entered into the EIC which will turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position and exit
lock the boom and bucket spool lock solenoids when the loader, allowing all the EIC board lights to go
the spools are in the neutral position. This will prevent “OFF”, locking the EIC.
movement of the boom and bucket. When the EIC board lights go off, the lock code will
The same two digit code must be reentered to unlock enter the EIC memory, locking the EIC until the same
the solenoids and return the loader to normal oper- two digit code is reentered.
ation. To reenter the same two (2) digit code to return the
To enter a security code: loader to normal operation:
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the ground and 1. Sit in the operator’s seat.
position the bucket to prevent movement of the 2. The EIC will display “LOC 0 0” with the left digit
loader. flashing.
2. Turn “OFF” the ignition key. 3. Turn the ignition key switch to the “ON” position;
3. Unbuckle the seat belt, raise your weight off the Do Not engage the starter.
seat, and wait until all EIC lights are off. 4. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch and
4. While out of the seat, press and hold the “OPEN enter the left number of the code previously used
BOOK” switch, 2, then sit in the seat and turn the to lock the loader.
ignition key to the “ON” position; Do Not engage 5. Press and release the “ARROW” switch, the right
the starter. zero will flash.
5. Display, 3, will show the program level of the EIC 6. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch to
board (example r0100). At this time release the enter the right number of the code previously
“OPEN BOOK” switch. used to lock the loader.
6. Display, 3, will show “LOC_ _” for lock. 7. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position and
7. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch until allow the EIC to return to the operating mode.
two (2) zeros appear “LOC 0 0” with the left zero 8. Buckle the seat belt and proceed with normal
flashing, then release the “OPEN BOOK” switch. skid steer operation.
8. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch and If the two digit code is forgotten, the EIC can be un-
enter any number from “0” to “9” for the left digit. locked by using a (MASTER CODE). Contact your
9. Press and release the “ARROW” switch, 1, the dealer for assistance.
right zero will start to flash. The dealer will require your name, address and the
10. Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch and skid steer model and serial numbers.
enter any number from “1” to “9” for the right digit.
34 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
TROUBLESHOOTING
No battery voltage from seat Open in power wire from seat switch
switch to EIC board to EIC board, repair open in wire
Battery voltage from seat switch If battery voltage from seat to board
to EIC board is OK, replace EIC board
EIC board backlighting Brightness variations due to None –– overlay decal material
is dim production differences between variations cause differences in
models and/or EIC board brightness
changes
No battery voltage from seat belt Open in wire from seat belt switch to
switch to EIC board EIC board, repair open
Battery voltage from seat belt If voltage OK, replace EIC board
switch to EIC board
36 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
No battery voltage from seat belt Open in power wire from seat belt
switch to EIC switch, repair open
No battery voltage to start relay Open in power wire from key switch
“start” to relay, or through seat/seat
belt circuits to relay, repair open
No battery voltage from EIC to Open in power wire from EIC to fuel
fuel solenoid solenoid, repair open
Open in the W/O wire from the Repair open in W/O wire
seat/seat belt plug to the start
interlock relay
No fuel to manifold heater Check fuel feed tube and fuel supply
from injection pump
EIC will not read monitored circuits Incorrect engine configuration Correct engine configuration
ADVANCED WARNING SYSTEM (AWS) The AWS provides the following features for dealer
This skid steer is equipped with an Advanced Warn- technician use in diagnostics and troubleshooting of
ing System (AWS) that provides information to the the monitored function circuits:
operator about the operation of the skid steer. Diagnostics
The AWS provides an interlock system with the seat – Test individual monitored circuits.
and seat belt to prevent movement of the boom and
bucket if the operator is out of the seat or the seat belt Fault/Warning History
is unbuckled and the controls are in neutral. – Fault occurrence with hour level of last occur-
The AWS provides an automatic engine preheat sys- rence.
tem to aid in cold weather starting.
The AWS provides information to the operator about Clear Faults
the following monitored functions: – Clear Faults to zero.
– Hydraulic Oil Filter
– Engine Air Filter Engine Code
– Engine Preheat Relay Coil – Set EIC to loader engine model.
– Fuel Level
– Fuel Solenoid Select Displayed Temperature Units, Fahrenheit or
– Engine Coolant Temperature Celsius
– Hydrostatic Transmission Charge Pressure – Temperature displayed in English (Fahrenheit)
or Metric (Celsius).
– Transmission/Hydraulic Oil Temperature
– Battery Voltage Adjust Engine RPM
– Engine Oil Pressure – Calibrate EIC display to external RPM tach read-
– Alternator/Water Pump Belt Breakage Warning ing.
– Operator Seat and Seat Belt
– Hydraulic Boom/Bucket Solenoid Clear Memory
– Engine RPM – Return EIC to original factory settings.
– Engine Hours – Engine code reset to (01).
– Hours reset to (0000.0) zero.
The AWS provides an engine shut down feature if the – Temperature displayed (Fahrenheit).
engine oil pressure or the hydrostatic transmission – Engine RPM calibration cleared.
charge pressure are low.
The AWS will signal the operator if the alternator/ Adjust skid steer hours
water pump drive belt fails. – Change unit hours when installing a new EIC
The AWS provides a security feature allowing the op- board in a loader.
erator to enter a two digit security code, preventing
starting of the engine and movement of the boom and
bucket.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 39
24
EIC BOARD SELF TEST 3. The EIC will enter the normal start up mode.
When first sitting in the operator’s seat and/or before 4. Turning the ignition key to the “ON” position will
entering Diagnostics, allow the EIC board to self test. start the automatic engine preheat system (if re-
(Service/Run switch in the “RUN” position) quired).
Sit in operator’s seat. NOTE: The preheat times will vary from 0 to 40 sec-
1. The EIC board should light all symbol lights. onds, depending on engine temperature.
2. The character display should read “8888.8”, 1, If the EIC does not function as described, check the
and the fuel gauge (light bar), 2, should light seat and seat belt switches for proper operation and
showing 9 bars. EIC board power and ground circuits.
40 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
1 3
25
DIAGNOSTIC AND SETUP MODES tion key to the “ON” position; Do Not engage the
When in the Diagnostic Mode, the technician can test starter.
the individual monitored circuit wiring. When in the 5. Display, 3, will show the program level of the EIC
Setup Mode, the technician can make changes to the board (example - r0100); at this time, release the
EIC and perform additional troubleshooting. “OPEN BOOK” switch.
6. Display will show “LOC_ _” for lock.
To Enter Diagnostic Or Setup Mode: 7. Press and release the “ARROW” switch, 1;
1. Lower the boom and bucket to the ground or re- “dIAg” (for Diagnostic) will appear in the char-
move any attachment and rest the boom on the acter display.
boom lock pins. 8. Press and release the “ARROW” switch again
2. Turn “OFF” the ignition key. will move to the “SEtUP” mode in the display.
3. Unbuckle the seat belt, raise your weight off the Pressing and holding the “OPEN BOOK” switch
seat, and wait until all EIC lights are off. when in either mode will enter the selected mode for
4. While out of the seat, press and hold the “OPEN tests or changes to the EIC.
BOOK” switch, 2, sit in the seat and turn the igni-
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 41
1 2
26
EIC Diagnostics and Setup Items With display showing “LOC_ _” for lock.
1. Press and release the “ARROW” switch, 1;
Diagnostics Mode “dIAg” will appear in the character display, 2.
______________________________________________________________________________________
_________
27
2. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch, 1, until 1. EIC board bulbs
a low case “d” appears in the character display, 2. EIC board circuits
2, release the “OPEN BOOK” switch. The EIC is 3. EIC board arrow and open book switches
now in Diagnostics. 4. Audible beeper
Each individual monitored circuit can now be tested 5. Engine air filter circuit
for proper operation. 6. Hydraulic oil filter circuit
7. Hydrostatic transmission charge pressure circuit
When in Diagnostics and any circuit is activated the
8. Engine oil pressure circuit
EIC board will light all lights and an audible alarm will
9. Engine Coolant temperature circuit
sound.
10. Transmission/hydraulic oil temperature circuit
The Diagnostic test will not verify the performance of 11. Fuel level circuit
a sensor or sender. Only the EIC board and wires to 12. Seat switch(es) and circuit
the sender or sensor are tested. 13. Seat belt switch and circuit
14. Service/Run switch
The following circuits can be tested:
42 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
35
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 45
36
9. Seat Belt Switch and Circuit
The operator must be sitting in the seat.
Unbuckle and rebuckle the seat belt. The EIC
board will light and beep. If the board lights and
beeps, the switch and circuit are OK. If the board
fails to light and beep, check the seat belt switch
and circuit from the seat switch for battery volt-
age. If there is battery voltage to the switch,
check the switch for operation and the circuit
from the seat belt switch to the EIC board. If there
is no battery voltage from the seat switch, check
the seat switch for operation and the wire to the
seat belt switch.
37
10. Service/Run Switch, 1
The operator must be sitting in the seat.
Switch between “SERVICE” and “RUN”. The EIC 1
board will light and beep. If the board fails to light
and beep, check the switch and circuit for battery
voltage.
To exit Diagnostics and move to the next item,
press and hold the “ARROW” switch until “dIAg”
is displayed in the character display, then release
the switch. Pressing the “ARROW” switch again
will move the EIC to the SETUP Mode. To exit and
return to the Normal Operating Mode turn the
ignition key switch to the “OFF” position. 19984337
38
46 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
EIC SETUP MODE – Calibrate EIC display to external RPM tach read-
The EIC Setup Mode is made up of several items: ing.
FAULt - Fault/Warning history
CLr F - Clear Faults
– Fault occurrence with hour level of last occur-
rence. – Clear Faults to zero.
2
1
39
FAULt - Fault/Warning history
With display showing “LOC_ _” for lock.
1. Press and release the “ARROW” switch, 1;
“dIAg” will appear in the character display. Then
press and release the “ARROW” switch again;
“SEtUP” will appear in the display, 2.
______________________________________________________________________________________
_________
40
2. Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch, 1, until
“FAULt” appears in the character display, 2.
48 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
41
Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch, 1, until
“F0-XX” appears in the display. The “F0” is the fault
and the “XX” is the number of occurrences of that
fault since the fault memory was last cleared. The
fault code display will be accompanied by an illumi-
nated front panel symbol identifying the fault. Thus,
“F0” is identified via the illuminated oil filter symbol,
2, example “F0-02” is showing in display, 3, F0 code
with 02 occurrences.
Press and release the “OPEN BOOK” switch will dis-
play the hour of the last occurrence, for this code,
example “0565.3” hours. Pressing and releasing the
“OPEN BOOK” switch will return the EIC to the fault
code.
42
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 49
2
1
44
Once all faults have been identified, the fault history Press and release the “ARROW” switch, 1, until “CLr
can be cleared to zero. F” appears in the character display, 2.
To return to “FAULt” and clear the faults, press and
hold the “ARROW” switch, 1, until the original
“FAULt” item is displayed in the character display.
______________________________________________________________________________________
_________
45
Press and hold the “OPEN BOOK” switch, 1, until To exit this item, press and hold the “ARROW” switch
“CLEAr” appears in the display, 2. Then release the to return to the “SEtUP” mode, or turn the ignition key
switch to clear all fault occurrences from the fault his- switch to the “OFF” position to return the EIC to the
tory memory. Normal Operating Mode.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 51
48
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 53
Sit in the seat with the seat belt buckled. After the
EIC board self test, the parking brake light, 1,
should flash. Turn the ignition key to the “ON”
position and the light should go off. If the light fails
to go off, check the 5-amp fuse in the cab fuse
panel. 53
When exiting the loader with the ignition key in
the “ON” position, the light should flash for about
2 seconds after the seat belt is unbuckled and the
operator is out of the seat.
If the light does not flash when the seat belt is un-
buckled, check operation of the seat belt switch
and the seat switch.
Sit in the seat. After the EIC board self tests, the
seat belt light, 1, will flash until the seat belt is
buckled.
If the light continues to flash after the seat belt is
buckled, check operation of the seat belt switch.
54
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 57
59
2. Check the grounding strap from the cab ROPS
structure to main frame, 1.
3. Check the wiring harness from the EIC to the bell
housing.
60
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 61
61
5. Check the black wire in engine harness between
the bell housing and the starter mounting with
negative battery cable, 1.
Due to the distance between the bell housing
ground point and the starter mounting at the at-
tachment of the negative battery cable, a separ-
ate ground wire is used between these points to
carry the current across bolted assemblies.
Check the integrity of this wire at the bell housing
ground point and its connection with the negative
battery cable and braided strap (from frame) at
starter mounting bolt.
62
62 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
W/R
4
B R
1
R
_ _ 2
R
_
3
R/LTGN
14 12V
13
B P2
R/LTGN
6 5A
P1
R
5 15A
BSC0943A
64
Main Power Circuit to EIC board
1. Battery 4. Preheat circuit breaker
2. Start solenoid/starter 5. Engine fuse panel
3. Start relay 6. EIC
64 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
W/R
4
B R
1
R
_ _ 2
R
_
3
T
8 P2
T T/W
4
LTGN/R
6
7 P1 5A
5 15A
BSC0944A LTGN/R
65
Seat Switch Circuit to EIC board
1. Battery 5. Engine fuse panel
2. Start solenoid/starter 6. EIC
3. Start relay 7. Service/run switch
4. Preheat circuit breaker 8. Seat switch
SEAT SWITCH CIRCUIT TO EIC BOARD The power continues through the (LTGN/R) wire to
the seat switch. When one seat switch (only 1 switch
Battery voltage needs to be closed as switches are in parallel wiring)
is pressed closed, the power then continues through
The power originates at the battery and proceeds the (T) wire to the Service/Run switch. When the ser-
through the (R) battery cable to the starter solenoid. vice/run switch is in the “SERVICE” position, the
From there power continues through the (R) wire to power stops.
the battery side of the start relay. With the Service/Run switch in the “RUN” position,
The power continues through the (R) wire to the pre- the power continues through the (T/W) wire to the
heat circuit breaker, then through the (R) wire to the EIC board terminal 4 of connector P2.
engine fuse panel (standard fuse block) battery side
of the key main 15-amp fuse with a terminal bus to the
battery side of the electronics 5A fuse.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 65
DKBL
T T
2
W/O LTGN
1 B
LTGN LTGN P2
11
3
P1
W/O
BSC0945A
66
Seat Belt Switch Circuit to EIC board
1. Seat switch 3. EIC
2. Seat belt switch 4. Start interlock relay
SEAT BELT SWITCH CIRCUIT TO EIC When the seat belt is buckled, the power proceeds
BOARD through the (LTGN) wire to the EIC board terminal 11
of connector P2.
Battery voltage When the seat belt is buckled, power is sent through
The power originates from the seat switch(es) the (W/O) wire to the start interlock relay. This allows
through the (T) wire to the seat belt switch. the unit to start when the seat belt is buckled.
66 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 67
W/R
4
B R
1
R
_ _ 2
R
_
3
O/PU–2
12 P2 ACC
BAT IGN
8 5
O
6
11 P1 5A
7 R/W R
15A
BSC0946A LTGN/B
67
Ignition Switch Circuit to EIC board
1. Battery 5. Engine fuse panel
2. Start solenoid/starter 6. EIC
3. Start relay 7. Service/run switch
4. Preheat circuit breaker 8. Seat switch
IGNITION SWITCH CIRCUIT TO EIC BOARD The power continues through the (R/W) wire to the
battery terminal of the ignition switch.
Battery voltage When the ignition key switch is turned to the “ON”
The power originates at the battery and proceeds position, power continues through the (O/PU-2) wire
through the (R) battery cable to the starter solenoid. to the Electronics 5-amp fuse in the cab fuse panel.
From there power continues through the (R) wire to The power continues through the (O) wire to terminal
the battery side of the start relay. 12 of connector P2 at the EIC board.
The power continues through the (R) wire to the pre- NOTE: Also, with Key Switch “ON” Engine “OFF,”
heat circuit breaker, then through the (R) wire to the voltage travels from the switch “ACC” terminal via the
engine fuse panel (standard fuse block) battery side LTGN/B wire to terminal 11 of connector P1 to pro-
of the key main 15-amp fuse. vide a warning of Key “ON” should the operator exit
the loader.
68 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
19984337
68
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 69
W/R
4
B R
1
R
_ _ 2
R
_
W/DKBL
12 O O
LTBL/O
5
5A W/LTGN
O/PU 7 6
10
11 W
12 P2
W/O
ACC
9
W
BAT IGN
ST
W/LTGN
8 11 P1
R/W R
W
15A
R/W
BSC0947A
69
Service/Run Switch in the RUN Position
1. Battery 7. EIC
2. Start solenoid/starter 8. Seat/seat belt switch
3. Start relay 9. Start interlock relay
4. Preheat circuit breaker 10. Service/run switch
5. Fuel solenoid 11. Key switch
6. Engine fuse panel 12. Cab fuse panel
“SERVICE/RUN” SWITCH IN THE “RUN” Power then flows from the service/run switch through
POSITION the (W/LTGN) wire to the start interlock relay coil ter-
minal.
The power originates at the battery and flows through
the (R) positive battery cable to the starter solenoid. With the interlock energized, the power from the
From here the power flows through the (R) wire to the seat/seat belt circuit (W/O) wire flows through the
battery side of the start relay. (W/DKBL) wire to the start relay to activate the relay.
The power then flows through the (R) wire to the pre- Power also flows from the start interlock relay
heat circuit breaker and to the engine fuse panel to through the LTBL/O wire to the fuel solenoid to open
the 15A key main fuse. the solenoid, allowing fuel flow to the injection pump.
The power then flows through the (R/W) wire to the When the start relay is activated, power goes through
battery terminal on the ignition key switch. the (W/R) wire to the starter solenoid, which con-
nects battery power to the starter motor.
With the key switch in the “START” position, current
flows through the (W) wire to the service/run switch.
Power also flows through the (W) wire to connector
P2 terminal 10-key start at the EIC board.
70 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
2 3
BSC0948A
70
Cranking Circuit Ground
1. Start interlock relay 3. Preheat relay
2. Start relay 4. Engine bell housing
W/R
4
B R
1
R
_ _ 2
R
_
3
W/DKBL
8
7 5
ACC
W W BAT IGN
ST
R/W R/W R
15A
LTBL/O
6
BSC0949A
72
Service/Run Switch in the SERVICE Position
1. Battery 5. Engine fuse panel
2. Start solenoid/starter 6. Fuel solenoid
3. Start relay 7. Ignition keyswitch
4. Preheat circuit breaker 8. Service/run switch
SERVICE/RUN SWITCH IN THE “SERVICE” With the key switch in the “START” position, current
POSITION flows through the (W) wire to the service/run switch.
The power originates at the battery and flows through With the service/run switch in the “SERVICE” posi-
the (R) positive battery cable to the starter solenoid. tion, power goes through the (W/DKBL) wire from the
From here the power flows through the (R) wire to the service/run switch to the start relay to activate the
battery side of the start relay. relay.
The power then flows through the (R) wire to the pre- When the start relay is activated, power goes through
heat circuit breaker and to the engine fuse panel to the (W/R) wire to the starter solenoid, which con-
the 15A key main fuse. nects battery to the starter motor.
The power then flows through the (R/W) wire to the
battery terminal on the ignition key switch.
72 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
2 3
BSC0948A
73
Cranking Circuit Ground
1. Start interlock relay 3. Preheat relay
2. Start relay 4. Engine bell housing
74
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 73
W/R
4
B R
1
R
_ _ 2
R
_
3
LTBL/O
W/DKBL 5
10 9
12
6
ACC W/DKBL
W
BAT IGN
ST
W/O
8
11
R/W R/W R
W/LTGN
7 15A
BSC0950A
75
Start Relay Circuit
1. Battery 7. Seat/seat belt switch
2. Start solenoid/starter 8. Start interlock relay
3. Start relay 9. Service/run switch
4. Preheat circuit breaker 10. Service position
5. Fuel solenoid 11. Run position
6. Engine fuse panel 12. Ignition key sitch
START RELAY CIRCUIT and the start interlock relay is energized by the
The power originates at the battery and flows through W/LTGN wire from the service/run switch, the start
the (R) positive battery cable to the starter solenoid. relay receives energizing power from the seat/seat
From here the power flows through the (R) wire to the belt circuit via the W/O wire, then the (W/DKBL) wire
battery side of the start relay. from the start interlock relay.
The power then flows through the (R) wire to the pre- When the service/run switch is in the “SERVICE”
heat circuit breaker and to the engine fuse panel to position, the start relay receives energizing power
the 15A key main fuse. through the (W/DKBL) wire from the service/run
switch.
The power then flows through the (R/W) wire to the
battery terminal on the ignition key switch. When the start relay is activated, it connects the bat-
tery side of the relay to the start side and sends power
When the service/run switch is in the “RUN” position, to the starter solenoid through the (W/R) wire, acti-
the operator is in the seat with the seat belt buckled, vating the starter motor.
74 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
1 2
B–6 B–8
BSC0951A
76
Start Relay Ground
1. Start relay 3. Engine bell housing
2. Preheat relay
19984973
77
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 75
2 3
W/DKBL
B–4 B–6 B–8
O
4
5A
O
LTBL/O
O/PU
5
9 W/DKBL
ACC
W
BAT IGN B–4 W/O
ST 7
8
W/LTGN
6
BSC0952A
78
Start Interlock Circuit
1. Cab fuse panel 6. Seat/seat belt switch
2. Start relay 7. Start interlock relay
3. Preheat relay 8. Service/run switch
4. Engine bell housing 9. Ignition key switch
5. Fuel solenoid
START INTERLOCK CIRCUIT When the interlock is “satisfied” that the service/run
“SERVICE/RUN” switch in the “RUN” position. switch is in the “RUN” position and the operator is sit-
ting in the seat with the seat belt buckled, power will
The start interlock relay coil receives power from the travel through the W/DKBL wire to the start relay and
service/run switch, with the switch in the “RUN” posi- through the LTBL/O wire to the fuel solenoid, allowing
tion, through the W/LTGN wire. The interlock re- the engine to start. The source for the fuel solenoid
ceives power from the seat/seat belt plug when the power is from key switch “Ign,” then through the O/PU
operator is sitting in the seat with the seat belt wire to the cab 5-amp fuse, then via the O wire to the
buckled through the W/O wire. relay.
76 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
1 2 3
LTBL/O
7 5
ACC
W
BAT IGN
ST
BSC0953A
79
Start Interlock Ground Circuit
1. Start interlock relay 5. Fuel solenoid
2. Start relay 6. Service/run switch
3. Preheat relay 7. Ignition key switch
4. Engine bell housing
START INTERLOCK GROUND CIRCUIT in the “SERVICE” position, power flows from the key
The interlock is grounded through the B-4 wire to the switch “START” terminal via the W wire to the ser-
start relay, through B-6 wire to the preheat relay, vice/run switch, then through the LTBL/O wires to the
through B-8 wire to the engine bell housing ground. fuel solenoid, allowing the engine to start and con-
tinue to run. The start relay receives power from the
service/run switch via the W/DKBL wire to activate
START CIRCUIT the start relay. The EIC plays no supporting role in
“SERVICE/RUN” switch in the “SERVICE” position. this mode.
The interlock relay is not functional with the service/
run switch in the “SERVICE” position. With the switch
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 77
BATTERY
Op. 55 301 40
REMOVAL
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom lock pins,
1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
INSTALLATION
1. Orient the battery with the positive post, 2, toward
the rear of the loader. Install the battery and the
hold-down strap and hardware. Position the
hold-down strap to clear other components.
2. Connect the positive (+) RED cable to positive (+)
terminals and negative (-) BLACK cable to nega-
tive (-) terminals. Do not over tighten. Observe
the tightening specifications on the battery label. 81
IMPORTANT: Crossing of terminals may cause
damage to the electrical system, alternator and Ad-
vanced Warning System (EIC).
3. Install protective caps over the battery terminals
and cable connections.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 79
Op. 55 418 10
86
3. Unplug the two wire harness connectors, 1, from
the EIC, taking care to not stress or bend the
plastic locking ramps on the connectors.
NOTE: Note the positioning of the connectors to the
EIC board and reconnect to the new board in the cor-
rect position. If the connector is not connected
properly, damage to the EIC may occur.
87
80 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
89
2. Position the EIC board into the overhead dash
flat against the support at 1, and secure with the
hardware previously removed at 2. Make sure
that wires are not pinched between the EIC board
and dash frame.
IMPORTANT: Do not force the EIC board into the
overhead dash area or damage to the EIC board may
occur.
3. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
90
IGNITION (KEY) SWITCH WIRING
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 O/LTBL To Four-Way Flash- Key “ON”
ACC
ing lights 10A Fuse position
(cab panel)-
ST
To Beacon Light 7.5A
Fuse (cab panel) IGN
BAT
2 LTGN/B To EIC Board Pin #11 Key “ON”
(small connector) position
3 LTGN/B To Accessory Relay Key “ON”
(engine panel) position
4 W To Service/Run Key 91
Switch “START”
position
5 W To EIC Board Pin #10 Key
(large connector) “START”
position
6 R/W From 15A Fuse All times
(engine panel)
7 GY/B Power to dome light All times
(not available)
8 O/PU-2 To Electronics 5A Key “ON”
Fuse (cab panel) position
82 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Op. 55 201 10
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the retaining hardware, 1, and remove
the switch panel, 2, from the overhead dash area.
3. Remove the wires from the switch terminals.
92
4. Remove the switch retaining nut, 1, from the
switch and remove the switch from the dash
panel.
INSTALLATION
1. Attach the switch to the panel and secure with
nut, 1, previously removed.
2. Reconnect the wires to the terminals as shown
above.
3. Reinstall the switch panel to the overhead dash.
Make sure wires are positioned to prevent wires
1
from being pinched between the switch panel
and the dash.
4. Reinstall the negative (-) battery cable. 93
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 83
96
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 85
97
SERVICE/RUN SWITCH - SERVICE/RUN SWITCH - RUN POSITION
SERVICE POSITION
Battery
Battery Ref Color Destination Voltage
Ref Color Destination Voltage 1 W/DKBL To Start Relay Key
1 W/DKBL To Start Relay Key (engine panel) “START”
(engine panel) “START” position
position (backfed
from start in-
2 LTBL/O From EIC Board Pin #5 Key “ON” terlock relay)
(large connector) position
2 LTBL/O From EIC Board Pin Key “ON”
3 LTBL/O To Start Interlock Relay Key “ON” #5 (large connector) position (will
(engine panel) position read 0.5 to
4 LTGN/O To Manual Preheat Sitting in 1.0 volt be-
Switch Seat low battery
voltage)
5 T From Seat Switch(es) Sitting in
Seat 3 LTBL/O To Start Interlock Key “ON”
6 T/W To EIC Board Pin #4 No Relay (engine panel) position (will
read 0.5 to
(large connector) Voltage
1.0 volt be-
Anytime
low battery
7 O/PU 1 From 5A Fuse (cab Key “ON” voltage)
panel) position
4 LTGN/O To Manual Preheat Sitting in
8 W/LTGN To Start Interlock Relay No Switch Seat
(engine panel) Voltage
5 T From Seat Switch(es) Sitting in
Anytime
Seat
9 W From Key Switch Key
6 T/W To EIC Board Pin #4 Sitting in
(ignition) “START”
(large connector) Seat
position
7 O/PU 1 From 5A Fuse (spare) Key “ON”
(cab panel) position
8 W/LTGN To Start Interlock Key
Relay (engine panel) “START”
position
9 W From Key Switch (Igni- Key
tion) “START”
position
86 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
SERVICE/RUN SWITCH
3
2
Op. 55 418 30
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the panel, retaining hardware, 1; and
lower the panel, 2, from the support. Removal of
head line support panel, 3, may be required for 1
easier access.
3. Remove the wires from the switch terminals.
4. Push the switch retaining tabs in and remove the 19984336
switch from the panel. 98
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the switch into the panel and insure the
locking tabs secure the switch.
2. Reconnect the wires to the proper terminals as
shown in the “SERVICE/RUN SWITCH WIRING”
figure above.
3. Reinstall the panel to the support.
4. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
99
SEAT AND SEAT BELT SWITCH WIRING
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 LTGN To EIC Board Pin Seat Belt
#11 (large connec- Buckled
tor)
2 T From Seat Sit in
Switch(es) Seat
3 T To Seat Belt switch Sit in
Seat
4 LTGN/R From Electronics 5A All Times
Fuse (engine panel)
100
5 T To Service/Run Sit in
Switch Seat
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 87
SEAT SWITCH
Op. 55 201 15
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Slide the seat to the most rearward position.
Raise the seat and securely latch in the raised
latched position, 1.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
102
INSTALLATION
1. Install the switch(es) into the seat pan, making
sure the switch is seated into the hole in the seat
pan, 1.
NOTE: IMPORTANT: If the switch is not seated
properly when the retaining hardware is tightened,
the switch flange will be broken.
2. Reconnect the wire harness to the switch(es)
and reinstall the seat retaining hardware. Make
sure the harness connector latches are en-
gaged.
3. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
103
88 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Op. 55 201 14
Op. 55 404 20
106
ROAD LIGHT AND WORK LIGHT SWITCH
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the switch into the panel and insure the
locking tabs secure the switch, 1.
2. Reconnect the wires and connector to the proper
terminals with the PK/B and PK wires toward the
top of the panel.
3. Reattach the switch panel to the overhead dash.
4. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
107
90 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Op. 55 100 34
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Unplug the relay, 1, from the socket, 2. The
corners provide an area to insert screwdriver and
twist to assist removal.
3. The relay socket is wired into the main wire har-
ness.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert new relay fully into socket. 110
2. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
PREHEAT CIRCUIT BREAKER WIRING
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 R/LTBL To Preheat Relay All Times
2 R To Start Relay All Times
3 R From 15A Key Main All Times
Fuse Engine Fuse
Block
111
Op. 55 100 24
2
PREHEAT CIRCUIT BREAKER REMOVAL 1
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Disconnect wires from the terminals, 1.
3. Remove the circuit breaker retaining hardware,
2.
Op. 55 100 34
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
2. Remove the fuse block retaining hardware.
NOTE: NOTE: The standard fuse block, 1, is part of
the main harness and cannot be completely removed
from the main wire harness and replaced separately.
3. The optional equipment fuse block, 2, locks into
the standard fuse block. Insert a 1/4″ blade
screwdriver at the center of the fuse block bases
and twist to release the lock. Slide the optional
block up past the fuses on the standard block to
116
separate.
4. Unplug the wires from the fuse block assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Insert the lock tabs, 1, into slots, 2, and slide the
two blocks together to lock securely as shown.
NOTE: NOTE: The optional equipment fuse block
slides down over the standard block guides and is
positioned toward the center of the panel.
117
2. Attach the wires to the proper side of the fuses as
shown in “ENGINE FUSE PANEL WIRING” fig-
ure above.
1 Standard fuse block
2 Optional fuse block
3. Reinstall the block retaining hardware.
4. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
118
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 95
119
Op. 55 301 16
123
PREHEAT RELAY WIRING
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 R/LTBL From Preheat Circuit All Times
Breaker
2 LTBL/B To Glow Plugs Push
Button
3 LTBL/Y From Manual Push
Preheat Button Button
4 B-6 To Start Relay Ground 124
Circuit
5 B-8 To Engine Ground
Bellhousing Ground Circuit
Service/Run Switch - Run Position
Battery
Ref Color Destination Voltage
1 R/LTBL From Preheat Circuit All Times
Breaker
2 LTBL/B To Glow Plugs EIC
Preheat
Cycle
3 LTBL/Y From Manual EIC
Preheat Button Preheat
Cycle
(Voltage will
be 0.5 to
1.0 volt less
than battery
voltage).
Op. 55 100 34
126
Op. 55 201 26
LT BL/O
R
3
B
6
B 5
4
BSC0935A
129
1. Key switch 4. Electric fuel pump
2. EIC board 5. Injector pump
3. Fuel level sender 6. Fuel shutoff solenoid
100 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
FUEL GAUGE
In the center of the EIC panel is the fuel gauge, im-
plemented as a vertical 10-segment green LED bar
graph. The lowest segments will flash when the fuel
level is low. An audible alarm will accompany the
flashing light for about 5 seconds.
Op. 55 410 80
REMOVAL OF FUEL GAUGE
If the fuel gauge is found operative, the complete EIC
board will require replacement. 2
130
REMOVAL OF FUEL LEVEL SENDER
1. Support the boom on the boom lock pins.
2. Open the rear door and remove the left engine
side shield.
3. Disconnect the wires from the sender, 1.
4. Remove the sender retaining screws, 2, and re-
move the sender, 3, assembly from the tank.
131
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 101
132
Op. 10 223
FUEL SHUTOFF SOLENOID
The fuel shutoff solenoid is located at the injection
pump at 1. The solenoid is controlled through the
starting circuit during cranking. After the engine is
started, the EIC takes control of the solenoid for nor-
mal operation.
If a fault occurs in either the engine oil pressure or the
hydrostatic charge pressure circuits, the EIC will re-
move power from the solenoid, stopping the engine
within 30 seconds.
133
FUEL SHUTOFF SOLENOID TESTING
PRETEST PROBABLE CAUSE AND
STEP INSTRUCTIONS TEST RESULT CORRECTION
1 Loader on level with Battery voltage to NO Check power wire from EIC to
parking brake solenoid solenoid for open; if OK, go to
engaged, key “ON” next step
position, service
“RUN” switch in “RUN” YES Replace solenoid
position
2 Key “ON” position, Battery voltage to NO Check power wire from
service “RUN” switch solenoid service/run switch to fuel
in “SERVICE” position solenoid; if OK, go to next
step
Op. 10 223 10
135
ELECTRIC LIFT PUMP TESTING
PRETEST PROBABLE CAUSE AND
STEP INSTRUCTIONS TEST RESULT CORRECTION
1 Loader on level with Fuel level in tank NO Add fuel and bleed system
parking brake
engaged, key “OFF” YES Go to next step
position
2 Key “ON” position Fuel pump NO Check power supply (5-amp
operating fuse in cab panel). If not OK,
check ground; if OK, replace
pump
NOTE: Always check fuel level in tank. Always check fuel filters.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 103
Op. 10 210 21
Op. 55 414 10
Op. 55 414 12
141
HYDROSTATIC CHARGE PRESSURE
SWITCH INSTALLATION
1. Install the charge pressure switch into the hose.
2. Reinstall the Y/GY and B wires to the switch.
3. Reinstall the fender if removed for access.
106 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Op. 55 414 24
Op. 55 414 20
143
4. Loosen the return line clamp at 1.
5. Remove the return line at 2, and rotate the line so
the oil drains into a clean suitable pan for reuse.
6. After the reservoir is drained, reconnect the re-
turn lines and tighten all fittings and connections.
144
7. Remove the PU/LTBL wire, 1, and B wire, 2, from
the sender, 3.
8. Remove the sender from the reservoir by rotating
the sender counterclockwise.
9. Remove the grounding ring and washer from the
old sender.
145
108 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Op. 35 724 90
REMOVAL
1. Remove any attachment from the loader attach-
ing plate.
2. Raise the boom and support on the boom lock
pins.
3. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the
“RUN” position and operate the boom and bucket
controls to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn “OFF” the key.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the loader.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 109
WIRE HARNESS
Op. 55 100 74
MAIN WIRE HARNESS REMOVAL
1. Remove any attachment from the loader attach-
ing plate.
2. Raise the boom and support on the boom lock
pins.
3. Stop the engine, turn the ignition key to the
“RUN” position and operate the boom and bucket
controls to relieve pressure in the boom and
bucket circuits. Turn “OFF” the key.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless it is properly
supported by the boom lock pins.
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment.
Always remove the attachment from the loader.
148
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 111
149
9. Remove the right side plate, 1, and headliner, 2,
if equipped. Unhook all wire connections at the
service/run switch, and fuse block at this time.
Removal of fuse block/switch panel, 3, may be 1
required for easier switch access.
2
19984337
150
10. Remove the upper rear support retaining hard-
ware, 1, right and left side and remove support,
2.
151
112 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
152
12. Unplug the seat wire harness from the main har-
ness, if not previously unplugged.
13. Remove the seat and seat pan assembly retain-
ing hardware, 1, unlatch the seat assembly at 2,
and remove the assembly from the loader.
153
14. Remove the four retaining screws from the front
shield, 1, and the eight retaining bolts from the
step shield, 2. Remove both shields from the
loader.
154
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 113
155
16. Remove the right hydrostatic control handle as-
sembly, 1, retaining hardware, 2. Unhook the hy-
drostatic control linkage, 3, and auxiliary boom
hydraulic linkage, 4, (if equipped). Lift the control
assembly from the loader.
156
17. Remove the right fender to access and loosen
the right front isolator mount bolt, 1.
157
114 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
158
20. Remove harness from left rear of engine area
after disconnecting wires from fuel sender, 1.
159
21. Thoroughly clean the connector between the
main and engine harness. Make sure the con-
nector is dry.
22. Unplug the main wire harness from the engine
wire harness, 1, and remove the ground wires
from the engine bellhousing ground stud, 2. Re-
move wires from the engine fuse and relay panel,
3.
23. Remove the hydraulic oil temperature sender
wires and remove the harness from the clamp on
the face of bellhousing. Remove the remaining
bellhousing clamps.
160
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 115
19997742
161
25. Now the right side panel, 1, can be pivoted into
the center of the cab area at the rear and the wire
harness can be removed from the corner of the
side panel.
162
MAIN WIRE HARNESS INSTALLATION
1. Install the wire harness up the right rear corner of
the side panel with the EIC board connector to-
ward the front of the loader cab. Position the ser-
vice/run and fuse block connectors at their loca-
tion. Place the wire in the upper rear corner of the
cab side panel at 1, to prevent the wire harness
from contacting the cab panel retaining hard-
ware. Install two wire ties or clamp at the upper
right side of the rear window and one tie at the
bottom to hold the harness up and maintain
clearance from the cab panel hardware and
headliner support.
163
116 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
164
3. Route the wire harness to the front of the loader
on the left side, 1 and 2, and install wire clamps
where previously installed. Place the harness
into the loop (keeper) and secure with a wire tie
at 1, and then along the top of the lower frame to
the rear of the loader to the engine fuse/relay
panel area.
4. Route the harness branch to the inside of the
frame with the hydraulic lines and down to the
floor and front of the control valve. Refasten in
the J clamp and route the connectors between
valve bosses and plug in solenoids. Tuck the
connectors between valve bosses to protect the
harness.
165
5. Connect the main wire harness connector to the
engine wire harness, 1. Reconnect the wires to
the engine fuse and relay panel, 2.
6. Reconnect the wires to the fuel tank sender.
NOTE: Refer to “Removal, Installation and Wiring of
Electrical Components” earlier in this section for
more details of proper wire connections.
166
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 117
167
9. Reattach the wires to the service/run switch, 1;
fuse block(s), 2; preheat switch, 3; and any
ground wires if removed at 4.
NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place
the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface
and then stack the remaining ground wires according
to wire size on top of the heaviest wire.
168
10. Reposition the right side panel, 1, and reinstall
the front dash support hardware.
11. Reinstall the right front isolator, 2, if removed.
12. Reinstall the upper rear support.
13. Reinstall the lower rear support, 3, and the isola-
tors, 4. Tighten all cab support and side shield
hardware at this time.
169
118 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
170
16. Route the wire harness to the front of the cab to
the ignition switch and EIC board area. Attach the
wires to the ignition switch and position the wire
harness to prevent damage. Reinstall the switch
panel, 1.
17. Attach the wire harness connectors, 2, to the
proper EIC board connector and position the wire
harness across the front of the dash area to pre-
vent damage. Reinstall the EIC board.
18. Reconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
19. Check the electrical system for proper operation.
171
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 119
Op. 55 404
ROAD/WORK LIGHTS
The road and work lights provide illumination for road
travel and work operations. The rear work lights are
not recommended for road travel.
172
Road/work light switch, 1, is located in the ignition
key switch panel in the upper right corner of the over-
head dash. To remove the switch, disconnect the
negative (-) ground battery cable. Remove the key
switch panel hardware, 2, and tilt the panel down.
173
Disconnect wires from the switch, squeeze the
switch retaining tabs in, and remove the switch from
the panel.
174
120 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
175
Road/Work Light Wiring Diagram
NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place
the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface
and then stack the remaining ground wires according
to size on top of the heaviest wire.
PK/B
B B B B
DKBL/W
9 PK/B
B
B
B–3
O/B
8 1
PK/B
DKBL/W O/B
DKBL/W 15A
7.5A DKBL
B
DKBL
5A
O/B PK
5A
2
6
4
7 3
5
DKBL/W PK/B
B B–3
SH48091
176
Road?Work Kight Wiring Diagram
1. Right rear light 5. Connector to EIC
2. Rear work light 6. Light switch
3. Left rear light 7. Left front road/work light
4. Cab outer fuse block 8. Right front work/road light
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 121
Bulb Replacement
Clear lens with bulb #86533429 1
Bulb only (clear) #86533428
Red lens with bulb #9829515
Bulb only (red) #C6AB13465A
Op. 55 404 10
Front Road/Work Light
1. Facing the lens of the light assembly, push the
lens assembly, 1, to the left and lift the right side
of the assembly from the support.
177
2. Unplug the wire harness from the bulb, unlatch-
ing the connector at 1, and sliding the harness 1
from the bulb.
178
3. Facing the back of the assembly, rotate the bulb
holder, 1, counterclockwise and remove the bulb 3
from the support.
4. Position the bulb so when it is locked in position
the connector, 2, is pointed down with the clip, 3,
to the right.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT touch the bulb during re-
moval and installation. The bulb may become dam-
aged or a premature failure may occur.
179
122 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Op. 55 404 10
Rear Work and Taillight
1. Remove the center work light, 1, by pushing the 3 3
lens assembly to the left and lift the right side of
the assembly from the support.
2. Remove the red taillight lamps, 2, by unscrewing
the bezel self-tapping screws and removing the
bezels, 3.
3. Unplug the wire harness from the bulb, unlatch-
ing the connector, and sliding the harness from
the bulb.
180
4. Facing the back of the assembly, rotate the bulb
holder, 1, counterclockwise and remove the bulb 3
from the support. Replace the bulb.
5. For the clear rear work lamp, position the bulb so
when it is locked in position the connector, 2, is
pointed down with the clip, 3, to the right.
IMPORTANT: DO NOT touch the bulb during re-
moval and installation. The bulb may become dam-
aged or a premature failure may occur.
181
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 123
Op. 55 301
ALTERNATOR(45 AMP VERSION)
182
Charging System
1. Ground terminal (B) 4. Field excitation terminal (Y/DKBL)
2. Tachometer sense terminal (PU/R) 5. Main wire harness
3. Output terminal (R/DKBL) 6. Regulator and brushbox assembly
CHARGING SYSTEM
Introduction 2. A light-gauge wire, yellow with dark blue tracer,
The SL65B skid steers are equipped with Magnetti connects to the field excitation terminal. This cir-
Marelli (Lucas) A127-type alternators. s cuit provides initial voltage to energize the field at
This alternator is rated at 45 amps, has an integral startup.
regulator, and is driven by a single V-belt from the 3. A wire, purple with red tracer, connects to the “W”
engine crankshaft. terminal. This circuit provides an engine speed
Four cables from the wire harness connect with the signal to the Electronic Instrument Cluster.
alternator: 4. The fourth wire, black, connects to one of the al-
1. A heavy-gauge wire, red with a dark blue tracer, ternator housing bolts and functions as the
is the main power cable from the alternator. It ground circuit.
connects to the “B+” (output) terminal.
124 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
1
7 8
6
3
5 4
183
Alternator Charging Circuit
A To Starter Motor 1. Starter Solenoid 6. Stator Output Windings (45/70 Amp Alterna-
tors)
B To Starter Relay 2. Battery 7. Rectifier Pack
C To Electronic Instrument 3. Rotor Field Winding 8. Key Start Switch
Panel 4. Regulator
5. Alternator Frame B+ Output (R/DB)
D+ Field Excitation (Y/DKBL)
When the key start switch, 8, is turned on, a small cur- A portion of this current is fed back to the rotor field
rent flows from the battery, 2, through the rotor field winding, through the regulator, supplementing the in-
winding, 3. The circuit is made through the key start itial current. This produces an increasing magnetic
switch, the “D+” terminal, the rotor field winding, and field in the rotor, resulting in a rapid rise in generated
the integral regulator, 4, to ground. output current and voltage.
At this stage, the rotor is partially magnetized. The voltage continues to rise until the regulated volt-
When the engine is started and the partially-magnet- age level is reached. The voltage regulator controls
ized rotor revolves within the stator windings, a alternator output voltage by controlling the strength
3-phase alternating current is generated. This AC of the field current.
current is converted to direct current by the three field In a properly operating alternator, voltage at the out-
diodes in the rectifier pack, 7. put terminal (B+) will always equal voltage at the field
excitation terminal (D+).
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 125
189
Rotor Field Winding Continuity Test
1. Remove the regulator and brushbox assembly
from the alternator by withdrawing three screws
and one slip on connector.
2. Using an ohmmeter, 3, check resistance be-
tween the two slip rings, 2. The slip rings are ac-
cessible through the brushbox opening.
3. Resistance should be 2.9 ± 0.5 ohms at room
temperature.
If resistance is outside of specification, replace the
rotor.
190
Brushes and Springs and Rotor Slip Rings
1. Remove the regulator and brushbox assembly
from the alternator by withdrawing three screws
and one slip on connector.
2. Examine the brushes, ensuring they are clean
and free in the housing. The visible-free length of
the brushes should be 5 mm (0.25″) minimum.
3. Check the brush spring pressure which should
be 1.3 - 2.7 N (5 - 10 oz.) with the brush face flush
with the housing.
If the brush-free length or spring pressure are below
specification, replace the brushbox and regulator as-
sembly. The brushes are an integral part of the as-
sembly and cannot be replaced as individual items. 191
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 131
Op. 55 301 04
Op. 55 301 10
ALTERNATOR REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Disconnect the RED/DK BL wiring lead, 3, from
terminal B+ and PUR/RED wiring lead, 2, from
terminal W.
3. Disconnect BLK wiring lead, 1, and YEL/DK BL SM863-163
electrical connector, 4. 192
4. Remove the mounting bolts, nuts and lock
washers, 5. Remove belt, 6. Remove the alterna-
tor from the machine.
132 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
SM863-164
193
45 Amp Alternator Components
1. Rectifier Assembly 6. Stator
2. Pulley Retaining Nut 7. Rotor
3. Pulley 8. Regulator and Brushbox Assembly
4. Cooling Fan 9. Rear End Housing
5. Front End Housing
Op. 55 301 12 6. Separate the front end housing from the stator
and rear end housing.
DISASSEMBLY
7. Remove the two screws securing the rectifier as-
1. Remove the nut, insulator and washers from ter-
sembly, 1, to the rear end housing. Separate the
minal “W”.
stator and the rectifier assembly from the rear
2. Remove the nut, insulator, and washers from ter- end housing.
minal “B+”.
8. Unsolder the stator leads from the tabs on the
3. Remove the three securing bolts and withdraw rectifier using pliers as a heat sink to protect the
the regulator and brushbox assembly, 8. Discon- diodes from overheating.
nect the slip on connector.
9. Remove the nut, 2, washer, pulley, 3, fan, 4, and
4. Remove the three nuts from the alternator spacer from the rotor shaft, 7.
through bolts.
10. Press the rotor shaft out of the front-end bracket
5. Mark the alternator front end housing, 5, stator, bearing.
6, and rear end housing, 9, to ensure correct
alignment on reassembly.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 133
Op. 55 301 14
196
134 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
1
3
197
Rotor Tests
Prior to performing component tests on the rotor, in-
spect the slip rings. The slip rings should be clean
and smooth. If dirty, they may be cleaned with a sol-
vent-moistened cloth. If the slip rings are burned,
they may be polished with a fine crocus cloth, then
wiped clean.
The refinishing cloth must be fine enough to leave a
highly-polished slip ring surface, otherwise excess-
ive brush wear will occur.
Do not use an emery cloth, as it will leave an abrasive
residue, leading to premature brush failure.
If the slip rings are excessively worn, a new rotor
must be installed.
Rotor Field Winding Continuity Test
1. Connect an ohmmeter, 3, between the slip rings,
2. The resistance should be 2.9 ± 0.5 ohms.
If the resistance is outside of specification, re-
place rotor, 1.
198
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 135
199
INSPECTION AND REPAIR
1. Inspect the rotor poles and stator for signs of rub-
bing. Areas of rubbing indicates possible worn
bearings, misaligned housings or a bent rotor as-
sembly shaft.
NOTE: The front-end bearing is not serviced separ-
ately. It will be necessary to replace the front-end
housing assembly if the bearing has failed.
2. Inspect the roller bearing, 1, located in the rear
end housing, 2.
3. If bearing replacement is necessary, support the
housing and carefully drive out the bearing using
SM863-171
a properly-sized mandrel.
200
4. Clean and examine all components.
5. Press the new bearing into the housing, 1. The
bearing, 2, should be positioned 0.50 - 0.70 mm
(0.020″ - 0.028″) above the inner face of the
bearing boss, 3.
201
136 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
REASSEMBLY
1. Reassembly of the alternator follows the disas-
sembly process in reverse.
On reassembly, observe the following precau-
tions:
– Use a low-wattage soldering iron and a heat
sink when connecting the stator leads to the
rectifier assembly to avoid damaging the
diodes.
– To avoid misalignment of the end brackets,
install the stator assembly in the front-end
bracket and then assemble the rear-end
bracket to the stator assembly.
REINSTALLATION
1. Installation of the alternator is the reverse of the
removal procedure.
2. Install the mounting bolts, nuts, and lock
washers, 5. Install belt, 6.
3. Connect the RED/DKBL wiring lead, 3, to ter-
minal B+ and PUR/RED wiring lead, 2, to ter-
minal, W.
4. Reconnect BLK wiring lead, 1, and YEL/DKBL
electrical connector to 4.
5. Reconnect the negative battery cable.
SM863-173
202
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 137
203
Op. 55 201 When the key start switch is closed with the operator
in the seat and the seat belt fastened, or with the
STARTER “Service/Run” switch in the “Service” position, the
solenoid coils are energized, pulling the solenoid
plunger into the solenoid core. This action forces the
INTRODUCTION drive pinion via pivoted linkage into mesh with the
The starting system consists of a starter motor and starter ring gear. On full engagement, the solenoid
solenoid assembly, a starter relay, seat belt interlock plunger closes a set of contacts to give a direct feed
system, battery, key start switch, and heavy-duty wir- from the battery to all four field coils, providing full
ing. power to the starter motor.
The starter motor, rated at 3.1 Kw, is a four-pole, four- The starter incorporates a single set of contacts and
brush-type with integral solenoid and positive en- a two-piece solenoid plunger which completely
gagement drive assembly. closes the contacts, even if the pinion and ring gear
The integral solenoid incorporates two windings con- teeth are misaligned. When this happens, an en-
nected in parallel. One winding is the low resistance gagement spring is compressed, which forces the
“pull-in” coil grounded through the motor, while the pinion into full engagement as soon as the starter be-
other is the high resistance “hold-in” coil grounded gins to turn.
via the solenoid body.
138 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
When the key start switch is released, power to the Service Specifications
solenoid and motor is removed. The solenoid return No load test 11.5 volts
spring, acting through the pivoted linkage, pulls the 170 amps
drive pinion out of mesh and opens the solenoid con-
8000 RPM
tacts.
Locked rotor test 6.8 volts
Incorporated in the drive pinion assembly is an over- 1200 - 1400 amps
running clutch, 8. This clutch prevents the armature
35 N·m (26 ft. lbs.) torque
from over-speeding if the pinion remains in mesh
with the ring gear after the engine has started. Solenoid holding 8.0 volts
voltage, min.
Commutator dia. 45 mm (1.77 in.) - new
STARTER
42.5 mm (1.67 in.) - min.
Commutator brush, 8.5 mm (0.33 in.)
General Specifications
min. length
Rated voltage 12 volts
Armature end play 0.1 - 0.3 mm
Output 3.1 kw
(0.004 - 0.012″)
Motor-type Four-pole series wound
Pinion tooth backlash 0.4 - 0.7 mm
Engaging system Solenoid engaged pinion
(0.016 - 0.028″)
Rotation Clockwise (when viewed
from pinion)
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 139
Operator not in seat with seat Sit in seat. Buckle seat belt.
belt buckled. Retest.
STARTER MOTOR
Op. 55 201 50
REMOVAL
1. Raise the boom, extend the boom lock pins, and
rest the boom on the pins.
2. Open the engine compartment and remove the
left side shield.
3. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
4. Remove the fuel filter/sedimenter assembly, 1, to
provide access to the starter, 2.
5. Disconnect the throttle cable from the fuel injec-
tion pump and lay it, with the mounting bracket, 204
out of the way.
6. Disconnect the heavy electrical cables from the
upper post of the starter solenoid. Remove the
solenoid signal wire (white/red) from the sole-
noid.
7. Remove the cap screw and nut, which serve as
a main ground location, as well as retain the
starter in place. Retain all of the ground wires on
the cap screw and replace the nut. This will en-
sure all grounds are connected at reassembly.
8. Remove the remaining two cap screws holding
the starter and rotate the starter to remove from
the flywheel housing.
INSTALLATION
Starter installation is the reverse of the removal pro-
cedure, observing the following precautions:
1. Ensure the starter fits properly on the mounting
flange before tightening any of the mounting cap
screws.
2. Ensure all of the grounding wires removed in step
7 above are properly replaced with the heaviest
gauge wires placed closest to the flywheel hous-
ing.
3. Check fuel lines for leaks after engine startup.
NOTE: The ground strap, 3, ground strap to main
frame, battery (-) negative ground cable, 4, and
ground wire, 5, must all be connected to the engine
bell housing at 6. Ground wire, 5, connects this
ground connection to the main electrical ground stud
at 7, at the front of the engine bell housing. If the
ground wires are not properly connected, engine
crankshaft and bearing damage may occur.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 141
STARTER MAINTENANCE ing a 0-20 volt voltmeter and a 0-500 amp ammeter
Little maintenance of the starter is required. No peri- be used to diagnose starting system problems.
odic lubrication of the sealed bearings or starter drive When using test equipment, follow the manufac-
are required. turer’s recommended test procedures. If the recom-
If the starter drive becomes sluggish or hangs up, mended test equipment is not available, the following
due to dirt, it should be washed with diesel fuel. The test procedure (using a standard 0-20 volt voltmeter
fuel will not wash away the lubricant in the bushings and a 0-500 amp ammeter) can be used to determine
and will lubricate the starter drive. if the starter is operating correctly without removing
it from the engine.
The starter brushes should be inspected whenever
the starter is removed, after extended use and when- Before testing:
ever a problem with the starter is suspected. 1. Ensure that the battery is fully charged.
Ensure the brushes are free to slide freely in their 2. Check the complete starting system wiring circuit
holder. If dirty, wash with a suitable solvent, drying for frayed or broken wires. Also check for loose
with a clean, lint-free cloth and dry compressed air. or corroded terminal connections.
If binding, smooth with a fine abrasive or fine file. 3. Ensure the engine is not seized.
Clean all residue before installation. NOTE: Starter motor draw is directly dependent on
Replace a brush if it is broken, if the soldered pigtail the load placed on it. The above specifications are
has loosened, or if it is worn below 8.5 mm (11/32″). based on moderate ambient temperatures and a cold
Ensure new brushes do not bind in the holder. The motor. Extremely high or low temperatures will affect
commutator should be turned whenever new the load placed on the starter motor, thus the amper-
brushes are installed. age draw reading. Likewise, cold temperatures par-
ticularly will affect battery voltage readings.
SYSTEM TESTING NOTE: Before performing these tests ensure the hy-
For easier and rapid diagnosis, and for most conclus- drostats are in neutral. If the starter motor is required
ive test results, it is recommended that a battery/ to pump oil in the hydrostat system, the amperage
starter tester (high rate discharge tester) incorporat- draw will be excessively high, even with a good
starter motor.
142 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
206
Starter Motor Ground Connection Test
1. Connect the voltmeter to the starter motor frame,
1.
2. Connect the voltmeter negative lead to the en-
gine block, 2. Ensure that the meter lead is not
insulated from the block by paint.
3. Crank the engine while observing the voltmeter
reading. If the reading exceeds 0.2 volts, check
the ground connections between the starter
motor flange and the rear engine plate.
207
Battery Ground Cable Test
1. Connect the voltmeter positive lead to the engine
block, 1.
2. Connect the voltmeter negative lead to the bat-
tery negative terminal, 2.
3. Crank the engine while observing the voltmeter
reading. If the reading exceeds 0.2 volts, check,
clean and tighten the ground cable connections.
Retest. If voltage drop is still excessive, install a
new ground cable.
208
144 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
20
209
Starter Motor - Exploded View
1. Stud and Bolt Kit 11. Housing Assembly
2. End Cap 12. Solenoid Assembly
3. Collar and Ring Assembly, Drive Thrust 13. Solenoid Hardware Kit
4. Brush End Plate Assembly 14. Lever Assembly
5. Brush Assembly 15. Brush Spring
6. Brush Assembly 16. Brush Holder Assembly
7. Field Coils and Housing Assembly 17. Washer
8. Armature 18. Nut
9. Center Bearing Plate 19. Drive Assembly
10. Bushing 20. Pivot Pin
DISASSEMBLY
1. Support the starter motor in a soft jaw vise. 5. Remove the two end housing nuts and the two
2. Disconnect the thick braided wire from the field screws retaining the end cap, 2, and brush plate
coil housing to the solenoid assembly. to the end housing, 4. Remove the “C” clip and ar-
mature shaft end play shims, 3, and withdraw the
3. Remove the three screws from the front housing
end housing, leaving the brush gear, 16, on the
assembly, 11, and withdraw the solenoid assem-
commutator. Remove the thin metal washer from
bly, 12. The plunger will remain in the drive en-
the commutator end of the armature.
gagement lever, 14.
NOTE: At this point, inspect the brushes and
4. Remove the solenoid plunger from the drive en-
commutator as detailed under “Inspection and Re-
gagement lever by gripping the plunger and lift-
pair Bench Test” and determine if these are the cause
ing up the front end and releasing it from the drive
of failure.
engagement lever.
SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1 145
6. To remove the brush carrier and brushes, com- 2. Lever the armature fully forward and zero the dial
press the brush springs by inserting a small indicator. Lever the armature fully rearward and
screwdriver through the spring coil and bend record the indicator reading.
back the spring retaining tabs. Gently release the 3. The indicator reading should not exceed 0.3 mm
spring and remove the brush from the holder. (0.012″). If the reading is greater, inspect the ar-
With the four brushes removed, remove the mature assembly for wear. Replace worn com-
carrier. ponents as required and recheck the end play.
7. Remove the armature and drive end bracket
from the motor housing assembly. INSPECTION AND REPAIR - BENCH TEST
8. Remove the drive engagement lever pivot pin,
20, from the drive end housing. Brush Assembly
9. Remove the drive assembly, 19, and inner plate 1. Check for sticking brushes. If necessary, clean
retaining snap ring, 3, from the armature shaft by brushes and brush guides with a solvent-
driving the securing thrust collar squarely off the moistened cloth. Remove any burrs on the
snap ring with a suitable diameter tube and then brushes with a fine abrasive or a fine file.
levering the snap ring from the groove.
2. Check brushes for wear. If worn below the mini-
10. Remove the armature and drive assembly. mum length specified of 8.5 mm (0.33″), they
should be replaced. The commutator should be
REASSEMBLY turned whenever new brushes are installed.
Reassembly of the starter follows the disassembly
procedure in reverse. Brush Removal and Installation
After completing reassembly and prior to installation 1. Unsolder the field brush leads from the field coils.
in the engine, check the armature end play to specifi- 2. Unsolder the ground brush leads from the brush
cation and test the starter no load operation. holders.
3. Install the new brushes, soldering the leads using
Checking Armature End Play a 300-watt soldering iron and resin core solder.
1. Support the starter motor in a soft jaw vise. At- 4. Ensure the new brushes move freely in the
tach a dial indicator to the drive end housing holders. If necessary, smooth the sides of the
flange. Place the dial indicator pointer on the end brushes with a fine abrasive or fine file.
of the armature shaft.
146 SECTION 55 – ELECTRICAL SYSTEM – CHAPTER 1
Chapter 1 – Buckets
CONTENT
1
Op. 82 100 Bucket Capacity Cubic Feet
Capacity Capacity
GENERAL INFORMATION Bucket Heaped Struck
Width Bucket (cu ft) (cu ft)
BUCKETS 66″ Utility fork N/A N/A
Bucket Types 66″ Low profile 15.5 11.2
1 - LP - Low profile 66″ Dirt and foundry 15.2 11.6
The low-profile bucket has a shorter back and is 72″ Low profile 17.1 12.2
longer from bucket heel to cutting edge for optimum
72″ Dirt and foundry 16.7 12.7
cutting edge visibility. This is important for finish grad-
ing and accurate cut and fill jobs. 72″ Manure and fertilizer 19.1 15.5
2 - D & F - Dirt and foundry 72″ Light material 23.7 19.0
The dirt and foundry bucket is shorter from bucket 84″ Low profile 20.2 14.3
heel to cutting edge to provide maximum breakout 84″ Manure and fertilizer 22.5 18.2
force for tough digging conditions.
84″ Light material 27.9 22.3
3 - M & F - Manure and fertilizer (slurry)
The manure and slurry bucket is for handling loose
or fluid materials with more rollback to minimize spil-
lage.
4 - LM - Light material
The light-material bucket is for light, high- volume
materials for more productivity handling light ma-
terial.
Select bucket styles and sizes to provide both ad-
equate breakout force and reasonable carrying ca-
pacity. Handle dense materials with a relatively small
bucket. Handle lighter materials with higher capacity
buckets. Refer to the following bucket capacity chart
and the material weight chart in the operator’s manual
when choosing the bucket for a job.
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 3
Op. 82 100 77
2
To engage the boom lock pins:
1. Raise the boom above the boom lock pins and
engage the pins, 1.
2. Turn the ignition key to the “OFF” position to stop
the engine.
3. Turn the ignition key to the “ON” position and op-
erate the boom and bucket pedals to lower the
boom onto the lock pins and to relieve the pres-
sure in the boom and bucket circuits. Turn the
ignition key to the “OFF” position.
CAUTION
Never work under a raised boom unless the boom is
resting on the boom lock pins, 1. 3
Never work under a raised boom with an attachment,
always remove any attachment from the loader
mounting plate.
BOOM
The boom assembly consists of:
Op. 82 100 50
1 - Main boom frame
Op. 82 100 52
2 - Lower link, right and left
Op. 82 100 53
3 - Upper link, right and left
The boom and links are supported on the ROPS main
frame with tapered pivot pins at all pivot locations.
4
4 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
Op. 82 100 70
6
BOOM AND CYLINDER PIVOT PIN LOCA-
TION AND MACHINE USAGE
Ref. Description Part Number Qty. Torque
1 Mounting Plate Pivot 86501434 2 80 ft. lbs. (108 N·m)
2 Upper Bucket Cyl. Pivot 86501432 2 80 ft. lbs. (108 N·m)
3 Lower Bucket Cyl. Pivot 9614349 2 28 ft. lbs. (38 N·m)
4 Upper Boom Cyl. Pivot 86521982 2 28 ft. lbs. (38 N·m)
5 Lower Boom Cyl. Pivot 86501428 2 250 ft. lbs. (338 N·m)
6 Boom Lower Link Pivot 86501424 4 250 ft. lbs. (338 N·m)
7 Boom Upper Link Pivot 86501426 4 250 ft. lbs. (338 N·m)
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 5
Part Number A B C
9614349 (95mm) 3-3/4I (38mm)-1-1/2I
86501424 (92mm)-3-5/8I (60.3mm)-2-3/8I (156mm)-6-9/64I
86501426 (62.5mm)-2-15/32I (60.3mm)-2-3/8I (126.5mm)-5I
86501428 (59mm)-2-21/64I (60.3mm)-2-3/8I (126.5mm)-5I
86501432 (78.3mm)-3-5/64I (38.10mm)-1-1/2I (118.5mm)-4-43/64I
86501434 (57.8mm)-2-9/32I (38.10mm)-1-1/2I (92mm)-3-5/8I
86521982 (117mm)-4-39/64I (38.1mm)-1-1/2I
Op. 82 100 30
1
PALLET FORK
Pallet fork frame/guard, 36″ - 42″ - 48″ fork sets are
available. A block fork set is also available.
To adjust fork spacing, raise the lock pin, 1, and slide
the fork to the required spacing and relatch lock pins
into notches, 2. 2
2
Pallet Fork Capacity - LS180
2
WITH WEIGHT KIT
19990486
SAE
Max. Reach Height Rating 8
2794 mm ( 110″ ) 804 kg (1773 lbs.)
WITHOUT WEIGHT KIT
SAE
Max. Reach Height Rating
2794 mm (110 ″) 757 kg (1670 lbs.)
19990487
1
9
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 7
Op. 82 100 20
UTILITY FORK
The utility fork is for handling matted, stringy material
which is difficult to load into a standard bucket.
10
The standard tine spacing, center to center, is 21.8
cm (8-1/2″). The fork frame is equipped with addi-
tional holes for additional tines, reducing the tine
spacing to 10.9 cm (4-1/4″).
11
Op. 82 100 11
Tine Installation
1. Slide each tine, 1, into the fork backplate for the
desired tine spacing, until the 1/2″ x 2-3/4″ bolt,
2, can be inserted through the fork backplate and
tine with the nut to the inside of the fork back-
plate.
2. Position the spacer, 3, as shown with the angle
end of the spacer next to the floor of the back-
plate. Secure the assembly with 1/2″ lock washer
and nut. Tighten securely.
12
8 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
BUCKETS
Op. 82 100 12
Op. 82 100
17
10 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
18
7. Position the second plates as shown at 1, with
the plates contacting each other at 2, and about
28.6 mm (1-1/8″) spacing at 3. On low-profile
buckets, the second plate will be at the rear
corner of the bucket at 4. Spot weld the second
plate to the bucket at 4 and the two plates to-
gether at 5.
8. Remove the 4.8 mm (3/16″) square key stock
and push the latch handles to the latched position
making sure the latch pins engage the bucket
latch plates. The latch handles must fully latch.
The latch pin will only contact the top latch plate,
6.
19
9. If the latch handles will not fully latch, the top
plate may require some grinding in the pin area
at 1, or the plates are not located properly. 1
1
19984597
20
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 11
21
12. Attach the bucket to the loader by engaging the
top of the plate, 1, under the lip of the bucket at
2. Curl the bucket back to allow the bucket to con-
tact the loader quick-attach plate and engage the 2
latch handles and pins, making sure the latch
pins engage the bucket plates properly.
19984597
22
12 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
Op. 82 100
23
Op. 82 100 10
Tooth Point Replacement
The points of the teeth are a replaceable “pin-on” de-
sign and can be obtained from Parts.
To replace the “pin-on” points, use a punch that just
fits into the pin hole, 1, and drive the old retaining pin
from the shank.
Place the new point over the shank and insert the re-
taining pin into pin hole, 1. With a punch that contacts
both sides of the metal part of the retaining pin, drive
the pin until it is centered in the shank.
NOTE: If the punch or driver is too small and just con-
tacts the rubber center of the retaining pin, the pin will 24
be damaged and will not retain the point.
Tooth Location and Installation
1. The bucket should be flat on the floor when plac-
ing and welding the teeth to maintain good weld
points, 1.
IMPORTANT: Remove the bucket from the loader
while welding teeth to prevent damage to the loader
electrical system.
Slide the replaceable points in place but do not
attach with the steel/rubber pins as the rubber
may be damaged during the welding process.
25
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 13
26
2. Locate the teeth on the bucket edge as indicated.
NOTE: Position the teeth at these spacings, then re-center if necessary for equal spacing.
14 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
27
4. Weld in the direction shown at 1.
5. Weld a 5 mm (3/16″) fillet weld along both sides
and rear of the tooth at 2, high carbon steel to
high carbon steel.
28
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 15
Op. 82 100 77
REMOVAL
1. Lower the boom to the lowered position.
2. Open the rear door, 1, and the top engine access
cover, 2.
3. Remove the right and left engine side covers, 3.
29
4. Unhook spring, 1, from the control rod, by sliding
the spring to the side and removing spring at bot-
tom hook, 2.
5. Remove the push nuts, 3, from the control rod, 4.
6. Detach the linkage from the lock pin by removing
bolt, 5.
7. Remove the linkage support retaining hardware,
6.
30
8. Remove the plastic handle grip, 1, from the con-
trol lever.
31
16 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
32
11. Shown are the boom lock pins and linkage.
1. Boom Lock Pins (2)
2. Control Rod (1)
3. Push Nuts (2)
4. Support Angle (1)
5. Control Lever Assembly (1)
6. Plastic Handle Grip (1)
7. Spring
33
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 17
REINSTALLATION
1. Install the boom lock pins, 1, right and left, into
the ROPS posts at 2.
2. Install a rubber grommet at 3. Insert the control
handle assembly, 4, through the right cab side
shield at 5.
34
3. Position the control handle over the lock pin, 1,
and install the support hardware at 2.
4. Install the handle and lock pin through bolt at 3.
5. With the handle properly positioned tighten the
support hardware at 2, and the through bolt lock
nut, 3.
NOTE: Do not over tighten the through bolt because
the handle must pivot at the lock pin.
6. Install the control rod, 4, in the handle assembly,
positioning the seat and seat belt wire harness to
the seat side of the control rod.
35
7. Install the control rod, 1, in the left boom lock pin,
2. Slide new push retaining nuts onto the control
rod on both sides at 3.
36
18 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
37
BOOM, UPPER AND LOWER LINK
REMOVAL
1. Remove any attachment (bucket, fork, etc.) from
the boom mounting plate and lower the boom to
the lowered position.
38
2. Attach a chain or strap suitable for handling the
weight of the boom, approximately 360 kg (800
lbs.), to the boom grab handles as shown at 1,
and support about level with the top of the loader
ROPS.
CAUTION
Always use suitable lifting device and chains or
straps to support and remove the boom.
39
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 19
40
Op. 82 100 52
Lower Link Removal
1. Remove the plastic plugs, 1, from the cab inner
shell to access the boom lower link and cylinder
pivot hardware.
2. Remove the fenders to gain access to the boom
and bucket hydraulic tube and hose connections.
41
3. With the boom properly supported and all hy-
draulic oil pressure removed from the boom and
bucket circuits, disconnect the hydraulic lines at
1. Cap open ends of lines and hoses. Remove
the boom hose clamps, 2, retaining the hoses to
the lower boom links. Remove the hoses from the
lower hose retainer, 3.
CAUTION
Always use suitable lifting device and chains or
straps to support and remove the boom.
Do not disconnect any hydraulic lines until all hy-
draulic pressure is removed from the boom and
bucket hydraulic circuits.
42
NOTE: Mark all boom and boom link tapered pins
with their proper location prior to removal. This will
ensure that all pins are installed in their correct posi-
tion during reassembly.
20 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
4. Loosen the right and left lower link, rear pivot pin
retaining hardware.
CAUTION
Do not remove the pin retaining hardware until the
tapered pivot pin is broken loose at the tapered end
of pin or the link and pin may fall.
43
6. Loosen the front lower link pivot pin retaining
hardware, 1, and strike the link at 2, to break the
tapered pivot pin loose in the ROPS frame.
44
7. Remove the retaining pin hardware from the front
and rear pins. Lift the lower link and pins from the
loader.
NOTE: Both the right and left lower links can be re-
moved as described.
45
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 21
Op. 82 100 53
Upper Link Removal
1. The boom must be properly supported at the
front and rear with the boom in the lowered posi-
tion or raise and support the boom above the
front upper link pivot. Remove all hydraulic oil
pressure from the boom and bucket hydraulic cir-
cuits.
NOTE: Supporting of the boom will keep the boom
positioned during removal of the upper links.
CAUTION
Always use suitable lifting device and chains or
straps to support and remove the boom. 46
47
Op. 82 100 50
Main Boom Removal
1. Remove the plastic plugs, 1, from the cab inner
shell to access the boom lower link and cylinder
pivot hardware.
2. Remove the fenders to gain access to the boom
and bucket hydraulic tube and hose connections.
48
22 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
50
5. Remove the right and left upper boom cylinder
pivot pin retaining hardware, 1, and pin, 2, from
cylinders and boom.
NOTE: If only the main boom is being removed the
cylinders can remain attached at the bottom pivot.
NOTE: Mark all boom and boom link tapered pins
with their proper location prior to removal. This will
ensure that all pins are installed in their correct posi-
tion during reassembly.
51
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 23
6. Loosen the right and left lower link, rear pivot pin
retaining hardware.
CAUTION
Do not remove the pin retaining hardware until the
tapered pivot pin is broken loose at the tapered end
of pin or the link and pin may fall.
52
8. Remove the pin retaining hardware and pin from
the link and main boom. Lower the link and rest
it on the loader frame.
53
9. Loosen the right and left upper link rear retaining
bolts, 1; do not remove. With a soft-faced sledge
hammer, strike the link at 2, to break the tapered
pivot pin loose in the main boom.
10. Remove the hardware and pins from the ROPS
and link, resting the link on the lower link.
11. Lift the boom assembly from the loader.
54
24 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
Op. 82 100 70
56
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 25
58
3. Install the upper link pivot pins through the links
and insert the tapered end of the pin into the
ROPS post. Install the pin retaining hardware
and tighten, making sure the tapered pin is in-
serted into the ROPS post straight.
4. Position the main boom assembly over the
loader positioning the boom against the front
boom stops (front of the final drive case).
59
26 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
60
6. Attach the rear of the lower link at 1, using the
tapered pivot pins and retaining hardware.
Tighten the hardware, making sure the pin is
straight in the main boom.
61
7. With the main boom, upper and lower links at-
tached, the pivot pins and hardware must be
properly seated.
Torque the pin retaining hardware to the following
torques:
Lower link - 250 ft. lbs. (338 N·m)
Upper link - 250 ft. lbs. (338 N·m)
Cylinder pivot (lower) - 125 ft. lbs. (169 N·m)
Cylinder pivot (upper) - 28 ft. lbs. (38 N·m)
8. After the pivot pin retaining hardware is torqued
the pins must be properly seated. Using a
hammer, strike the head of the bolt and pin sev-
eral times to seat the tapered pin in the taper in 62
the ROPS. Retorque the hardware to specified
torque. Repeat this process until the torque is
maintained.
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 27
63
12. Route the tubes and hoses to the rear of the
boom through the rear hose supports, 1, and on
the top side of the lower link at 2.
64
13. Position the hoses with one on each side of the
lower link retaining clips, 1, and through the hose
retainer at 2. Do not tighten clamps at this time,
further adjustment will be required later.
14. Insert the hoses through the hose support on the
end of link at 3.
15. Reconnect the hoses to the tubes at 4, position-
ing the hoses and tubes for clearance to the
fender, when the boom is raised and lowered.
65
28 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
16. When all boom links and pivot pins are properly
seated and torqued and all hydraulic connec-
tions are tightened, operate the boom up and
down. Check the tube to ROPS (cab) at 1, for
clearance.
66
17. Check the hoses through the rear supports, 1.
When the boom is fully raised, position the hoses
in the support as shown, and remove any slack
from the hoses to the boom tubes.
67
18. Pull all slack from hoses and tighten the top
clamp, 1. Remove any slack between the clamps
and then tighten the second clamp, 2.
68
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 29
69
20. Reinstall the boom mounting plate if removed.
Torque the pivot bolts, 1, to 80 ft. lbs. (108 N·m).
The tapered pivot pins and retaining hardware
must be hammer seated by striking the head of
the bolt and pin and retorquing the bolt. This step
must be repeated until the torque is maintained.
21. Reinstall any shields removed for the repair.
70
30 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
Op. 82 100 70 4
REMOVAL
1. Remove any attachment from the loader attach- 2
ment mounting plate.
2. Lower the boom to the fully lowered position.
3. Tilt the attachment mounting plate forward until 3 3
1
the face is level with the ground.
4. Remove the cylinder attachment mounting plate
pivot pins by removing the pin retaining bolts, 1,
and sliding the pins from the mounting plate and 19984476
cylinders. 71
CAUTION
Support the mounting plate during removal to pre-
vent dropping the plate when pins are removed.
Op. 82 100 74
LATCH LEVER AND PIN REMOVAL/REPAIR
1. Remove any attachment from the loader attach-
ment mounting plate.
2. Lower the boom to the lowered position.
3. Tilt the attachment mounting plate forward until 1
the face is level with the ground.
4. With an allen wrench, remove the setscrew, 1,
from the backside of the mounting plate for both
the left and right sides. 19984477
72
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 31
1
2
19984478
73
7. Remove the cylinder attachment mounting plate
pivot pins to allow access to the latch handle
pivot pin snap ring clips.
CAUTION
Support the mounting plate during removal of the
mounting plate pivot pins to prevent dropping the
plate down when pins are removed.
1 1
8. Remove the pin retaining bolts, 1, and slide the
pins from the mounting plate and cylinders.
19984476
74
9. Enter the skid steer. Sitting in the operator’s seat
with the seat belt buckled, start the loader and re-
tract the attachment mounting plate actuating
cylinders, 1, fully to clear the attachment mount-
ing plate, 2. 1
19984479
75
32 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
19984480
76
12. Remove the handle/spring assembly, 1, from the
attachment mounting plate on the LEFT and
RIGHT sides of the attachment mounting plate.
1
19984481
77
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 33
PARTS INSPECTION
1 1
Mounting Plate Assembly 5
1. Inspect the plate, 1, for straightness. If the 4 3 4
mounting plate pods are not straight with each
other it may be difficult to hook up to attachments.
Refer to the “Checking Procedure for Buckets
6 6
and Attachments” in Section 88 - Optional Equip-
ment for further details. If the mounting plate is
not within specifications, replace the assembly. 7
2. Inspect the latch pin area for excessive wear,
which can result in loose attachments. If the pins, 2
2, do not slide freely, remove the pins, clean and 1998482
lubricate. 78
3. Inspect the mounting plate pivot pins, 3, and
bushings, 4, for wear, which can result in loose
attachment to the mounting plate boom cylin-
ders.
4. Inspect the cylinder pivot pins, 5, for wear. In-
spect the pivot pin holes for wear that could
cause a sloppy fit. Replace the bushings in the
mounting plate or pivot pins, if necessary.
Latch Pins
1. Examine the latch pins, 2, for excessive wear and
binding in the mounting plate.
2. Check the tapered area of the pins for wear or
chips. Replace if necessary.
34 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
Op. 82 100 57
Pivot Bushings Replacement
1. Use a suitable bushing driver and remove the old
bushings.
2. Clean the bushing area to remove any dirt, debris
and burrs.
3. Using a bushing driver, install the new pivot bush-
ings from each end of hole, 1. Drive bushings
flush with the outer edge of the hub.
NOTE: There will be a space in the center between
the two bushings.
79
Op. 82 100 74
2
Latch Lever and Spring Repair/Rebuild
1. Clamp the lower spring guide, 1, in a vise. Turn
the step bolt, 2, to remove the lower spring guide
from the step bolt and remove spring, 3.
1
CAUTION 3
When removing the step bolt, the spring will have
some compression pressure. Remove the bolt while
applying downward pressure on the bolt.
19984483
80
2. Remove the upper spring guide, 1, pivot block, 2,
and step bolt, 3, from handle, 4.
1 2 3
19984484
81
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 35
Reassembly
1. Insert the pivot block, 1, and step bolt, 4, into the
handle, 2. Install the upper spring guide, 3, onto
step bolt, 4.
2. Install spring, 5, over the upper spring guide, 3.
Install the lower spring guide, 6, onto step bolt, 4,
and tighten. 1 3 4 5
NOTE: Apply slight pressure to the lower spring 6
guide to compress the spring slightly and start
threading the lower guide onto the step bolt.
2
19984485
82
3. Slide the latch handle/spring assembly, 1, into
the mounting plate, pointing the spring down.
1
19984481
83
4. Install the handle pivot pin, 1, from the front of the
plate and install the snap ring retaining clip, 2.
The pivot pins will have a snap ring on both ends
of the pins.
NOTE: The handle pivot pin should have one snap
ring retaining clip already installed prior to reinstalla-
tion in the attachment plate. If the snap ring retaining
clip is not present, install the clip prior to pin installa- 1
tion.
19984486
84
36 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
1
2
19984478
85
7. Reinstall the setscrew, 1.
19984477
86
8. Reinstall the boom mounting plate, if removed,
by installing the plate pivot taper pins and retain-
ing hardware, 1.
9. Torque the pivot bolts, 1, to 108 N·m (80 ft. lbs.).
NOTE: The tapered pivot pins and retaining hard-
2
ware must be hammer seated by striking the head of
the bolt and pin, and then re-tightening. This step
must be repeated until the torque remains constant.
10. Reinstall hub caps, 2, into the plate pivots. 1 3 1
11. Extend the attachment mounting plate cylinders
until they align with their mounting holes on the
attachment mounting plate.
19984476
12. Install the cylinder attachment mounting plate
87
pins through the mounting plate and into the cyl-
inder rod ends. Install the pin retaining hardware,
3, and tighten.
13. Grease the two boom mounting plate pivot pins
and the two cylinder mounting plate pivot pins
prior to moving the attachment mounting plate to
prevent any damage to the pivot points.
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 37
Inspection 2
The SL65B loader latching system requires that
the faceplate wedge into the attachment.
The faceplate must contact the attachment at 1, 2,
and 3, and must have clearance between the attach-
ment and faceplate at 4, when the attachment is
latched properly.
The latch pins should not extend below the lower
plate at 5.
4
3
89
The following are some quick visual checks of the
loader faceplate and attachment.
1. The attachment must have an 850 mm ± 0.8 mm
(33-15/32″ ± 1/32″) center to center latch point,
1, to be compatible with the latch system.
2. Check the latch pins and levers for proper oper-
ation and lubrication. If the latch pins do not move
freely, the system will not function properly.
– Control levers pivot over center into the low-
ered latched position.
– Latch pins fully extend from the faceplate.
– Control levers pivot over center into the
raised unlatched position and hold in this
90
position.
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 39
4
91
40 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
CHECKING PROCEDURE
The following are the procedures used to measure
the skid steer faceplate and how to measure the at-
tachment.
1
1-9/32″ 5
92
SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1 41
3
15-5/8″
93
2. Check the faceplate pods to ensure they are
straight with each other and not twisted. Place a
straightedge across both pods as shown at 1,
across the front flat surface and at 2, the top of
the pods.
If the pods are not straight, the faceplate will re-
quire straightening or replacement.
94
42 SECTION 82 – FRONT LOADER – CHAPTER 1
CONTENT
Op. 88 100
GENERAL INFORMATION
1
5. ALWAYS CONNECT new electrical attachments
to the engine fuse/relay panel, 1, and connect the
grounds to the engine bell housing. USE ONLY
vacant connections and fuses not in use for
specified attachments.
6. PLEASE REFER to Service Bulletin 11/95-I4 for
more detailed information about higher amper-
age requirements and making electrical connec-
tions.
2
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 3
3
Engine Fuse Panle
A. Standard fuse block
B. Optional fuse block
4 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
4
For Intermittent High Current Loads up to 15 amps
1. Preheat circuit breaker
2. R/LTBL (preheat load side)
3. R (feed dise)
4. Preheat relay
5. Main ground to bell housing
6. Live to attachment
7. Ground from attachment
8. Attachment power cable
9. Start relay
10. Alternator excite resistor
11. Start interlock relay
12. Drill second hole (protect component whilst drilling)
13. Accessory relay
14. Customer supplied 15 amp circuit breaker
15. Existing hole
16. Customer supplied jumper wire
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 5
5
For Intermittent High Current Loads up to 30 amps
1. Preheat circuit breaker
2. R/LTBL
3. R
4. Preheat relay
5. Customer supplied sealed circuit breaker
6. Customer supplied jumper wire
7. Main ground to bell housing
8. Ground wire from attachment
9. Live wire to attachment
10. Attachment power cable
11. Start relay
12. Alternator excite resistor
13. Start interlock relay
14. Accessory relay
15. Heater power relay
16. Turn signal relay
6 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
SL65B 18.5 US. GPM (70.0 l/min.) @2350 RPM 32.0 US. GPM (22 l/min.) @2250 RPM
@1000 PSI (68 bar) @1000 PSI (68 bar)
NOTE: When using the High-Flow system, 3/4, quick 5. Will the attachment accept hydraulic system
couplers must be used or high system backpressure backpressure?
may result. If “YES”, nothing is required.
3. Will the attachment accept oil flow in both direc- If “NO”, the attachment will not function properly
tions? on a skid-steer loader. Normal backpressure
If “YES”, nothing is required. for skid-steer loaders
If “NO”, install a check valve or cross into the at- is between 13.8 to 17.3 bar (200 to 250 PSI).
tachment return line to prevent reverse oil flow to Examples: Post drivers, some breakers, and
the attachment. some hand held hydraulic tools do not accept
Examples: Backhoes and trees spades with a system backpressure.
separate control valve do not accept oil flow in If all the skid-steer loader oil flow is not required
both directions. to operate an attachment (e.g., shaver post
4. Must the attachment “Free Wheel” to a STOP? driver), a flow divider can be installed into the hy-
draulic oil circuit on the attachment. The flow di-
If “YES”, a crossover relief connection must be
vider sends the required oil flow to the attach-
installed on the attachment side to allow the at-
ment and the remainder back to the normal
tachment to free wheel to a stop after the skid-
skid-steer loader hydraulic circuits.
steer loader hydraulics is turned off.
If “NO”, nothing is required.
Example: Snow blowers must free wheel to a
stop.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 7
6. Does the attachment have a separate case drain NOTE: Skid-steer loaders equipped with High Flow
oil line? Hydraulics have a separate case drain coupler and
If “NO”, nothing is required. return line attached to the right boom arm.
If “YES”, install a separate case drain line to re- 7. Does the attachment require a circuit relief in the
turn the attachment case drain oil directly to the bucket circuit?
hydraulic oil reservoir. If “NO”, nothing is required.
Example: Cold planners have a separate case If “YES”, install a bucket circuit relief valve on
drain oil line. front of the control valve in the bucket circuit.
NOTE: Most attachment case drains will not accept Example: Some mini-backhoes attach like a
backpressure and must drain directly into the reser- bucket, and require a bucket circuit relief.
voir.
8 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
Op. 90 000
Op. 90 000
9
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 9
Op. 90 000
2
FOREARM RESTS 1
The forearm rests are attached to the side of the op-
erator’s cab (one each side) to be used to support the
operator’s arms while operating the skid steer. The
armrest may be pivoted up when not being used or
for ooerator entry and exit of the operator’s area. The
armrest may be used in any combination of controls,
boom/bucket hand controls or boom/bucket foot con- 3
trols. Using the armrest in combination with the boom
and bucket hand controls provides the operator with
arm support during boom and bucket operations.
NOTE: The cab armrest pad kit cannot be installed 10
in combination with the forearm rest kit. The armrest
pads are glued to the same area of the operator’s cab
that the forearm rests are attached.
The SL65B armrests mount with the bracket, 1,
over the cab side panel, 2.
Pivot the armrest up and down, and adjust the two
clamp bolts, 3, if binding occurs, or to retain the
armrest in the raised position.
10 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
Op. 55 000
BACK-UP ALARM
The back-up alarm sound device should be located
to the inside and in the upper right rear corner of the
engine rear door at 1.
The back-up alarm serves as an audible warning de-
vice to alert bystanders and other machine operators
of machine movements. The alarm will only sound
when both hydrostatic control levers are stroked into
reverse. Refer to local codes for requirements.
IMPORTANT: Before servicing any switches or
alarm, disconnect the negative (-) battery ground
cable to avoid accidental shorts in the wiring system 11
when removing or installing components.
Adjustment
With the battery connected, and both hydrostatic
control levers in the neutral position, loosen and slide
both strikers, 1, rearward until the alarm sounds.
Move the strikers forward until the alarm stops (ap-
proximately 1.5 mm [1/16″]) and tighten the hard-
ware.
NOTE: There are two different switch designs. Later
model units will have round collars secured with set
screws. The adjustment procedure is the same.
12
IMPORTANT: Make sure the striker clamp, 2, is posi-
tioned around rod, 3, properly so the clamp will retain
the striker.
NOTE: Both switches must be activated simulta-
neously for the alarm to sound.
13
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 11
14
Back up Alarm Wiring
1. Backup alarm
2. Fuse block
3. LH backup switch
4. RH backup switch
5. Accessory relay
6. Start relay
Op. 10 300
Op. 55 000
18
Electric Power Wiring
1. Start relay
2. Engine compartment fuse block
3. Cab ground
4. Attachment power socket
14 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
Op. 10 254
EXHAUST (ENGINE)
CATALYTIC MUFFLER
The catalytic muffler kit is a combination catalytic and
aspirated precleaner muffler and can be installed on
diesel engines being operated in applications where
cleaner exhaust emissions are required. The catalyt-
ic muffler, 1, is a direct replacement for the standard
muffler.
When operating a skid-steer loader equipped with
the catalytic muffler, the unit must be operated at full
engine speed. 19
The engine exhaust system must be operated at op-
erating temperature for the catalytic purifier muffler to
function properly. If the temperature is not high
enough, the catalytic purifier muffler will not function
properly and not reduce the carbon monoxide level.
The operating life of the purifier muffler will also be re-
duced.
Op. 10 254
20
The aspirator muffler hose connects to the air cleaner
at 1.
NOTE: When the aspirator muffler is installed, the
engine must be operated at or near full engine speed
to reduce the recirculating of exhaust gases through
the air cleaner. If an air cleaner element is sooted
with diesel smoke, the engine is being operated at re-
duced speeds.
21
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 15
Op. 35 000
HIGH-FLOW HYDRAULICS
When the high-flow hydraulics circuit is used, it will
allow the operator to utilize more available engine
horsepower through the auxiliary hydraulic circuit.
The high-flow increases the hydraulic flow:
SL65B
From 18.5 US. GPM (70 LPM) at 1000 PSI (68 bar)
at 2225 RPM to 32.3 US. GPM (122 LPM) at 1000
PSI (68 bar), (at 2500 PSI [170 bar] = 47.1 hydraulic
horsepower).
22
19987112
23
When the high-flow is being used, 3/4″ quick
couplers, 1, must be used on the loader and attach-
ment or overheating of the hydraulic oil may occur.
The 1/2″ quick couplers, 2, can be used for other at-
tachments that do not require the added oil flow.
24
16 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
25
The case drain line drains into the hydraulic reser-
voir, 1. Most auxiliary hydraulic drive attachments
equipped with a separate case drain line require no
system back pressure for the drain line.
26
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 17
No selector valve operation No battery voltage to selector valve Check switch for proper operation
No selector valve spool movement Check valve spool for binding and
sticking
Hydraulic oil overheats Using 1/2″ quick couplers Must use 3/4″ quick couplers
Control valve and boom steel lines Change lines and hoses to 3/4″
and hoses were not changed from
5/8″ to 3/4″
Operating attachment when high oil Turn high-flow switch to the “OFF”
flows are not required position
All lift check parts not removed Remove all lift check parts (spring,
during assembly. poppet, and cap)
Oil cooler restricted not allowing Clean oil cooler and radiator
cooling air to flow properly
18 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
Low hydraulic power Low main system relief valve setting Check and replace relief valve
Leaking control valve plugs, leaking Check O ring and backup washer
oil to return on plugs
Inefficient gear pump (main) Check pump efficiency, repair or
replace
Inefficient gear pump (high-flow) Check pump efficiency, repair or
replace
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 19
HIGH-FLOW HYDRAULICS
COMPONENT REPLACEMENT
Op. 35 724
High-Flow Selector Valve Replacement
To access the selector valve:
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom lock pins.
2. Open the rear engine access door and remove
the right engine side shield.
3. The engine belly pan can also be removed for
more access as shown.
4. Mark and remove the lines from the selector
valve, 1. 27
5. Remove selector valve mounting hardware.
Rebuild the selector valve with new O rings on the
spool and fittings at 1, and on both ends of the coil at
2.
To check the coil, use an ohmmeter and put one lead
on one wire and the other on the other wire; the ohms
reading should be between 7.5 and 11.5. If the coil is
not within specification, replace it.
NOTE: The SL65B selector valve is located to the
rear of the battery box (radiator end).
28
Op. 35 710
High-Flow Gear Pump Removal
1. Raise the boom and rest on the boom lock pins.
2. Raise the operator’s seat and latch in the raised
latched position.
3. Remove suction line, 1, from the pump and cap
the line. If the lines are not capped, the hydraulic
oil reservoir must be drained to prevent loss of oil.
4. Remove the pressure line, 2, from the pump.
5. Loosen the gear pump mounting bolts, 3, and re-
move.
6. Remove the pump from gearbox. The charge
line, 4, may need to be removed to remove pump. 29
NOTE: The gearbox oil level is below the pump drive
level, the gearbox does not require draining.
20 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
30
Op. 35 710 20
Gear Pump Repair
1. Remove the pump hardware, 1.
2. Using a soft hammer, tap the gear pump section
to separate the pump sections.
3. Inspect the pump bearings, 2, for damage and
wear.
4. Inspect the pump center section, 3, for scoring
damage.
5. Inspect the pump end caps and bearing plate at
6
4 for scoring damage.
6. Inspect the drive shaft, 5, and gears, 6, for wear
and scoring. Inspect the shaft in seal and bearing 31
areas for scoring.
Gear Pump Reinstallation
1. Reinstall the inside retaining ring, 1, gear, 2, and
outside retaining ring, 3, on pump shaft.
2. Apply a 1/4″ bead of silicone sealant around the
pump flange at 4, and around the retaining hard-
ware to seal pump top gearbox.
32
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 21
33
4. Reattach the 1/2″ hose to the pump fitting, 1.
5. Reattach the 3/4″ hose to the pump fitting, 2.
34
Start-Up After Repair
1. Engage the parking brake. Check that the high
flow control switch, 1, is in the “OFF” position. 1
(The switch is located to the left of the operator’s
seat.)
2. Start the loader with the high-flow control switch
in the “OFF” position and operate at idle, no more
than 1500 RPM for about 10 minutes to allow air
to be removed from the hydraulic system. Check
for oil leaks and repair if required.
3. After operating the unit for a few minutes and with
the control valve spool in the neutral position,
turn the high-flow control switch to “ON” position 19987112
and operate for a few minutes. Turn the switch to 35
the “OFF” position. Check for oil leaks and repair
if required.
22 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
36
NOTE: When the high-flow hydraulics are in oper-
ation, the 3/4, couplers must be used.
NOTE: Flat-faced quide couplers have become stan-
dard equipment for Boom Hydraulic kits, High-Flow
Hydraulic kits, and production models equipped with
these options.
1
2
37
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 23
Some attachments may require oil flow in one direc- IMPORTANT: When operating the high-flow for ex-
tion ONLY and must be assembled accordingly. If the tended periods of time, monitor the system tempera-
attachment will not accept oil flow in both directions, tures. If temperatures reach 2105F (995C), for engine
a check valve must be installed in the return line from coolant, or 2005F (935C), for hydraulic oil, back off
the attachment to prevent damage to the attachment. operation to allow the systems to cool down.
To stop the attachment operation, return the control IMPORTANT: Operating hydraulic attachments at
to the neutral position. When the additional hydraulic maximum HP relief valve pressure will cause ex-
oil flow is not required, turn the electronic control cessive heat. Relief valves operated at relief pressur-
switch to the “OFF” position. es will cause hydraulic oil to overheat quickly.
During operation of the hydraulic high flow, use the The high-flow switch MUST BE IN THE “OFF” posi-
skid-steer loader Advanced Warning System to tion when the added oil flow is not required or the at-
monitor the engine coolant or hydraulic oil tempera- tachment is not in use to prevent unnecessary hy-
ture. draulic oil heating and engine loads.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 25
40
41
High Flow Hydraulic Oil Flow Diagram
1. 10 micron filter 10. Male auxiliary quick coupler
2. Oil cooler 11. Auxiliary Sppol
3. Engine 12. Boom spool
4. Engine gearbox 13. Bucket spool
5. High flow auxiliary pump 14. Three spool control valve
6. LH hydrostatic pump 15. Right boom case drain quick coupler
7. RH hydrostatic pump 16. reservoir
8. Main system hydraulic pump 17. High flow relief valve
9. Female auxiliary quick coupler 18. Selector valve
26 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
Op. 55 000
HORN 1
The horn kit provides an operator-controlled device
to alert bystanders and other machine operators.
The horn button is located in the top of the left hydro-
static control lever as shown at 1.
19984626
42
Horn Wiring Diagram
43
Horn Wiring Diagram
1. Accessory relay 5. Attachment power outlet
2. Start relay 6. Horn switch
3. Engine compartment fuse block 7. Horn
4. LH cab ground
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 27
Op. 90 000
44
If the shoulder belt becomes completely retracted or
the belt becomes locked, the web must move back
into the retractor approximately 1/2″ with the retrac-
tor in 90/90 degree or proper mounting position.
When the belt is retracted 1/2″, hold the belt straight
up and pull the belt up slowly, 1. The belt will not un-
lock and pull out in any other position.
45
The shoulder belt support pivot bolt, 1, must be loose
enough to allow the belt to pivot. If the belt will not
pivot properly, it will not adjust to fit the operator.
46
28 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
Op. 88 000
47
1. Attach the angle, 1, with one 5/16″ x 1-1/4″ car-
riage bolt from the kit and nut and M8 lock washer
previously removed at 2.
2. Attach the spade socket to the angle at 3 using
two 5/16″ x 1″ carriage bolts, M8 lock washers,
and nuts.
3. Assemble the SMV sign, 4, to the support, 5,
using two #10 x 1/2″ machine screws and flange
nuts at 6.
4. Mount the SMV sign assembly in the spade
socket as shown at 7.
48
Op. 44 511
TYRES/WHEELS
TYRE OPTIONS
1. 8.25 x 15 HST-Hollow segmented
2. 12.00 x 16.5 HST-Hollow segmented
3. 8.25 x 15 Chevron tread
4. 12.00 x 16.5 R4-Cleat tread
5. 12.00 x 16.5 PHD- Premium heavy-duty
6. 14.00 x 17.5 cleat tread (not shown)
7. Solid Tyres (not shown) 49
NOTE: Solid Tyres are available and can be obtained
from your New Holland dealer.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 29
Tyre Pressures
Tyre Pressure
8.25 x 15 Chevron tread 50 PSI (414 kPa)
7.50 x 15 HST-Hollow segmented N/A
12.00 x 16.5 R4-Cleat tread 50 PSI (345 kPa)
12.00 x 16.5 PHD- Premium heavy-duty 50 PSI (345 kPa)
12.00 x 16.5 HST-Hollow segmented N/A
14.00 x 17.5 - cleat tread 60 PSI (410 kPa)
50
Op. 44 511 28
When replacing the sections of the hollow seg-
mented Tyres, torque the section hardware to 10 ft.
lbs. (13.6 N·m).
51
30 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
Op. 55 000
53
The beacon light switch, 1, is located in the ignition
key switch panel in the upper right corner of the over-
head dash.
To remove the switch, disconnect the negative (-)
ground battery cable, remove the key switch panel
hardware, 2, and tilt the panel down.
54
Disconnect wires from the switch, squeeze the
switch retaining tabs in, and remove the switch from
the panel.
55
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 33
56
Beacon Wiring Diagram
NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place
the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface
and then stack the remaining ground wires according
to size on top of the heaviest wire.
Y O/Y
B
Y B 3
2
Y O/Y
1
O/LTBL
O/DKBR
10A
O/Y O/Y
ACC 7.5A
ST
5 4
BAT IGN
BSC0962A
57
1. Beacon switch 4. Beacon light
2. Cab inner fuse block 5. Cab ground
3. Key switch
34 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
58
Squeeze the bulb retaining tabs to separate the bulb
from the holder.
Remove the bulb assembly from the wire connector.
59
Op. 55 000
60
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 35
61
Disconnect the wires from the switch. Squeeze the
switch retaining tabs in and remove the switch from
the panel.
62
Warning Light Switch Wiring
63
36 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
1 5
DKBR/LTGN
DKBR/LTGN
B–2
B–7
B
B O/DKBR
O/DKBR 4
O/DKBR B B–7 6
5
Y/R
2
3 4 B–2
7
6 B
2 3
R/B R/B
10A
Y Y/R
B–10 Y/R
DKGN
Y
DKBR/Y
O/Y 9
5
DKBR/Y 8
LTGN/W
Y/W 1 Y/W
3 O/DKBR
LTGN/W
DKBR/LTGN 14 6
DKBR/LTGN
10
18 DKBR/LTGN 4 7 DKBR/LTGN
R/ N GK D
B
R/ N GK D
B–1 B
DKGN/Y
DKBR/Y 15A
DKBR/Y 9
B/ L BK D
15
R/ N GK D
B
11 10
B
16
DKGN/R
W
Y/ N GK D
N GK D
DKGN/R
B
R/ Y
DKBL/B 13
Y/R
17 12
BSC0961A
64
Warning Light (Four-way) Wiring Diagram
1. Right front flashing light 10. Fuse block D
2. Hazard switch/beacon/off/4 way/flash 11. LH cab ground
3. Flasher module 12. Left rear flashing light
4. Turn signal relay 13. Turn signal switch
5. Right rear flashing light 14. Turn signal converter module
6. To ground 15. Turn signal indicator lights
7. Fuse block B 16. Horn switch
8. from preheat circuit breaker 17. Left front flashing light
9. from accessory relay 18. Horn
NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface and
then stack the remaining ground wires according to size on top of the heaviest wire.
SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1 37
Op. 55 404 10
Front Light
1. Remove the bezel, 1, retaining screws and re-
move lens from support.
2. Disconnect the wire harness from the bulb
holder.
3. Rotate the light bulb holder and element assem-
bly from the lens and remove from the lens.
4. Insert the new bulb into the lens and rotate to lock 65
into position, using caution not to touch the bulb
element.
IMPORTANT: Touching the light bulb element may
damage the element and cause a premature failure.
Op. 55 404 10
Rear Light
1. Remove the bezel, 1, retaining hardware and re-
move the lens from the light bar.
NOTE: The remaining light lens will be loose in the
light bar.
2. Disconnect the wire harness from the bulb
holder.
3. Rotate the light bulb holder and element assem-
bly from the lens and remove from the lens.
4. Insert the new bulb into the lens and rotate it to
lock into position, using caution not to touch the
bulb element. 66
IMPORTANT: Touching the light bulb element may
damage the element and cause a premature failure.
38 SECTION 88 – ACCESSORIES – CHAPTER 1
SECTION 90 – PLATFORM, CAB, BODYWORK, AND DECALS
CONTENT
GENERAL INFORMATION
Op. 90 108
SAFETY DECALS
The safety decals located on the skid steer are in-
tended for the personal safety of you and those work-
ing with you.
Keep the decals legible. If they are not, replace as re-
quired.
SEAT AND SEAT PAN SUPPORT
Incorporated in the seat and seat belt buckle are
switches that tie the seat and seat belt into the EIC
(Electronic Instrument Cluster) Advanced Warning
System. When the seat belt is unbuckled and/or the
operator is out of the operator’s seat, the boom and
bucket control valve spools will be locked in the neu-
tral position. The operator will have to properly se-
quence the system to unlock the controls, sit in the
seat and buckle the seat belt.
1
The seat and seat pan support can be locked up in
the raised position as shown at 1.
CAUTION
Do not work under a raised seat unless it is securely
latched in the raised position.
2
The seat/pan support assembly support rod, 1, is
shown in the raised latched position at 2.
To lower the seat assembly, raise the seat upward to
the top of the cab and pull the support rod, 1, forward
to unlatch and lower the seat assembly. 2
1
3
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 3
19984338
4
Op. 90 152
5
Op. 90 120 10
SEAT REMOVAL
This section describes how to remove the seat and
seat pan support assembly.
Op. 90 120 12
SEAT PAN SUPPORT REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (–) battery cable.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the (–) negative ground
cable. Failure to disconnect the battery may result in
damage to the EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster)
monitoring system and other electrical components.
2. Disconnect the seat and seat belt wire harness 6
connector, 1.
4 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1
19984338
7
6. The right side of the seat and pan support assem-
bly shows the seat belt buckle, 1, wire harness,
2, and seat latch rod, 3.
7. To remove the seat belt buckle, remove the wire
harness retaining clamp, 4, and buckle hard-
ware, 5.
NOTE: When reinstalling the seat belt buckle hard-
ware, 5, tighten the pivot bolt tight enough to hold the
belt in a set position but will allow movement of the
buckle to the front or rear as required by the operator.
8
8. Remove the seat retaining hardware, 1, to separ-
ate the seat and seat track from the seat pan sup-
port. Remove the wire clamp at 2, if the seat/seat
belt wire harness is being replaced.
9. Holding the seat in place, unplug the seat
switch(es). Disconnect the wire harness from the
switch(es) by releasing the latch away from the
switch.
9
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 5
Op. 55 201 15
11. Remove the switch(es) from the seat pan, 2.
Note the standard seat uses one switch and the
deluxe seat uses two switches as shown. 1 1
10
12. To remove the seat/seat belt wire harness re-
move the grommet at 1, and pull the harness
from the seat pan.
13. Remove the seat pan latch rod, 2, by removing
the retaining hardware, 3.
11
SEAT, SWITCH AND PAN REINSTALLATION
1. Install the switch(es) into the seat pan, making
sure the switch is seated into the hole in the seat
pan, 1.
IMPORTANT: If the switch is not seated properly
when the retaining hardware is tightened, the switch
flange will be broken.
2. Reconnect the wire harness to the switch(es)
and reinstall the seat retaining hardware. Make
sure the harness connector latches are en-
gaged.
12
6 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1
13
4. Reinstall the seat and seat pan support assembly
into the loader and attach with hardware at 1.
If the seat pan latch rod, 2, or latch plates, 3, were
removed they may require adjustment to ensure 1
proper seat latching. 2
19984338
14
5. To adjust the latches, 1, lower the seat down to
the operating position and slide the latches, 1, to
obtain full engagement of latches and latch rod.
After the latches are adjusted release latch rod,
raise seat and lower seat to operating position.
Try lifting on the front of the seat to verify seat pan
support is latched securely.
15
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 7
16
CAB INNER SHELL
This section describes how to remove and install the
cab inner shell.
Op. 90 152 34
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
IMPORTANT: Disconnect the (-) negative ground
cable. Failure to disconnect the battery may result in
damage to the EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster)
monitoring system and other electrical components.
2. Disconnect the seat and seat belt wire harness
connector, 1. 17
3. Remove the EIC board retaining hardware, 1,
and remove the EIC board from the overhead
dash area.
4. Unplug the two wire harness connectors from the
EIC, taking care to not stress or bend the plastic
locking ramps on the connectors.
NOTE: Note the positioning of the connectors to the
EIC board and reconnect in the correct position. If the
connector is not connected properly, damage to the
EIC may occur.
IMPORTANT: Do not service the EIC board with
magnetized tools, wrenches, screwdrivers, etc., or
magnets. Severe damage to the EIC board may
occur. 18
8 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1
19984593
19
7. Remove the ignition switch panel hardware, 1,
and lower the switch panel.
DO NOT remove any wires from any switches.
20
8. Remove any ground wires attached to cab
ground terminal at 1.
9. Remove any wire harness ties or clamps in the
upper cab area at this time. Remove the wire har-
ness, fuse and switch panels from the right cab
side sheet.
10. If the unit is equipped with front lights the light
harness and light bulbs must be removed.
IMPORTANT: Touching the light bulb element may
damage the element and cause a premature failure.
21
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 9
1 1
2 2
19997740
22
12. Remove the front cross support, 1, by removing
hardware, 2, separating the cross member from
the right and left side panels.
23
13. Remove the rear window and frame assembly re-
taining hardware, 1, and lift the window and
frame from the loader.
24
10 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1
19984338
25
17. Remove the four retaining screws from the front
shield, 1, and the eight retaining bolts from the
step shield, 2. Remove both shields from the
loader.
26
18. Remove the right and left fenders, 1, to access
the front isolator mount bolts and wire harness.
27
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 11
1 1
28
20. Remove any wire harness clamps and cut wire
ties along the rear of the seat support, 1, and side
panels, 2.
2 1 2
29
21. Remove the upper rear support retaining hard-
ware, 1, right and left side and remove support.
30
12 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1
31
23. Remove the right and left hydrostatic control
handle assembly retaining hardware, 1. Unhook
the hydrostatic control linkage and auxiliary
boom hydraulic linkage. Unplug any electrical
connections, high flow switch or horn and lift the
control assemblies from the loader.
32
24. Remove the left and right side shield isolator and
hardware at 1, right side shown.
33
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 13
2
3
34
26. Remove the throttle control cable, 1, from the
control lever at 2. Remove the cable retaining
nut, 3, and slide the cable down through the right
side shield at 4.
27. Remove the control lever pivot bolt, 5, from the
lever and support.
35
28. Remove the cotter pins from the parking brake
control link spring at 1. Unhook the spring link 6 5
from the control rod, 2.
29. Remove the control rod support hardware, 3.
30. Remove the control lever hardware, 4.
31. Rotate the control rod, 2, down to remove link
from the side shield at 5, and slide the rod from
the support at 6.
Now the side shields can be removed from the loader
ROPS frame.
36
14 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1
37
REINSTALLATION
1. Position the right and left side shields inside the
loader frame.
2. Install the front side isolators and retaining hard-
ware, 1. Do not tighten at this time.
38
3. Lay the main cab wire harness along the inside
of the right side shield, 1, at the top and right rear
corner.
39
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 15
40
5. Install the upper rear support, 1, and retaining
hardware, 2. Do not tighten at this time.
1
41
6. Install the front cross member, 1, and retaining
hardware, 2. Do not tighten at this time. 2 2
7. Position the inner shell assembly squarely with
the ROPS frame. Make sure the wire harness is
positioned to prevent damage to the harness
when the inner shell isolators and support hard- 1 1
ware is tightened.
8. Tighten the front support hardware.
9. Install the light pads, 1, with one long bolt, 2, and
washers for each pod. Plug each light into the 3 3
harness connectors and install by pushing left
side in first.
19997740
42
16 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1
43
11. With the inner shell positioned and cross sup-
ports securely tightened, tighten the front, 1, and
rear, 2, isolator support hardware at this time.
44
12. Reinstall all wire harness retaining clamps and
plastic ties to secure the harness, 1, in the upper
right rear corner of the operator’s cab.
45
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 17
46
14. Reinstall the wire harness clamps and ties along
the left side of the operator’s cab at 1.
15. Position the rear of the harness and engine relay/
fuse panel and install harness clamps and ties at
2.
16. With the harness positioned pull a loop (excess)
of harness through the support at 3, to retain the
excess wire harness.
47
17. Reinstall the light pods, light wire harness and
lights.
18. Reconnect the wire harness to all switches and
EIC (Electronic Instrument Cluster) previously
removed.
NOTE: Plug the two wire harness connectors into the
EIC, noting the correct positioning of the connectors.
If the connectors are not connected properly, dam-
age to the EIC may occur.
IMPORTANT: Do not service the EIC board with
magnetized tools, wrenches, screwdrivers, etc. or
magnets. Severe damage to the EIC board may
occur.
19. Remove any paint from the ground surface and 48
attach ground wires at 1.
NOTE: When attaching ground wires, always place
the heaviest ground wire next to the ground surface
and then stack the remaining ground wires according
to size on top of the heaviest wire.
18 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1
49
21. Reinstall the wire harness along the right side
shield at 1. Install wire clamps and ties to prevent
harness damage. Install the service/run switch,
fuse panel and ignition switch panel.
50
22. Reinstall the parking brake control rod and pivot
bearings. Install the right bearing into the right
support, 1.
Slide control rod, 2, into right bearing, place the
left bearing and support over rod at 3, and rotate
control rod link into cab at 4. Attach the left bear-
ing support to the cab at 5.
51
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 19
52
24. Attach the handle assembly, 1, to the control link
at 2. Slide the handle grip, 3, over end of handle,
1. Use silicone or weather strip glue to hold grip
in position.
53
25. Reconnect the spring links, 1, to the control rod
at 2 and install the cotter pins.
54
20 SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1
55
28. Reinstall the right and left hydrostatic control
lever assemblies, 1.
After the assemblies are installed check the
levers for parallel, external stop and neutral ad-
justment. If adjustment is required refer to the op-
erator’s manual for detailed adjustment informa-
tion.
29. Reinstall the rear window assembly, 2.
30. Install the step shield, 3.
56
31. Slide the throttle cable up through the hole in the
left cab panel and secure with retaining nut at 1.
Attach the control lever, 2, to the cab panel at 3,
with 3/8″ x 1-1/2″ cap screw; friction disc, 4;
spring, 5; 3/8″ flat washer and locknut. Tighten
the pivot hardware to hold the control lever in set
position. Over tightening will require more effort
to set throttle.
32. Reconnect the (-) negative ground battery cable.
33. Reinstall any shields and fenders previously re-
moved.
57
SECTION 90 – PLATFORMS, CAB, BODYWORK & DECALS – CHAPTER 1 21
Op. 90 108 around your machine and note the content and loca-
tion of these warning signs. Review these decals with
SAFETY DECALS your machine operators.
The following safety decals have been placed on Keep the decals legible. If they are not, obtain re-
your machine in the areas indicated. They are in- placements from your New Holland dealer. The decal
tended for the personal safety of you, and those part numbers are listed with each decal.
working with you. Please take this manual, walk